Академический Документы
Профессиональный Документы
Культура Документы
www.anvilintl.com
JANUARY 2014 For the most current product/pricing information on Anvil products, please visit our website at www.anvilintl.com
B U I L D I N G C O N N E c T I O N S T H AT L A S T
For over 160 years, Anvil has worked diligently to build a strong, vibrant tradition of making connections pipe to pipe and people to people.
We pride ourselves in providing the nest-quality pipe products and services with integrity and dedication to superior customer service at all levels. We provide expertise and product solutions for a wide range of applications, from plumbing, mechanical, HVAC, industrial and re protection to mining, oil and gas. Our comprehensive line of products includes: grooved pipe couplings, grooved and plain-end ttings, valves, cast and malleable iron ttings, forged steel ttings, steel pipe nipples and couplings, pipe hangers and supports, channel and strut ttings, mining and oil eld ttings, along with much more. As an additional benet to our customers, Anvil offers a complete and comprehensive Design Services Analysis for mechanical equipment rooms, to help you determine the most effective and cost-efcient piping solutions. Anvil is a proud member of the United States Green Building Council (USGBC). Go to the Anvil website to obtain manufacturer recycled certicates and other Green information. At Anvil, we believe that responsive and accessible customer support is what makes the difference between simply delivering products and delivering solutions.
We also provide:
Special Fabrication/ Miscellaneous Structural/ Steel Fabrication Special Design Products Per Customer Specications Domestic Manufactured Product Line
Design Services
Either on or off-site, Anvil Design Services helps you maximize the efciency of your pipe support systems. These services include: Pipe Hanger Design & Engineering Computer-Aided Drafting System Analysis Pipe Stress Analysis Product Qualification Testing (environmental static and cycling loads, ow and leak) Field Services Supervision of Client Design Personnel Non-destructive Examination
PH-1.14
Customer Service
With four key stocking locations throughout North America, you can count on getting all of the product you need - when you need it. When you have installation questions our solid customer service personnel are there to answer all of you questions, backed by our designers or engineers we are there for you - on site if needed.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
General Notes
General Notes
Standard Materials...................................................................................................... 16 Standard Galvanizing Practice.......................................................................17 - 18
through
Beam Clamps
Fig. 86 & Fig. 88 C-Clamp........................................................................................60 Fig. 95 C-Clamp with Locknut.............................................................................. 61 Fig. 89 & 89X Retaining Clip...................................................................................62 Fig. 92 Universal C-Type Clamp (Standard Throat). ....................................63 Fig. 93 Universal C-Type Clamp (Wide Throat)...........................................64 Fig. 94 Wide Throat Top Beam C-Clamp........................................................ 65 Fig. 227 Top Beam Clamp........................................................................................66 Fig. 217 Adjustable Side Beam Clamp................................................................67 Fig. 14 Adjustable Side Beam Clamp..................................................................67 Fig. 133 Standard Duty Beam Clamp..................................................................68 Fig. 134 Heavy Duty Beam Clamp. .......................................................................68 Fig. 218 Malleable Beam Clamp without Extension Piece..................... 69 Fig. 228 Universal Forged Steel (UFS) Beam Clamp. .................................. 70 Fig. 292 & Fig. 292L Universal Forged Steel (UFS) Beam Clamp........... 71
Structural Attachments
Fig. 55 & Fig. 55L Structural Welding Lug.........................................................72 Fig. 54 Two Hole Welding Beam Lug.................................................................73 Fig. 66 Welded Beam Attachment. .....................................................................74 Fig. 60 Steel Washer Plate.......................................................................................75 Fig. 112 Brace Fitting Complete.............................................................................76 Fig. 113 Brace Fitting (Pipe End Only)..................................................................76
Pipe Rings
Fig. 108 Split Pipe Ring...............................................................................................36 Fig. 138R Extension Split Pipe Clamp.................................................................37 Fig. 104 Adjustable Swivel Ring, Split Ring Type..........................................38 Fig. 69 Adjustable Swivel Ring, Tapped per NFPA Standards...............39
Brackets
Fig. 202 Iron Side Beam Bracket...........................................................................77 Fig. 206 Steel Side Beam Bracket.........................................................................78 Fig. 207 Threaded Steel Side Beam Bracket...................................................78 Fig. 189 Straight Eye Socket. ................................................................................... 79 Fig. 190 Off-Set Eye Socket. ...................................................................................80 Fig. 194 Light Welded Steel Bracket.................................................................. 81 Fig. 195 Medium Welded Steel Bracket........................................................... 82 Fig. 199 Heavy Welded Steel Bracket................................................................83
Clevis
Fig. 67 Pipe or Conduit Hanger............................................................................40 Fig. 65 Light Duty Adjustable Clevis.................................................................. 41 Fig. 260 Adjustable Clevis Hanger.......................................................................42 Fig. 260 ISS Clevis Hanger with Insulation Saddle System..........43 - 45 Fig. 300 Adjustable Clevis for Insulated Lines.............................................46 Fig. 590 Adjustable Clevis for Ductile or Cast Iron Pipe.........................47
4 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
TABLE OF CONTENTS
General Table of Notes Contents
Pipe Rolls
Fig. 177 Adjustable Pipe Roll Support..............................................................127 Fig. 171 Single Pipe Roll............................................................................................128 Fig. 178 Spring Cushion Hanger...........................................................................129 Fig. 181 Adjustable Steel Yoke Pipe Roll.........................................................130 Fig. 175 Roller Chair....................................................................................................131 Fig. 277 Pipe Roll and Base Plate........................................................................ 132 Fig. 271 PIpe Roll Stand............................................................................................ 133 Fig. 274, Fig. 274P & Fig. 275 Adjustable Pipe Roll Stand........................134 Fig. 76CP Non-Conductive Roll.......................................................................... 135
Rod Attachments
Fig. 135, Fig. 135E & Fig. 135R Rod Coupling...................................................100 Fig. 136 & Fig. 136R Rod Coupling......................................................................100 Fig. 114 Turnbuckle Adjuster.................................................................................. 101 Fig. 110R Socket, Rod Threaded.......................................................................... 101 Fig. 157 Extension Piece.......................................................................................... 102 Fig. 290 & Fig. 290L Weldless Eye Nut........................................................... 102 Fig. 299 Forged Steel Clevis..................................................................................103 Fig. 233 Turnbuckle................................................................................................... 104 Fig. 230 Turnbuckle. .................................................................................................. 104
Straps
Fig. 126 One-Hole Clamp..................................................................................... 109 Fig. 262 Strap Short.................................................................................................. 109 Fig. 243 & 244 Pipe Strap. ........................................................................................ 110
Fig. 62 Pipe Stanchion................................................................................................111 Fig. 63 Pipe Stanchion...............................................................................................112 Fig. 192 Adjustable Pipe Saddle. ...........................................................................113 Fig. 191 Adjustable Pipe Saddle with U-Bolt.................................................113 Fig. 258 Pipe Saddle Support................................................................................114 Fig. 264 Adjustable Pipe Saddle Support.......................................................115 Fig. 265 Adjustable Pipe Saddle Support with U-Bolt............................116 Fig. 259 Pipe Saddle Support with U-Bolt.....................................................117
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
Model R 80-V, C-80-V Vertical & 81-H, C-81-H Horizontal...... 182 - 185 Total Travel & Selection Chart................................................................186 - 189 Fig. 80-V Type A......................................................................................................... 190 Fig. 80-V Type B...........................................................................................................191 Fig. 80-V Type C..........................................................................................................192 Fig. 80-V Type D..........................................................................................................193
Rod Attachments
Fig. 46 Universal Trapeze Assembly..................................................................118 Fig. 45 Channel Assembly.......................................................................................119 Fig. 50 Equal Leg Angle for Trapeze Assembly.......................................... 120
Constant Supports
Hanger Rods
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Fig. 82, B-268, 98, Triple & Quadruple Springs............................... 164 - 165 Spring Hanger Size & Series Selection.................................................166 - 167 Check List.......................................................................................................................168 Fig. B-268, Fig. C-268 Type A................................................................................169 Fig. B-268, Fig. C-268 Type B & C. .......................................................................170 Fig. B-268, Fig. C-268 Type D & E.........................................................................171 Fig. B-268, Fig. C-268 Type F.................................................................................172 Fig. B-268, Fig. C-268 Type G................................................................................ 173 Fig. 82, Fig. C-82 Series Short Spring..................................................... 174 - 175 Fig. 98, Fig. C-98 Series Double Spring.................................................176 - 177 Triple Spring, Triple Spring-CR Series...................................................178 - 179 Quadruple Spring, Quadruple Spring-CR Series............................180 - 181
Brackets
Spring Hangers
Structural Attachments
Fig. 291 Clevis Pin with Cotters...........................................................................105 Machine Bolts & Hexagon Nuts........................................................................ 106 Fig. 137, Fig. 137S Standard & Special U-Bolts. ...............................................107 Fig. 137C Plastic Coated U-Bolt.......................................................................... 108 Fig. 120 Light Weight U-Bolts. ............................................................................. 108
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Constant Supports through Index
Fig. 80-V Type E...........................................................................................................194 Fig. 80-V Type F...........................................................................................................195 Fig. 80-V Type G. .........................................................................................................196 Fig. 80-V Type A, B & C Size 84-110...................................................................197 Fig. 81-H Type A...........................................................................................................198 Fig. 81-H Type B...........................................................................................................199 Fig. 81-H Type C.........................................................................................................200 Fig. 81-H Type D. ......................................................................................................... 201 Fig. 81-H Type E. ..........................................................................................................202 Fig. 81-H Type F Upthrust......................................................................................203 Fig. 81-H Type A, B, C & E Size 84-110............................................................. 204 Fig. 80-V and Fig. 81-H Weight Chart..............................................................205 Check List..................................................................................................................... 206 Fig. 170 Horizontal Traveler..................................................................................207 Maximum Recommended Applied Torques.............................................. 257 Beam Dimensions.....................................................................................................258
Anvil Compliances, Listings and Approvals...........259 - 264 Anvil Pipe Hanger & Support Services....................................265 Anvil Terms of Sale and Conditions..........................................266 Index
Subject Index. ..............................................................................................................267 Numerical Index........................................................................................... 268 - 269
Anvil reserves the right to make specication changes without notice. While every effort has been made to assure the accuracy of information contained in this catalog at the time of publication, we cannot accept responsibility for inaccuracies resulting from undetected errors or omissions. The acceptability of galvanized coatings at temperatures above 450F is at the discretion of the end user. Rod load ratings shown in this catalog are based upon MSS-SP-58 (2002 and later).
Snubbers
Fig. 3306, 3307 Hydraulic Snubber......................................................... 216 - 219 Fig. 200, C-200, 201, C-201 Hydraulic Snubber..............................220 - 223 Fig. 312 Tapered Pin...................................................................................................224
Application Assembly Examples.......................................229 - 236 Pipe Hanger Specications...................................................... 237 - 238 Master Format 3 Part Specication...............................239 - 248 Technical Data
Pipe Support Spacing. ................................................................................ 249 - 250 Steel Pipe Data................................................................................................251 - 252 Copper Tube Data.................................................................................................... 252 Soil Pipe Data.............................................................................................................. 253 AWWA Ductile Iron Pipe Data. .......................................................................... 253 PVC Plastic Pipe Data..............................................................................................254 Thermal Expansion of Pipe Material. ..................................................255 - 256 Threaded Rod Data.................................................................................................. 257
6 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
Pipe Rings
Fig. CT-69
Page 20
Fig. CT-65
Page 21
Fig. CT-138R
Page 22
Adjustable Swivel Ring Felt Lined Size Range: 1/2" thru 6"
Fig. 69F
Page 23
Copper Tube Felt Lined Hanger Size Range: 1/2" thru 6"
Fig. 67F
Page 24
Pages 26 - 27
Page 25
Page 22
Fig. 137SS
Page 28
Fig. 260SS
Page 29
Fig. 261SS
Page 30
Adjustable Clevis for Ductile or C.I. Pipe Size Range: 4" thru 12"
Fig. 590SS
Page 31
Fig. 185
Page 32
Fig. 186
Page 33
Two Hole 90 Side Mount Strap Size Range: 3/4" thru 2"
Fig. 187
Page 34
Two Hole Stand Off Strap Size Range: 3/4" thru 2"
Fig. 188
Page 35
Pipe Rings
Fig. 108
Page 36
Fig. 138R
Page 37
Adjustable Swivel Ring, Split Ring Type Size Range: 3/4" thru 8"
Fig. 104
Page 38
Fig. 69
Page 39
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Fig. CT-255
Fig. CT-121
Fig. CT-128R
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
Fig. 67
Page 40
Fig. 65
Page 41
Fig. 260
Page 42
Clevis Hanger with Insulation Saddle System Size Range: 2" thru 16"
Adjustable Clevis for Insulated Lines Size Range: 3/4" thru 12"
Fig. 300
Page 46
Adjustable Clevis for Ductile or Cast Iron Size Range: 3" thru 24"
Fig. 590
Page 47
Fig. 261
Page 48
Fig. 40
Page 49
Fig. 103
Page 50
Fig. 100
Page 50
Fig. 212
Page 51
Fig. 212FP
Page 52
Fig. 216
Page 53
Fig. 295
Page 54
Alloy Double Bolt Pipe Clamp Size Range: 11/2" thru 24"
Fig. 295A
Page 55
Heavy Duty Double Bolt Pipe Clamp Size Range: 6" thru 36"
Fig. 295H
Page 56
Page 57
8 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
General Table of Notes Contents Universal C-Type Clamp Standard Throat Size Range: 3/8" and 1/2"
Socket Clamps
Structural Attachments
SOCKET CLAMPS
Socket Clamp for Ductile Iron or Cast Iron Pipe & Socket Clamp Washer Size Range: 4" thru 24" pipe
Page 58
Socket Clamp for Ductile Iron or Cast Iron Pipe & Socket Clamp Washer Size Range: 3" thru 24" pipe
Page 59
BEAM CLAMPS
C-Clamp with Set Screw and Lock Nut Size Range: 3/8" thru 3/4"
Page 60
Page 61
Page 62
Page 62
Page 63
Universal C-Type Clamp Wide Throat Size Range: 3/8" and 1/2"
Page 68
Page 68
Page 69
Page 70
Page 71
Structural Welding Lug Size Range (55): 1/2" thru 33/4" Size Range (55L): 1/2" thru 2"
Page 72
Page 73
Page 74
Page 75
Page 76
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
Fig. 54
Fig. 66
Fig. 60
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
structural attachments
Fig. 133
Fig. 134
Fig. 218
Fig. 228
Brackets
Page 64
Wide Throat Top Beam C-Clamp Size Range: 5/8" and 3/4"
Page 66
Page 65
Page 67
Page 67
Structural Attachments
Fig. 93
Fig. 94
Fig. 227
Fig. 14
Fig. 217
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Fig. 86 & 88
Fig. 95
Fig. 89
Fig. 89X
Fig. 92
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
Fig. 202
Page 77
Fig. 206
Page 78
Threaded Steel Side Beam Bracket Size Range: 3/8" and 1/2"
Fig. 207
Page 78
Fig. 189
Page 79
Fig. 190
Page 80
Fig. 194
Page 81
Fig. 195
Page 82
Fig. 199
Page 83
Ceiling Plates
Fig. 127
Page 84
Fig. 395
Page 84
Fig. 128R
Page 85
Fig. 153
Page 86
Fig. 152
Page 87
Fig. 282
Page 88
Fig. 281
Page 89
Fig. 285
Page 90
Fig. 286
Page 91
Fig. 284
Page 92
Fig. 47
Page 93
Fig. 49
Page 94
Fig. 52
Page 95
10 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
Straps
Fig. 142
Page 96
Page 96
Page 97
Fig. 248
Page 97
Fig. 278
Page 98
Fig. 248X
Linked Eye Rods Size Range: 3 /8" thru 21/2"
U-BOlts
STRAPS
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
11
Rod Attachments
Page 107
Page 108
Page 108
Page 109
Page 109
Page 110
Page 110
Hanger Rods
Fig. 137C
Fig. 120
Fig. 262
Strap Short Size Range: 1 /2" thru 4"
Fig. 126
Fig. 243
Fig. 244
Brackets
Page 101
Page 102
Page 102
Page 103
Page 104
Page 104
Page 106
Page 105
Structural Attachments
Fig. 110R
Fig. 157
Fig. 290
Fig. 299
Fig. 230
Fig. 233
Fig. 291
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Page 98
Fig. 278X
Page 98
Fig. 148
Page 99
Straight Rod Coupling Straight Rod Coupling Turnbuckle Adjuster Size Range: Size Range: Size Range: 1 1 1 /4" thru 1" /4" thru 1" /4" thru 3/4"
Fig. 114
Page 101
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
Fig. 146
Machine Threaded Rods Threaded on Both Ends Size Range: 3/8" thru 5"
Fig. 62
Page 111
Fig. 63
Page 112
Fig. 192
Page 113
Adjustable Pipe Saddle with U-Bolt Size Range: 2" thru 12"
Fig. 191
Page 113
Fig. 258
Page 114
Fig. 264
Page 115
Adjustable Pipe Saddle Support with U-Bolt Size Range: 4" thru 36"
Fig. 265
Page 116
Pipe Saddle Support with U-Bolt Size Range: 4" thru 36"
Fig. 259
Page 117
TrapeZe
Fig. 46
Page 118
Channel Assembly
Fig. 45
Page 119
Fig. 50
Page 120
Insulation Protection Shield Size Range: 1/2" thru 24" pipe with up to 2" thick insulation
Fig. 167
Page 121
Rib-Lok Shield Size Range: 1/2" thru 8" pipe or copper tube with up to 2" thick insulation
Fig. 168
Page 122
12 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
General Table of Notes Contents Adjustable Steel Yoke Pipe Roll Size Range: 21/2" thru 24"
Pipe Rolls
Page 127
Page 128
Page 129
Page 130
Page 131
Page 132
Page 133
Page 134
Non-Conductive Roller
Page 135
Page 146
Page 147
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
13
Structural "H" Slide Assembly, Complete Size Range: 6" thru 36"
Fig. 432
Fig. 212
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
Pipe Alignment Guide Pipe Alignment Guide Size Range: 1" thru 24" pipe and insulation Size Range: 1" thru 24" pipe and insulation thickness of 1" thru 4" thickness of 1" thru 4"
Fig. 255
Fig. 256
Structural Tee Slide Assembly Size Range: All sizes within maximum load rating
Fabricated Tee Slide Assembly Size Range: All sizes within maximum load rating
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Fig. 76CP
Socket Clamps
Fig. 175
Pipe Roll and Base Plate Size Range: 2" thru 24"
Fig. 277
Fig. 271
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
Fig. 177
Fig. 171
Fig. 178
Fig. 181
Fig. 770
Fig. 776
Lateral/Longitudinal Brace Clamp Size Range: 21/2" thru 8" Service Pipe
Fig. 775
STRUCTURAL ATTACHMENTS
OPA-2804-10 OPA-2804-10
Bar Joist and Beam Attachment (WF) Size Range: Flange Thickness 1/8" thru 3/4"
Fig. 778
Adjustable Steel Beam Attachment Size Range: Flange Widths 4" thru 15"
Fig. 772
Fig. 779
Page 159
Restraints
Surge Restrainer Size Range: /4" thru 2" Swivel Ring Hanger
3
Fig. 773
Page 160
Swivel Joint Connector - Rod Tap Size Range: 3/8" Rod Diameter
Fig. 777
Page 161
Sway Brace Swivel Attachment Size Range: 1" and 11/4" Brace Pipe
Fig. 771
Go to www.anvilintl.com/OPA for State of California Ofce of Statewide Health Planning and Development (OSHPD) for design information relating to OSHPD projects. Seis Brace Seismic Fire Protection Design Tool may be accessed at www.seisbrace.com Notes:
1. For re protection installations - sway braces are intended to be installed in accordance with NFPA-13 and Anvil's installations instructions and local codes. 2. The required type, number and size of fasteners used for the structural attachment tting shall be in accordance with NFPA-13. 3. To assure proper performance, installer is responsible for: a. Structural integrity of attachment member to safely handle load requirements. b. Securely tightening the component on the brace pipe. 4. Anvil International brand bracing components are designed to be compatible ONLY with other Anvil International brand bracing components, resulting in a Listed seismic bracing assembly. 5. Updated UL listing information may be viewed at www.ul.com and FM approvals may be viewed at www.fmgobal.com
Disclaimer: Anvil International (Anvil) does not provide any warranties and specically disclaims any liability whatsoever with respect to Anvil bracing products
and components that are used in combination with products, parts or systems not manufactured or sold by Anvil. In no event shall Anvil be liable for any incidental, direct, consequential, special or indirect damages or lost prots where non-Anvil bracing components have been, or are used.
14 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
Spring Hangers
Snubbers
HORIZONTAL TRAVELER & SWAY BRACE
SPRING HANGERS
Horizontal Traveler Size Range: Available in four sizes to take loads to 20,700 (lbs.) All sizes provide for 12" of horizontal travel.
Fig. 170
Page 207
Fig. 82 & C-82 Fig. B-268 & C-268 Fig. 98 & C-98
Pages 164 - 165, 174 - 175
Short Spring
Pages 164 - 165, 178 -179 Pages 164 -165, 180 - 181
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
SNUBBERS
Fig. 312
Page 224
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
15
Hydraulic Shock and Sway Suppressor (Snubber) Size Range: Seven standard sizes with load ratings from 350 (lbs.) to 120,000 (lbs)
Hydraulic Shock and Sway Suppressor (Snubber) Size Range: Nine standard sizes with load ratings from 3000 (lbs.) to 128,000 (lbs)
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Sway Brace Size Range: Preloads from 50 (lbs.) to 1,800 (lbs.) and maximum forces from 200 (lbs.) to 7,200 (lbs.)
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
Standard Spring
Double Spring
GENERAL NOTES
S tandard Materials
Anvil catalog items are made from the following materials. Hanger Classication Material
Malleable Iron Ductile Iron Carbon Steel - Stamped Carbon Steel- Formed Forged Steel Carbon Steel - Rod Carbon Steel - Bolts Carbon Steel- Nuts Malleable Iron Carbon Steel - Pre Galv. Carbon Steel - Structural Shapes and Plate Plastic Malleable Iron Cast Iron Carbon Steel - Stamped Carbon Steel Carbon Steel Malleable Iron Carbon Steel - Stamped Carbon Steel - Formed and Fabricated Malleable Iron Carbon Steel Carbon Steel Carbon Steel Carbon Steel Carbon Steel Carbon Steel - Structural Shapes or Plates Malleable Iron Carbon Steel Cast Iron Cast Iron Carbon Steel Alloy Steel Carbon Steel Carbon Steel Carbon Steel Cast Iron Malleable Iron Carbon Steel Forged Steel Carbon Steel Carbon Steel Cast Iron Carbon Steel Refer to table note 1. Stainless Steel Stainless Steel Stainless Steel Stainless Steel Stainless Steel Carbon Steel Carbon Steel - Stamped Carbon Steel - Formed Chrome Molybdenum Steel Malleable Iron Carbon Steel - Formed Carbon Steel - Stamped Carbon Steel Carbon Steel Malleable / Ductile Carbon Steel - Structural Shapes Carbon Steel - HSS
Beam Clamps
Bolts, Nuts, Pins and U-Bolts Brackets Ceiling Plates and Flanges Clevis Hangers Clevis Hangers - Pipe or Conduit Clevis Hangers - Ductile Iron Pipe Concrete Inserts and Attachments Copper Tubing Hangers Copper Tubing Hangers - Pipe Ring CPVC Hangers Hanger Rods Pipe Alingment Guides Pipe Slides Pipe Rings Pipe Roll - (2) Rod, Yoke & Chair Pipe Roll - Stands Pipe Protection Saddles Pipe Shields Pipe Supports - Stanchions Pipe Supports - Saddles Rod Attachments Rod Attachments - Rod Couplings Socket Clamps Socket Clamps- Washers Stainless Steel Hangers and Supports Plate Pipe Rod and Pins Bolts Nuts Steel Pipe Clamps- Offset and Extended Steel Pipe Clamps Straps Structural Attachments - Washer Plates Structural Attachments Trapeze
Notes: 1. Most Anvil hanger gure numbers are available in stainless steel on special order, primarily in type 304 and type 316. Items are limited. 2. Custom fabricated products can be furnished - to specications provided by customer. 3. Standard material specications are subject to change without notice.
16 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
GENERAL NOTES
Copper Tubing General Table of Notes Contents Hangers
76
EG = Zinc Electro Plate ASTM B633 Hot Dip = ASTM A123 or A153 Pre-Galv. = ASTM A653 Most EG items and fasteners can be hot dip galvanized except as indicated. Hot Dipped galvanized all thread rod is available. Note 1 indicates that hot dip fasteners are not available.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
17
69
Rod Attachments
14 40 45 46 47 49 50 52 54 55 60 62 63 65 66 66 with BN 67
Adj. Side Beam Clamp Riser Clamp Standard Channel Assembly Universal Trapeze Assembly Concrete Single Lug Plate Concrete Clevis Plate Equal Leg Angle for Trapeze Assembly Concrete Rod Attachment Plate Two Hole Welding Beam Lug Structural Welding Lug Steel Washer Plate Pipe Stanchion Pipe Stanchion Light Duty Adj. Clevis Welded Beam Attachment Welded Beam Attachment Pipe or Conduit Hanger Adj. Swivel Ring, Tapped per NFPA Standards
EG Hot Dip with EG Fasteners Hot Dip Hot Dip Hot Dip Hot Dip with EG Fasteners Hot Dip Hot Dip Hot Dip Hot Dip Hot Dip Hot Dip Hot Dip EG Hot Dip Hot Dip with EG Fasteners EG Strap is Pre-Galv. Material, Nut is EG (See Note 1) Galvanizing not possible, Fabricated Roller for Large Dia. Pipe Paint Only
Fabricated Roller for Large Dia. Pipe C-Clamp with Set Screw & Lock Nut C-Clamp with Set Screw Retaining Clip Universal C-Type Clamp (Std. Throat) Universal C-Type Clamp (Wide Throat) Wide Throat Beam C-Clamp C-Clamp with Lock Nut Extended Pipe Clamp Offset Pipe Clamp Adj. Swivel Ring, Split Ring Type Light Weight U-Bolt One-Hole Clamp Rod Threaded Ceiling Flange Standard Duty Beam Clamp Heavy Duty Beam Clamp Rod Coupling Straight less Sight Hole Rod Coupling Reducing Rod Coupling Straight Rod Coupling Reducing
Galvanizing not possible, Paint Only EG EG EG EG EG EG EG Hot Dip with EG Fasteners Hot Dip with EG Fasteners EG EG EG EG Hot Dip with EG Fasteners Hot Dip with EG Fasteners EG EG EG EG
Hanger Rods
Brackets
Figure Number
Description
Description
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Hot-Dip Galvanized (ASTM 123 or ASTM 153) Recommended for prolonged outdoor exposure and will usually protect steel in most atmospheric environments. After fabrication, the part is immersed in a bath of molten zinc. A metallurgical bond is formed, resulting in a zinc coating that coats all surfaces including edges. Anvil's standard galvanizing practice for our Fig. 261 riser clamps and Fig. 212 medium pipe clamps is hot-dip galvanized.
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
GENERAL NOTES
Standard Galvanizing Practice
Figure Number
137 137S 138R 140 142 146 148 157 167 168 171 175 177 178 181 185 186 187 188 189 190 191 192 194 195 199 202 206 207 212 212FP 216 218
(cont.)
Description
Standard U-Bolt Special U-Bolt (non-standard) Ext. Split Pipe Clamp (Rod Threaded) Machine Threaded Rod (RH Threads) Coach Screw Rod Continuous Threaded Rod Rod with Eye End Extension Piece Insulated Protection Shield Rib-Lok Shield Single Pipe Roll Roller Chair Adj. Pipe Roll Support Spring Cushion Hanger Adj. Steel Yoke Pipe Roll One Hole Pipe Strap Two Hole Pipe Strap Two Hole 90 Side Mount Strap Two Hole Stand Off Strap Straight Eye Socket Off-Set Eye Socket Adj. Pipe Saddle with U-Bolt Adj. Pipe Saddle Light Welded Steel Bracket Medium Welded Steel Bracket Heavy Welded Steel Bracket Iron Side Beam Bracket Steel Side Beam Bracket Threaded Steel Side Beam Bracket Medium Pipe Clamp Earthquake Bracing Clamp Heavy Pipe Clamp Malleable Beam Clamp without Ext. Piece Universal Forged Steel Beam Clamp Turnbuckle Turnbuckle
Figure Number
260 ISS 261 262 264
Description
Clevis Hanger with Insulation Saddle Reference Fig. 260 System Ext. Pipe or Riser Clamp Hot Dip with EG Bolts & Nuts Strap Short EG EG (See Note 1) Adj. Pipe Saddle Support Nippl red. assembly cannot be hot dipped. EG (See Note 1) Adj. Pipe Saddle Support with U-Bolt Nippl red. assembly cannot be hot dipped. Pipe Roll Stand EG Adj. Pipe Roll Stand with Base Plate EG Pipe Roll Stand - Base Plate Only EG Adj. Pipe Roll Stand without Base Plate EG Pipe Roll and Base Plate EG Eye Rod Welded Wedge Type Concrete Insert Universal Concrete Insert Light Weight Concrete Insert Weldless Eye Nut Clevis Pin with Cotters Universal Forged Steel Beam Clamp Double Bolt Pipe Clamp Alloy Double Bolt Pipe Clamp Heavy Duty Double Bolt Pipe Clamp Forged Steel Clevis Adj. Clevis for Insulated Lines Cast Iron Ceiling Plate Special Clamp Fabricated Tee Slide Assembly Structural "H" Slide Assembly Adj. Clevis for Ductile or Cast Iron Pipe Socket Clamp Washer Socket Clamp for Ductile Iron or Cast Iron Pipe Socket Clamp Washer Socket Clamp for Ductile Iron or Cast Iron Pipe Q-Brace Clamp Sway Brace Swivel Attachment Adj. Steel Beam Attachment Surge Restrainer Lateral/Longitudinal Brace Clamp Brace Clamp Swivel Joint Connector Bar Joist and Beam Attachment Multi-Connector Adapter EG EG (See Note 1) EG (See Note 1) EG (See Note 1) EG EG EG Hot Dip with EG Bolts & Nuts Alloy Material, Galv. is not Recommended Hot Dip with EG Bolts & Nuts EG 8" & Smaller: EG 10" & Larger: Hot Dip with EG Bolts & Nuts EG Hot Dip with EG Bolts & Nuts Hot Dip, Weld after Galv. & Cold Spray Touch-up Hot Dip, Weld after Galv. & Cold Spray Touch-up Hot Dip with EG Bolts & Nuts EG Hot Dip with EG Bolts & Nuts EG Hot Dip with EG Bolts & Nuts EG (See Note 2) EG EG EG EG EG EG EG EG
265 271 274 274P 275 277 278, 278L, 278X 281 282 285 290, 290L 291 292, 292L 295 295A 295H 299 300 395 432 436 439 590 594 595 599 600 770 771 772 773 775 776 777 778 779
228 230 233 248, 248L, Eye Rod Not Welded 248X Machine Threaded Rod (Threaded Both 253 Ends) 255 Pipe Alignment Guide CT-255 256 257 258 259 260 Copper Tubing Alignment Guide Pipe Alignment Guide Structural Tee Slide Pipe Saddle Support Pipe Saddle Support with U-Bolt Adj. Clevis Hanger
EG = Zinc Electro Plate ASTM B633 Hot Dip = ASTM A123 or A153 Pre-Galv. = ASTM A653 Most EG items and fasteners can be hot dip galvanized except as indicated. Hot Dipped galvanized all thread rod is available. Note 1 indicates that hot dip fasteners are not available.
18 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
www.anvilintl.com
GENERAL NOTES
19
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
Fig. CT-69
Size Range: 12" through 4" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Copper plated Service: Recommended for suspension of non-insulated stationary copper tube. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 10) WW-H-171-E (Type 10), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 10). Features: Threads are countersunk so that they cannot become burred or damaged. Knurled swivel nut provides vertical adjustment after piping is in place. Captured swivel nut will not fall off. Ordering: Specify nominal tube size, gure number, name and nish. Note: Metric nut available upon request.
38"
38"
B F C
C B
C L G
1
C L
Max Load
Weight
0.10 0.10 0.10 0.10 0.10 0.11 0.25 0.27 0.48
B
3 21316 21116 212 21116 3 16
7
C
2316 2 11316 158 11316 2 2
1
F
178 1916 114
15
G Width
2 4 300
16
/8
525 650
31316 414 4 8
3
21516 338 3 2
1
/4
Note: Reects changes in rod diameter from previously published data per recent revisions in MSS-SP-58 & 69
20 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. CT-65
F B E C C L G
2 4
150
112 1 16
11
12732 2 32
3
1716 1 16
9
1116 1 4
1
16 16 2 8 16
/8
1 1 4
1 1
1 8
7
2 32
13 13 3
1 8
5 3
1 16
7
3 32
11
4 32
17
2 16
5
2 8
7
1 16
3
234 3 314
Note: 1) Reects changes in rod diameter from previously published data per recent revisions in MSS-SP-58 & 69. 2) 31/2" tube size alternate - 31/2" Fig. 65 galvanized.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
21
Rod Attachments
1 2
250
2 32
5
2 16 3 8
1 4 1 16
15
1 16
11 1
5 13
2 32
17
2 16
/4
Hanger Rods
Max Load
Weight
Rod Size A
Adjustment F
G Width Lower
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
Size Range: 12" through 4" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Copper plated Service: Recommended for suspension of non-insulated, stationary copper tube. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication WW-H-171-E (Type 12). Installation: (1) Adjustment may be made either before or after tubing is in place without temporary support of pipe. (2) Hanger rod and nuts may be locked into position after adjustment by use of the upper nut. Features: Provides for adjustment up to 1 78". Ordering: Specify nominal tube size, gure number, name and nish
Fig. CT-128R
Size Range: 38" and 12" Material: Malleable iron Finish: Copper plated Service: Recommended for attachment to wood beams or ceiling. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name.
316"
214"
12"
A 3516"
Max Load
180
Weight
0.16
138"
8 2
Fig. CT-138R
Size Range: 12" through 2" Material: Malleable iron Finish: Copper plated Service: Recommended for suspension of non-insulated stationary copper tube. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 12) WW-H-171-E (Type 25), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 12). Installation: Permanent installation of clamp may be made before the tubing is placed in position. Final installation is attained by swinging the lower portion of the hinged clamp up under the tubing and inserting a single screw securely. Features: Hinged design provides for economical installation. Designed to provide a tight t on copper tubing. Ordering: Specify nominal tube size, gure number, name.
38"
Fig. CT-138R:
LOads (lbs) Weight (lbs) DimensiOns (in)
B C L
Weight
0.10 0.12 0.14 0.18 0.22 0.36
A
2 214 212 278 314 4
B
4 8 1 118 114 1916
3 7
180
34"
22 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 69F
F C
F B C
Pipe Size
2 3 4 1 114 112 2 212 3 4 5
1
C L
G
1 /2" & 3/4" tube /2" through 1" Felted Ring
Max Load
Rod Size A
B
234 258 2716 212 258 318 378 334 458 514 61116
C
178 11116 1916 158 134 214 258 278 334 4516 5916
F
138 118 11316 13 16 3 4 1 11316 1916 158 238
G Width
Weight
0.10 0.10 0.10 0.10 0.10 0.10 0.20 0.20 0.30 0.54 0.65
650 1,000
1
/4
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
23
525
Rod Attachments
/8
Hanger Rods
Brackets
C L
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Size Range: 12" through 6" copper tube Material: Carbon steel and felt with adhesive backing Finish: Galvanized Service: Recommended for suspension of non-insulated stationary copper tubing. Maximum Temperature: 120 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 10) WW-H-171-E (Type 10), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 10). Features: The layer of felt separates the copper tubing from the steel ring for electrolytic resistance and also minimizes noise and vibration. Threads are countersunk so they cannot become burred or damaged. Knurled swivel nut provides vertical adjustment after tubing is in place. The captured nut is permanent in the bottom portion of band, allowing the hanger to be opened during installation if desired, but not allowing the nut to fall out. Ordering: Specify felt ring size, gure number and name.
Pipe Rings
Fig. 67F
Size Range: 12" through 6" copper tube Material: Carbon steel and felt with adhesive backing Finish: Galvanized Service: Can be suspended by hanger rod or attached to wall. T slot in hanger permits side bolt to be installed after installation and setting of pipe. Maximum Temperature: 120F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 5), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 5). Features: The layer of felt separates the copper tubing from the steel strap for electrolytic resistance and also minimizes noise and vibration. Components: Strap and bolt with nut assembled. Ordering: Specify felt hanger size, gure number and name.
D B G C C L
Pipe Size
C L
Load Rating
Rod Size A
B
212 21116
D
158 11116
F
1516 112
G
134 11516 218 2 16
9
H Width
Weight
0.22 0.25
2 4
1 114 1 4
1 1
1 1 4
1 1
400
21316 3 8
1
11316 1 8
7
16
158 2 2 16
5 7 1
1 2 2 2 2
1
1 2 2 2 2
1
3 16
7 9 5
2 16
1
2 4
3
3 16 500
1
2 2 16
5
2 16 3 16 3 2
1 9
2 16
15 1
3 4 5 6
3 4 5 6
4 16 4 4
3
3 2 4 16
1
2 2
1 3
550 600
8 4
16
11/4
24 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. CT-121
Size Range: 12" through 4" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Copper plated Service: Recommended for support and steadying of copper tube risers, either insulated or non-insulated. This product is not intended for use with hanger rods. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 8), WW-H-171-E (Type 8), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 8). Service: For support and steadying of copper tubing risers. Installation: Clamp is tted and bolted preferably below a coupling or tting on the tubing. Do not over tighten bolts. Features: Rounded ears provide greater safety for personnel. Ordering: Specify tube size, gure number, name.
C L
G B L
Tube Size
2 4 1 114 112 2 212 3 312 4
1 3
Max Load
75 120 150
Weight
0.52 0.56 0.94 0.98 1.50 1.50 1.70 1.80 1.90 2.60
L
612 7 938 958 10 1038 111316 1112 12 13
G Width
1
Bolt Size
5
Torque Values
11
114
21
300
46
Note: Minimum loads per MSS SP only applicable to 11/4" and up.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
25
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
16
Fig. CT-121: LOads (lbs) Weight (lbs) DimensiOns (in) TOrQue (Ft-LBS)
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
Fig. CT-255
Size Range: 1" through 4" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized housing with copper plated nish on spider clamp. Service: For maintaining alignment of tubing through its axial expansion and contraction cycles. Normally, two or more pipe alignment guides are used on a single tubing run to avoid a pivoting effect within the tubing system. Consult the Expansion Joint Manufacturers Association or the Copper Tube Manufacturers for additional guidelines of spacing requirements of intermediate guides. Supports are usually required between intermediate guides to comply with standard support practices. Maximum Temperature: 400 F Installation: (1) Attach outer housing to structure by bolting or welding. (2) Remove upper section of housing to open position. (3) Attach spider clamp to tube and completely insulate. (4) Set tube and spider clamp into outer housing. (5) Replace upper section of housing to closed position and secure. Note: Spider attachments to tube must be properly located during installation to insure that a minimum of one-half the spider width remains within the length of the outer housing for all conditions of operation. If larger travels are required, special guides can be furnished to special order. How to size: Size by nominal tube size and insulation thickness in accordance with the selection table. Ordering: Specify size number, tube size, insulation thickness, gure number, name and nish. Tube Size (in) Caution: The primary function of the Figure CT-255 is to maintain axial 1" to 4" alignment of a system. Other components should be incorporated into the system to carry the primary loading of the system. Guides are designed such that minor loading amounts may be transferred to the guide in any given direction, up to 20% of dead weight load for typical maximum spans of a given pipe diameter.
L (in)
4
Maximum Movement
4
26 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
C L
C L
C D T Tube
H DIA 4 HOLES
E J INSULATION THICKNESS
2 4
A B C D
8 16
13
6 4
3
8 10 12 16
7
4 8
5
5 4
3
13 16
5
11 4
1
6 8
5
7 4
3
1 2
1
2
A A A A A B B B B B
212
A A A C C B B B D D
3
C C C C C D D D
4
C C C C C D D D
A A A A B B B B B
A A A A B B B B B
1 1 4
1
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
27
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
1578
1338
141316
71516
934
Socket Clamps
101316
834
538
Dimensions (in) A B C D E H T
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
Stainless Steel Copper Tubing General Table of Hangers Hangers Notes Contents
Fig. CT-255
Fig. 137SS
Size Range: 12" through 12" Material: Stainless steel U-bolt and four nished hex nuts Finish: 304 stainless steel Service: Recommended for support, or guide of heavy loads; often employed in power, process plant and marine service. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 24), WW-H-171-E (Type 24), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 24). Ordering: Specify pipe size x rod size (e.g., 6 x 58), gure number and name. If hex nuts are not required, specify without hex nuts.
C B A
F E D
C L
Wt.
0.11 0.12 0.12 0.28 0.30 0.33 0.73 0.78 0.90 1.0 2.0 2.3 4.9 7.7
B
16 1 8 138 11116 2 7 2 16 21516 3916 4916 558 634 834 1078 1278
15 1
C
1316 138 158 2116 238 21316 3716 4116 5116 618 738 938 1158 1334
F
2516 2732 2332 2132 2116 2516
500
454
120
110
2 4
3
218
1,240
1,144
310
280
2,300
2,070
570
515
8 4 8
3 7
212
*When the combination of a normal load and a side load occurs, a straight line interaction formula may be used to determine if the Fig. 137 is still within the allowable stress range: Pn/Pna + Ps/Psa 1 Where: Pn = actual applied normal load; Pna = allowable normal load for the Fig. 137; Ps = actual applied side load; Psa = allowable side load for the Fig. 137 Nuts must be snug tight in installation to achieve side loads shown.
214 2732
334 4
21316 3 314
28 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 260SS
E C L H
2 8 4 8
G E
F B C C L
Span represents the maximum recommended distance between hangers on a continuous and straight run of horizontal standard weight steel pipe lled with water. In all cases, verify that chosen location of hangers does not subject hangers to a load greater than the maximum recommended load shown above. *Indicates that span represents the maximum span for water lled pipe as given in Table 1 of page 249.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
29
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
Brackets
520
470
0.34 0.34 0.35 0.40 0.45 0.50 0.65 0.85 1.51 1.70 3.10 4.75 8.60 11.20
2316 2 2516 238 21316 3516 4116 434 5916 6916 61516 838 978 11916
21116 3 314 31316 412 512 612 71316 81516 1014 121116 1514 171516
112 1516 158 11116 218 258 3316 4116 412 512 534 7316 8716 1018
8
1
Structural Attachments
H Width Lower
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Size Range: 12" through 12" Material: 304 stainless steel Service: Recommended for the suspension of stationary pipe lines. Maximum Temperature: 650 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 1), WW-H-171-E (Type 1), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 1). Installation: Hanger load nut above clevis must be tightened securely to assure proper hanger performance. Adjustment: Vertical adjustment without removing pipe may be made from 38" through 5 18", varying with the size of clevis. Tighten upper nut after adjustment. Features: Design has yoke on outside of lower U-strap so yoke cannot slide toward center of bolt, thus bending of bolt is minimized. Sizes 5" and up have rod and two nuts instead of bolt and nut; thread length on clevis rod is such that the thread locks the nuts in place, and threads are not in shear plane. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number and name. Notes: Punched forming holes may be present on certain sizes of this clevis hanger. These holes are solely for the purpose of manufacturing, and do not effect the structural integrity or load carrying capacities of these hangers. For insulated line options without shields, see Figures 260 ISS and Figure 300. For ductile iron pipe sizes, see Figure 590SS. Caution: When an oversize clevis is used, a pipe spacer or multispacer should be placed over clevis bolt to ensure that the lower U-strap will not move in on the bolt.
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
Fig. 261SS
Size Range: 12" through 12" Material: 304 stainless steel Service: For support of stationary steel pipe risers or conduit. Maximum Temperature: 650 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 8) WW-H-171-E (Type 8), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 8). Installation: Clamp is tted and bolted below a coupling, hub or welded lugs on steel pipe (2 lugs up to 3" pipe, 4 lugs up to 12" pipe). Bolt torques should be per industry standards (see page 257). Clamp is designed for standard steel pipe O.D. and this must be considered in sizing the riser for other types of piping. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish.
C C L
G B L
Fig. 261SS: LOads (lbs) Weight (lbs) DimensiOns (in) TORQUE (FT-LBS)
Pipe Size
1
Lugs
Weight
1.1 1.1 1.6 1.6 1.7 1.9 1.9 2.4 3.6 4.0 7.6 11.1 16.5
L
878 10 1014 1114 1138 1278 1334 1434 1812 2014 2234
G Width
B
278 318 312 378 414 434 512 7 8 9 12 1334 1534
Bolt Diameter
3
Torque Values
21
16
32
46
112 2
100
30 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 590SS
E C L
8 4 8
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
31
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
Weight
G Width Lower
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
B C
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
Size Range: 4" through 12" ductile or cast iron pipe Material: 304 stainless steel Service: Recommended for the suspension of stationary ductile iron or cast iron pipe. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 1) WW-H-171-E (Type 1), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 1). Installation: Hanger rod nut above clevis must be tightened securely to assure proper hanger performance. Adjustment: Vertical adjustment without removing pipe may be made from 1 1516" through 3 316", varying with the size of the clevis. Tighten upper nut after adjustment. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number and name. Note: Figure 590 typically feature a Figure 260SS Top Component.
Fig. 185
Size Range: 34" through 2" Finish: Galvanized steel Service: Hanger for CPVC pipe in the horizontal position on the side of structural wood beams and Steel 20 Ga. (min) with hanger tab in the upward position only (Fig. A). It can also be used as a guide to limit movement of vertical CPVC pipe with the tab in the horizontal position. Approvals: UL and ULC Listed. Installation: Place hanger over pipe. Secure hanger to mounting surface with screws provided. Steel applications require one (1) #14 x 1" hex washer head self-drilling TEK screw. Not Supplied. Part Number STD-0090. Features: Beveled edge design helps protect the CPVC pipe from any rough surface. Easily attaches to wood structure with #10 x 1" hex washer head self threading screw supplied with product. No pre-drilling required. Ordering: Specify CPVC pipe size, gure number and description.
A
1716 134 11116 178 2
B
212 278 3 3716 3 8
7
C
1 1
E
118 118 118 118 1 8
1
F
114 112 178 218 2 8
5
4 4 4 4 4
1 114 112 2
1 1 1
32 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 186
Size Range: 34" through 2" Finish: Galvanized steel Service: Hanger for CPVC pipe in the horizontal position on the bottom and side of structural wood beams, composite beams and Steel 20 Ga. (min.) (Fig. A, C respectively). Can be used as a restrainer when installed on top of structural wood beams (Fig. B), for limiting pipe movement due to thrust loads during sprinkler system start-up. It can also be used as a guide to limit movement for pipe in the vertical position. When used on composite wood beams, web thickness must be 3/8" or greater. Approvals: UL and ULC Listed. Installation: Snap hanger over pipe. Secure hanger to mounting surface with screws provided. Do not make adjustments to hanger mounting anges that result in clamping the pipe to the mounting surface. Pipe must be allowed to move freely through hanger. Steel applications require two (2) #14 x 1" hex washer head self-drilling TEK screws. Not Supplied. Part Number STD-0090. Features: Beveled edge design helps protect the CPVC pipe from any rough surface. Easily attaches to wood structure with #10 x 1" hex washer head self threading screw supplied with product. No pre-drilling required. Ordering: Specify CPVC pipe size, gure number and description.
Fig. A
Fig. C
1 1 4
1
21316 3 4
1
1 1 1 1 1
4 4 4 4 4
118 1 8
1
118 1 2
1
512 6 612 7 8
5 6 7 8 9
114 112 2
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
33
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Fig. 187
Size Range: 34" through 2" Finish: Galvanized steel Service: Hanger for CPVC pipe in the horizontal position on the bottom of structural wood beams and Steel 20 Ga. (min.) (Fig. A). Can be used as a restrainer, only in Steel 20 Ga. (min) (Fig. B). During installation, adjust hanger mounting anges such that pipe contacts both mounting surface and hanger, minimizing vertical pipe movement. Approvals: UL and ULC Listed. Installation: Snap hanger over pipe. Secure hanger to mounting surface with screws provided. Do not anchor tightly to mounting surface. Pipe must be allowed to move freely through hanger. Steel applications require two (2) #14 x 1" hex washer head self-drilling TEK screws. Not Supplied. Part Number STD-0090. Features: Beveled edge design helps protect the CPVC pipe from any rough surface. Easily attaches to wood structure with #10 x 1" hex washer head self threading screw supplied with product. No pre-drilling required. Ordering: Specify CPVC pipe size, gure number and description.
Fig. B
A
1 1 8
1
B
112 1 2
1
C
1 1 1 1
E
118 1 8
1
F
234 2 16
13
4 4 4 4 4
1 114 112 2
134 178 2
34 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 188
Size Range: 34" through 2" Finish: Galvanized steel Service: Support for CPVC pipe off the face of structural wood beams (Fig. A) eliminates the use of back-up blocks. It can also be used as a hanger for CPVC pipe in the horizontal position on the bottom of structural wood beams and Steel 20 Ga. (min.) (Fig. B). Approvals: UL and ULC Listed. Installation: Snap hanger over pipe. Position hanger back around pipe but allow for pipe movement. Secure hanger to mounting surface with screws provided. Recheck to insure that the pipe is allowed to move freely through hanger. Steel applications require two (2) #14 x 1" hex washer head self-drilling TEK screws. Not Supplied. Part Number STD-0090. Features: Beveled edge design helps protect the CPVC pipe from any rough surface. Easily attaches to wood structure with #10 x 1" hex washer head self threading screw supplied with product. No pre-drilling required. Eliminates wooden spacer blocks. Ordering: Specify CPVC pipe size, gure number and description.
Fig. B
1516 1 8
3
314 3 8
3
1 1 1 1 1
4 4 4 4 4
118 1 8
1
234 3 3516 3 16
9
512 6 612 7 8
5 6 7 8 9
1 114 1 2
1
1 8
7
4 8
3 1
1 8
1 1
4 2
1 8
4 8
1
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
35
112
31116
118
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
pIpE RINgS
Fig. 108
Size Range: 38" through 8" Material: Malleable iron Finish: Plain Service: Recommended for suspension of non-insulated stationary pipe lines or conduit. May be used with rod socket Fig. 110R or turnbuckle adjuster Fig. 114. Maximum Temperature: 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 11) WW-H-171-E (Type 11), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 11). Features: Permits installation before or after pipe is in place. Provides economical installation. Permits use of universally adaptable parts. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name.
Pipe Size
3
Max Load
200
Weight
0.06 0.09 0.11 0.13
C
3
Bolt Size
#10 x 78
C L
8 2 4
4 16
1 3
15
118 114 1916 11116 2116 214 234 318 358 412 5716 63/8
1
1 114 1 2
1
4 x 1
300
2 2 2
1
4 x 114
3 3 2
1
450
4 5 6 8
8 x 2 2 x 2
36 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
pIpE RINgS
Extension Split Pipe Clamp
General Table of Notes Contents
B C L
Pipe Size
3
Max Load
Weight
0.10 0.13 0.14
Rod Size A
B
13
8 2 4 180
16 8
Hanger Rods
1 3
1
3
1 114 112 2 2 2
1
300
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
37
Rod Attachments
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
pIpE RINgS
Fig. 104
Size Range: 34" through 8" Material: Malleable iron, carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for suspension of non-insulated stationary pipe lines. Maximum Temperature: 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 6) WW-H-171-E (Type 6), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 16). Features: Labor-saving features in installation completely outweigh slight additional cost. Hanger may be installed prior to suspension of pipe. Off-center hinge provides seating for pipe during installation. Wedge-type locking pin is inseparably cast into hinged section, sizes 2 12" and larger. Adjustable swivel ring is self-locking; prevents loosening due to vibration; maintains proper pitch of pipe. Wire retaining ring prevents separation of swivel shank from pipe ring before installation. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish.
Pipe Size
3
Max Load
Weight
0.31 0.32
Rod Size A
B
278
C
238 2 4
1
D
3716 3 16
9
E
11516 1 4
3
4 300
1 114 1 2
1
3 3 8
1 1
2316 2 16
5
378 4 8
1
11116 1 16
13
C L
3 2
1
4 16
11
2 8 4
31516 4 8
3
212 2 8
5
538 6 8
1
178 2 278 3 2
1 7
5 3 7
51316 7 8
5 1
3916 4 16
5
8116 10 16
15 1
9 8
4 8
7
13 2
3 8
38 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
pIpE RINgS
Adjustable Swivel Ring, Tapped Per NFPA Standards
General Table of Notes Contents
Fig. 69
Size Range: 12" through 8" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Galvanized Service: Recommended for suspension of non-insulated stationary pipe line. Maximum Temperature: 650 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 10) WW-H-171-E (Type 10), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 10). UL Listed and FM Approved (Sizes 34" - 8"). Features: Threads are countersunk so that they cannot become burred or damaged. Knurled swivel nut provides vertical adjustment after piping is in place. Captured swivel nut in the 12" through 6" sizes. The capture is permanent in the bottom portion of the band, allowing the hanger to be opened during installation if desired, but not allowing the nut to fall completely out. Ordering: Specify size, gure number and name. Note: The acceptability of galvanized coatings at temperatures above 450F is at the discretion of the end user. Metric nut available upon request. Non-captured nut also available upon request.
A
B F C
C L G
1
Pipe Size
2 4 1 114 112 2 212 3 4 5 6 8
1 3
Max Load
Weight
0.10 0.10 0.10 0.10 0.10 0.11 0.20 0.20 0.30 0.54 0.65 1.00
Rod Size A
B
278 234 2916 258 234 314 4 31316 41116 5516 61116 8
C
2 178 11116 134 178 238 234 21516 31316 438 5916 7
F
1916 1516 1
7
G Width
300
/8
/4
Note: Reects changes in rod diameter from previously published data per recent revisions in MSS-SP-58 & 69
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
39
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
Brackets
C L
Structural Attachments
C B
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
CLEvIS HANgERS
Fig. 67
Size Range: 12" through 6" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Galvanized Service: Can be suspended by hanger rod or attached to wall. T slot in hanger permits side bolt to be installed after installation and setting of pipe. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 5), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 5). Components: Strap and bolt with nut assembled. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number and name.
D B G
F
C C L C L
Load Rating
Weight
0.21 0.22
Rod Size A
B
258 278
D
134 178
F
112 11116
G
11516 218 2516 258 278 3116 358 4116 5316 534 658
H Width
2 4 400
16
500
550 600
8 4
16
11/4
40 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
CLEvIS HANgERS
Light Duty Adjustable Clevis
General Table of Notes Contents
Fig. 65
Size Range: 12" through 4" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for suspension of stationary pipe or conduit. Maximum Temperature: Plain 650 F, Galvanized and Epoxy 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication WW-H-171-E (Type 12). Installation: Hanger load nut above the clevis must be tightened securely to assure proper hanger performance. Adjustment: Vertical adjustment is provided, varying with the size of clevis. Tighten upper nut after adjustment. Features: An economical attachment for light duty service. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish. Metric nut available upon request. Caution: When an oversize clevis is used, a pipe spacer or multispacer should be placed over clevis bolt to ensure that the lower U-strap will not move in on the bolt.
A
F B E C C L G
2 4
150
2332 21332 21316 338 31316 41732 5932 6732 63132 72532
114 1716 11116 2116 238 278 314 378 438 41516
16 2 8 16 16
/8
250
13
/4
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
41
350
0.59
Rod Attachments
21316
15
Hanger Rods
Max Load
Weight
Rod Size A
Adjustment F
G Width Lower
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
CLEvIS HANgERS
Fig. 260
Size Range: 12" through 30" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain, Galvanized, or Primed, also available in Plastic or Epoxy Coated Service: Recommended for the suspension of stationary pipe lines. Maximum Temperature: Plain 650 F, Galvanized and Epoxy 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 1), WW-H-171-E (Type 1), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 1). UL (Sizes 3/4" through 8"), ULC Listed (Sizes 3/4" through 4") and FM Approved (Sizes 34" through 8"). Installation: Hanger load nut above clevis must be tightened securely to assure proper hanger performance. Adjustment: Vertical adjustment without removing pipe may be made from 38" through 5 18", varying with the size of clevis. Tighten upper nut after adjustment. Features: Design has yoke on outside of lower U-strap so yoke cannot slide toward center of bolt, thus bending of bolt is minimized. Sizes 5" and up have rod and two nuts instead of bolt and nut; thread length on clevis rod is such that the thread locks the nuts in place, and threads are not in shear plane. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish. Notes: Punched forming holes may be present on certain sizes of this clevis hanger. These holes are solely for the purpose of manufacturing, and do not effect the structural integrity or load carrying capacities of these hangers. For insulated line options without shields, see Figures 260 ISS and Figure 300. For insulated line options with shields, see Figures 167 and 168. For ductile iron pipe sizes, see Figure 590. Caution: When an oversize clevis is used, a pipe spacer or multispacer should be placed over clevis bolt to ensure that the lower U-strap will not move in on the bolt.
A
B
2316 2 2516 238 21316 3516 4116 434 5116 5916 6916 61516 838 978 11916 12916 14 151516 17916 191316 24316
C
21116 3 314 31316 412 512 612 7116 71316 81516 1014 121116 1514 171516 19916 22 241516 27916 311316 39316
H Width Lower
G E C L H
F B C
G E
F B C C L
8
1
4 1
1,350 1,430 1,940 2,000 3,600 3,800 4,200 4,600 4,800 4,800 4,800 6,000
2 8 4 8
8 118 1516 158 11316 11116 11516 11116 2 218 21316 21116 234 31316
7
8 11/4 8 2 8 4
5 3
1 114 7 8* 114
1 4
1
378 518
Span represents the maximum recommended distance between hangers on a continuous and straight run of horizontal standard weight steel pipe lled with water. In all cases, verify that chosen location of hangers does not subject hangers to a load greater than the maximum recommended load shown above. *Indicates that span represents the maximum span for water lled pipe as given in Table 1 of page 249. * The 24" pipe size assembly includes a 11/4" SCH 40 pipe spacer over the 7/8" threaded rod. ** 30" pipe size: When assembled, the U-strap sits outside of the yoke.
42 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
CLEvIS HANgERS
Clevis Hanger with Insulation Saddle System
General Table of Notes Contents
4 5 6 8 10 12
6 8 10 12 14 16
6 8 10 12 14 16
8 8 10 12 14 16
8 10 10 12 14 16
C
41/2 61/2 713/16 815/16 101/4 1211/16 151/4 1715/16 199/16 22
G
1
X
23/8 35/8 41/2 511/16 611/16 813/16 103/4 127/16 147/16 165/16
/8 /2 /8 /4 /8
* Max load exceeds dead weight load requirement of pipe at max span, except 14 and 16 where max load is based on industry standard spacing of 14. Further information on typical pipe spans and piping weight per length can be found on pages 249 and 251, respectively. ** Based on maximum insulation thickness, variations due to pipe size and insulation thickness may occur.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
43
/4 /8 /2 /8
5 3
/4 1
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
Adjust. F
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Size Range: 1/2" through 12" pipe and accommodates up to 2" of insulation. Material: Carbon steel with high impact glass reinforced polypropylene saddle and carbon steel pipe spacer. Finish: Plain or Galvanized Clevis Hanger Service: Recommended for the suspension of stationary insulated chilled or hot water pipe lines. Maximum Temperature: 40 F to 200 F Approvals: Dual Fire Ratings, UL E94 VO and ASTM E84 Class 1 25/60. Installation: Hanger load nut above clevis must be tightened securely to assure proper performance. Position the pipe on the saddle. Notch insulation to t around the saddle. Square cut adjoining insulation and butt the insulation ends to each other. Insulation joint is coated, caulked and taped following standard insulation practice used on anges and valves. Adjustment: Vertical adjustment without removing the hanger may be made 7/8" through 23/8" varying with the size of the clevis. Tighten all nuts after adjustment. Features: V-Block design cradles pipe Fig. 260 ISS SiZing Table through out the entire erection process. Clevis bolt spacer included as standard Insulation Thickness Pipe keeps the clevis lower strap from collapsing. 1 3 Size /2" /4" 1" 11/2" Eliminates: (Size Number) Wood blocks and standard shields 1 /2 2 2 3 Costly calcium silicate inserts 3 /4 2 3 3 Re-leveling of piping at each 1 2 3 3 individual hanger after insulation 3 4 4 11/2 is completed. 2 4 4 5 Ordering: Specify size number, pipe size, 21/2 5 5 5 6 insulation thickness, gure number name 3 5 5 5 6 and nish. 31/2 5 6 6 8
Insulation Thickness
1
/2"
/4"
1"
3 3 3 3 3 3 4 4 5 5 6 8 8 10 12
11/2"
6 6 8 8 8 10 12
2"
8 8 8 10 10 12
(Size Number)
2 2 2 2 2 3 3 4 4 5 5 6 8 8 10
2 2 2 2 3 3 3 4 5 5 5 6 8 10 10
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
CLEvIS HANgERS
Application: Anvil's insulation saddle system clevises are fully tested and rated for a temperature range from 40F to 200F. Ideal for the suspension of stationary insulated chilled or hot water pipelines. Chilled Water Testing: Extensive eld-testing and inspection has been performed to conrm that the integrity of the insulation vapor barrier for chilled water systems are sustained with the 260 ISS. To Assure Proper Vapor Barrier: Each insulation joint should be properly coated, caulked and taped. Applying standard insulation practice that is used on anges and valves. Features: The Anvil 260 (ISS) Insulation Saddle System reduces your overall installation time and greatly simplies the way you insulate copper and steel pipe systems. Contractors can support insulated pipe with less parts and labor. The revolutionary design of the 260 ISS spreads the load evenly over the lower strap of the clevis. The innovative V-Block design cradles the pipe at the design elevation throughout the erection process. The wide base V-Block design accommodates multiple pipe sizes, reducing the on-site inventory and the exibility of pipe and insulation combinations with each size number. ASTM & UL Fire Ratings: The 260 ISS has been independently tested by ASTM and UL for: Flame Spread Index (FSI) Smoke Development (SD) and drip ratings Approvals from both agencies with the highest ratings for the type of product. Low Thermal Conductivity: V-Block low thermal conductivity of .77 BTU-In./Sq.FT-HrF Insulation R-Values: The Figure 260 ISS polymer V-Block component has an R-value ranging from 5.0 to 8.7, depending on the hanger size. Meets or exceeds most commercial insulation R-values.
44 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
CLEvIS HANgERS
Clevis Hanger with Insulation Saddle System (cont.)
General Table of Notes Contents
STEP 2
Notch
Cope or notch insulation to t around saddle. The notch should be deep enough to extend 1/8" to 1/4" beyond the saddle.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
45
Systems (Below 50F) apply sealant as per 50 Degrees with additional sealant to: The V-Block saddle joint between the two saddle halves.
Additional sealant applied to V-Block saddle joint between the two saddle halves. (Chilled water below 50F)
Rod Attachments
Systems (50F or greater) apply sealant to: The coped and at edges of the mating insulation sections. The V-Block saddle at the insulation interface.
Hanger Rods
For chilled systems a mastic for thermal insulations or similar sealant is typically used:
Square cut adjoining insulation and butt the insulation ends to each other.
Caulk joints and nish taping. To assure proper vapor barrier: Each insulation joint should be properly coated, caulked and taped. Applying standard insulation practice that is used on anges and valves. Finish via standard taping method.
Brackets
Square Cut
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
STEP 3
STEP 4
Easy Installation Make sure the double hex nuts installed with the upper hanger load nut above the clevis are tightened securely. Position pipe on saddle.
CLEvIS HANgERS
Fig. 300
Size Range: 34" through 12" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain, Galvanized or Epoxy coated Service: Recommended for suspension of insulated stationary pipe lines. Maximum Temperature: Plain 650 F, Galvanized and Epoxy 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 1) WW-H-171-E (Type 1), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 1). Installation: Hanger load nut above clevis must be tightened securely to assure proper hanger performance. Adjustment: Vertical adjustment is provided, varying with the size of the clevis. Tighten upper nut after adjustment. Features: Designed for 2" of insulation on 34" through 1 12" pipe and 4" of insulation on 2" and larger pipe. When properly installed, clevis bolt is outside the insulation. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish.
A
B C
C L I
Max Load
Weight
0.51 0.58 0.64 0.72 0.85 1.90 2.00 2.50 3.00 3.40 6.70 11.0 13.8
Rod Size A
B
358 4 4716 434 7716 8716 858 938 978 1058 1238 1334 1518
C
414 41116 514 534 81116 91516 10516 1158 1258 14 1634 19316 21916
E
278 314 358 4116 612 712 7916 8316 834 938 11 1214 1358
Adjustment F
2 8 7 8 1116 158 2 134 11516 134 178 2 218 2716
1 5
I Width Lower
730
2 1
2 8
1 5 3
2 8
46 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
CLEvIS HANgERS
Adjustable Clevis for Ductile or Cast Iron Pipe
General Table of Notes Contents
Fig. 590
E C L
1,350 1,430 1,940 2,000 3,600 3,800 4,200 4,600 4,800 4,800 4,800
1.10 1.64 4.26 6.70 9.73 13.64 16.04 24.52 27.45 46.24 57.10
3.96 4.80 6.90 9.05 11.10 13.20 15.30 17.40 19.50 21.60 25.80
1 5
2 8 4 8
114
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
47
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
Max Load
Weight
Rod Size A
G Width Lower
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
B C
Socket Clamps
Size Range: 3" through 24" ductile or cast iron pipe Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for the suspension of stationary ductile iron or cast iron pipe. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 1) WW-H-171-E (Type 1), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 1). Installation: Hanger rod nut above clevis must be tightened securely to assure proper hanger performance. Adjustment: Vertical adjustment without removing pipe may be made from 1 1516" through 3 316", varying with the size of the clevis. Tighten upper nut after adjustment. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish. Note: Figure 590 sizes 12" and below typically feature a Figure 260 Top Component.
Fig. 261
Size Range: 34" through 24" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain, Galvanized or Epoxy coated Service: For support of stationary steel pipe risers, cast iron pipe or conduit. This product is not intended for use with hanger rods. For this application refer to Fig. 40 Riser Clamp, page 49. Maximum Temperature: Plain 650 F, Galvanized and Epoxy 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 8) WW-H-171-E (Type 8), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 8). Note: Refer to Technical Data Section for cast iron soil pipe data. UL, ULC Listed (Sizes 1 12" - 8"). Installation: Clamp is tted and bolted preferably below a coupling, hub or welded lugs on steel pipe. Bolt torques should be per industry standards (see page 257). Clamp is designed for standard steel pipe O.D. and this must be considered in sizing the riser for other types of piping. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish.
C C L
G B L
FiG. 261: LoaDs (lBs) WEiGHt (lBs) DimENsioNs (iN) TORQUE (FT-LBS)
Pipe Size
4 1 114 112 2 212 3 312 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24
3
Max Load
220 250 300 400 500 600 750 1,500 1,600 2,500 2,700 2,900 3,200
Weight
1.1 1.1 1.6 1.6 1.7 1.9 1.9 2.3 2.4 3.6 4.0 7.6 11.1 16.5 17.7 30.4 33.8 35.0 82.0
L
878 10 1014 1114 1138 1278 1334 1434 1812 2014 2234 24 26 28 30 3634
G Width
B
278 318 312 378 414 434 512 612 7 8 9 12 1334 1534 1714 1934 2134 2334 30
Bolt Diameter
3
Torque Values
21
16
32
46
112
100
212 3
4 8
150 190
48 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 40
Size Range: 2" through 24" Material: Carbon steel (CS), Alloy (A), or Stainless Steel (SS) Finish: Plain or Galvanized Maximum Temperature: Galvanized 450 F, 650 F (CS), 950 F (A) and 1,000 F (SS) Service: Riser clamps are used for the support of vertical piping. Load is carried by shear lugs which are welded to the pipe. Shear lugs provided upon request. Local pipe wall stress evaluation available upon request. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 42), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 42). Ordering: Specify pipe size, material, gure number, name and nish. Note: If different loads or dimensions are required, refer to Fig. 40 SD special design riser clamp.
BOLT/STUD DIA. F C L
PIPE SPACER A G (max) B E E Sizes 16" to 20" have (4) inner bolts.
Fig. 290
Fig. 40
C to C
Pipe Size
2 212 3 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24
C-C
18 20 22 24 27 30 32 34 36 39 42 45
E
9 10 11 12 1312 15 16 17 18 1912 21 2212
F (max)
1 5 3
G (max)
21/2 3 4
S
3
A (CS)
114 112 2
7
2 8 4 8
8 2
1 114
114 1 2
1
214 2 2
1
7 8 9 10 11
312
258
414
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
49
Rod Attachments
5 6
112
114
Hanger Rods
118
A (alloy) (SS)
B (max)
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Pipe Rings
Fig. 103
Size Range: 34" through 8" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For use in supporting piping away from wall or oor. Maximum Temperature: Plain 650 F, Galvanized 450 F Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish Service: For use in supporting horizontal piping away from the wall or oor (not to be used as a riser type support)
W
834 914 934 10 1114 1134 1278 1378 1558 1634 1834
B
212 258 21316 21516 3316 3716 334 414 434 5516 6516
D
7
G C L
Bolt Dia. F
16
8 11/4
16
2 11/2
11
16
Fig. 100
Size Range: 12" through 8" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For attachment to structure without use of rods. Maximum Temperature: Plain 650 F, Galvanized 450 F Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish.
H
G
1 8"
C L
F E 12"
W
558 578 638 678 718 838 878 10 1058 1238 1312 1512
E
278 318 358 418 438 518 558 634 738 858 934 1134
G Width
1
H
414 412 5 512 534 678 738 814 918 1078 12 14
Weight
1.85 2.20 2.25 2.34 2.39 3.25 3.40 3.58 4.74 5.09 8.23 9.25
8 114
2 112
50 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 212
Size Range: 12" through 30" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for suspension of cold pipe lines or hot lines where no insulation is required. Maximum Temperature: Plain 750 F, Galvanized 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 4) WW-H-171-E (Type 4), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 4). UL, ULC Listed and FM Approved (Sizes 34" - 8"). Installation: Normally used with weldless eye nut Fig. 290, page 102 or eye rod. Features: C F Clamps tightly to pipe. Wide range of sizes. Equal gap design on many sizes. E Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, G name and nish. C L Note: The C gap dimension ensures adequate clearance at the top attachment point for a weldless B eye nut or other appropriate rod attachment. This gap may or may not be present on the bottom portion of the clamp. If different loads or dimensions are required, refer to Fig. 42 SD non-standard two bolt pipe clamp.
Note: This picture is representative of a typical Figure 212. Distance between clamp ears beneath pipe may or may not be equal to upper gap.
Weight
0.29 0.33 0.35 0.38 0.43 1.10 1.20 1.40 1.50 1.80 2.60 5.40 6.50 13.60 15.20 20.50 22.30 31.60 35.80 53.10 113.90
B
1 118 1716 1916 218 258 278 3316 312 4316 478 6 7716 8716 914 1014 1158 1234 1514 19
H
11732 12132 13132 2332 234 314 312 31316 414 41516 534 678 8916 9916 1058 1158 13 1418 1678 2118
D
12332 12532 12932 2532 2732 234 314 312 31316 414 41516 534 678 8916 9916 1058 1158 13 1418 1678 2118
650 F
500 800
750 F
7* 9* 10* 11* 12* 13* 14* 16* 17* 19* 22* 23* 20 15 15 12 12 9
1,040
930
8 4
1,615
1,440
2,490
2,220
3,060 3,500
2,730 3,360
Clamps may be furnished with square ends. Span represents the maximum recommended distance between hangers on a continuous & straight run of horizontal standard weight steel pipe lled with water. In all cases, verify that chosen location of hangers does not subject hangers to a load greater than the maximum recommended load shown above. For vapor service, the presence of ttings or insulation, and other weights and types of pipe, spans may either increase or decrease. In all cases, verify that chosen location of hanger does not subject hangers to a load greater than the maximum recommended load shown. *Indicates that span represents the maximum span for water lled pipe as given in Table 1 of page 249.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
51
1316 114 138 158 11116 218 258 278 3316 312 4316 478 6 7716 8716 914 1014 1158 1234 1514 19
16 1
5 3
8 4
11/4 11/2 2
8 21/2 3 4
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Span Ft.
G Width
Beam Clamps
Pipe Rings
Fig. 212FP
Size Range: 2 12" through 12" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For seismic bracing, to be used with Fig. 113 brace tting. Pipe clamp bolt holes are designed to match holes in brace tting. Maximum Temperature: Plain 750 F, Galvanized 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 4) WW-H-171-E (Type 4), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 4). Installation: Designed for use with Fig. 113 brace tting, see page 76. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish. Note: The C gap dimension should be used at the upper and lower locations to ensure proper installation of the clamp. Standard Figure 212 will be furnished for sizes 2 12" thru 4".
E C L
B H
Weight (lbs)
1.20 1.40 1.50 1.80 2.50 5.20 6.30 13.60 15.20
B
258 278 3316 312 4316 478 6 7 7 16 8716
H
314 312 31316 414 41516 534 678 8916 9916
D
314 312 31316 414 41516 534 678 8916 9916
G Width
1,040
930
11/4 11/2 2
114 1
52 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 216
Size Range: 3" through 42" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for suspension of pipe lines where no insulation is required. Maximum Temperature: Plain 750 F, Galvanized 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 4) WW-H-171-E (Type 4), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 4). Installation: Normally used with welded eye rod or with weldless eye nut Fig. 290, see page 102. Features: Designed for heavy load up to 750 F Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish. Note: If different loads or dimensions are required, refer to Fig. 42 SD non-standard two bolt pipe clamp.
C
F E C L
B H
650 F
3,370 3,515 4,865 6,010 8,675 9,120 13,800 15,300 16,300 18,000 20,500 23,750 25,000 28,000 35,000
750 F
3,005 3,135 4,350 4,340 5,360 7,740 8,135 3.6 5.5 6.3 11.7 13.9 22.3 38.1 46.8 51.4 130.1 163.6 215.2 302.8 365.4 431.7 533.8 575.1 915.7 21516 3916 418 5 618 7916 9 934 1034 1412 16 1812 2012 2212 2312 25 2612 30 1 118 1 4
1
3 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 28 30 32 34 36 42
31/2 6 5 6 8 7 8
314
312
10
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
53
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
158
4 478 512 658 758 9116 1078 1178 1278 1714 1834 2112 2312 26 27 2812 3014 3334
318 334 438 514 614 71116 914 10 11 1412 16 1812 2012 2212 2312 25 2612 30
3 7
4 8 2
1 1 4
1
21/2 3
112
31316 41116 514 638 712 81516 1058 1158 1258 1714 1834 2112 2312 26 27 2812 3014 3334
Pipe Size
Weight
G Width
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Note: This picture is representative of a typical Figure 216. Distance between clamp ears beneath pipe may or may not be equal to upper gap.
Pipe Rings
Fig. 295
Size Range: 34" through 36" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for suspension of pipe requiring insulation within the limitation of temperature and loads shown below. Maximum Temperature: Plain 750 F, Galvanized 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 3), WW-H-171-E (Type 3), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 3). Installation: Attachment to the clamp may be made with a welded eye rod Fig. 278, page 98 or the weldless G eye nut Fig. 290, see page 102. Features: Sizes 6" and above accommodate up to 4" thick insulation. Figure 41SD will accommodate larger insulation thicknesses, loads and dimensions. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish.
C
F E D
C L
Note: This picture is representative of a typical Figure 295. Distance between clamp ears beneath pipe may or may not be equal to upper gap.
Weight
0.7 0.8 0.8 2.3 2.6 1.97 2.17 6.7 7.0 7.31 8.33 19.8 22.3 37.7 41.4 44.9 57.3 65.9 112.3 150.0 193.3 248.8 257.5
B
15 16 1116 114 11316 218 258 278 338 31516 478 6 678 778 9116 10116 11116 1238 1438 1712 1812 1958 2112 2212
D
278 3 318 478 578 6 658 758 818 938 1038 12 13 14516 15516 16516 1758 1958 2414 2618 28 3114 3214
750 F
1,380
5
G Width
1 11/4 1 2
H
138 112 11116 238 21116 314 312 412 5 534 678 814 914 101116 111116 121116 14 16 20 2114 2258 25 26
8 8 2
1116
5
1,545
2,500 2,865 3,240 4,300 5,490 4,500 6,000 7,500 8,250 9,800 10,500
1116 114 1 16
7
4 21/2
1 114 3 1 8
3
214 212 3
4 5 6 5
Clamps may be furnished with square ends. Span represents the maximum recommended distance between hangers on a continuous and straight run of horizontal standard weight steel pipe lled with water. In all cases, verify that chosen location of hangers does not subject hangers to a load greater than the maximum recommended load shown above. *Indicates that span represents the maximum span for water lled pipe as given in Table 1 of page 249. For vapor service, the presence of ttings or insulation, and other weights and types of pipe, spans may either increase or decrease. In all cases, verify that chosen location of hanger does not subject hangers to a load greater than the maximum recommended load shown.
54 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 295A
C L G
Note: This picture is representative of a typical Figure 295A. Distance between clamp ears beneath pipe may or may not be equal to upper gap.
H
Weight
2.3 2.6 2.7 3.0 6.7 7.0 11.5 13.2 19.8 22.3 37.7 41.4 44.9 57.3 65.9
B
11316 218 2516 234 338 31516 434 534 7116 8116 9116 10116 11116 1238 1438
D
478 578 618 61116 758 818 91516 101516 12 13 14516 15516 16516 1712 1912
G Width
H
238 21116 21516 312 412 5 618 718 814 9516 101116 111116 121116 14 16
11/4
1 16
1
4 8
1 16
7
Based on the allowable stresses shown in the ASME Code for Pressure Piping.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
55
Size Range: 1 12" through 24" Material: Chrome molybdenum steel (ASTM A 387 Grade 22). Service: Recommended for suspension of high temperature pipe requiring insulation. Maximum Temperature: 1,050 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 3) WW-H-171-E (Type 3), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 3). Features: Sizes 6" and above accommodate up to 4" thick insulation. Figure 41SD will accommodate larger insulation thicknesses, loads and dimensions. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number and name. Note: Galvanizing is not recommended for alloy products.
Fig 295H
Size Range: 6" through 36" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for suspension of pipe requiring insulation within the limitation of temperature and loads shown below. Maximum Temperature: Plain 750 F, Galvanized 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 3) WW-H-171-E (Type 3), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 3). Features: Accommodates up to 4" thick insulation. Figure 41SD will accommodate larger insulation thicknesses, loads and dimensions. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish.
C
C L G
Note: This picture is representative of a typical Figure 295H. Distance between clamp ears beneath pipe may or may not be equal to upper gap.
H
Weight
12.0 18.5 30.3 42.0 60.0 80.0 115.0 140.0 190.0 354.0 406.0 555.0 604.0 678.0
B
434 6 714 858 958 1078 1212 1312 1512 1878 1978 2134 2338 2458
C
134 2 214 2 2
1
D
101316 1138 1318 14516 1512 1718 1814 1934 22516 3134 3234 36 3712 4014
750 F
3,125 4,285 4,910 6,250 8,485 8,930 12,325 13,665 14,555
F
1 118 114 138 112 134 2 214 212 234
G Width
21/2 31/2 4 41/2 4 5 6 7 8 7 8
H
6 714 9 1038 1158 1318 1412 16 1812 2338 2438 2634 2838 3018
56 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
H D
C L
Fig. 224 & 246: LOads (lbs) Weight (lbs) DimensiOns (in)
Pipe Size
4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24
750 F
3,780 6,060 9,060 12,570
950 F
3,300 5,290 13,500 16,500 19,000 25,000
214
138
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
57
834 - 101316 1078 - 121316 1278 - 14116 1418 - 16116 1618 - 18116 1818 - 20116 2018 - 24116
1 5
2 8
1 112 158
114 2
612 918 1118 1538 1778 1918 2118 2418 2618 3034
4 412
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
314
Max Load
Weight
Brackets
3"
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Size Range: 4" through 24" Material: Chrome molybdenum steel except U-bolt which is stainless steel. Service: Recommended for suspension of high temperature pipe requiring up to 6" of insulation. Maximum Temperature: 1,075 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 2), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 2). Installation: Used with welded eye rod Fig. 278, page 98 or weldless eye nut Fig. 290, page 102. Features: Designed for the support of loads at temperatures up to 1,075 F. Fig. 246 Clamp with ller plate will snugly hold pipe of non-standard size. Alloy load distribution strap provided. When used on pipe with 6 of covering, the top bolt is outside of the insulation. Yoke has rugged cross section area, eliminating high stress conditions. Ordering: Ordering: Specify nominal pipe size and exact O.D. of pipe, gure number, name. Special alloy ller plates will be provided, at an C extra charge, when the O.D. of the pipe size is other than standard. F Installation instructions are attached to the clamp when the ller plates are required.
Pipe Rings
SOCKET CLAMpS
Fig. 595
Size Range: 4" through 24" Material: Two carbon steel half bands and four bolts and nuts. Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Clamps ductile or cast iron mechanical joint piping or mechanical joint or socket joint ttings together to prevent separation or distortion of pipe line under excessive water pressure. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 8), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 8). Complies with the requirements of the National Fire Protection Association Standard NFPA-24 for Outside Protection. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish.
Fig. 594
FIG. 594 WASHER ORDER SEPARATELY E C L
wo cast iron or steel washers, Fig. 594, are used with each Fig. 595 socket clamp and these must be ordered separately. T Ordering: Specify washer size, gure number, name and nish.
F B
Pipe Anchor
Fig. 595, Fig. 594: LOads (lbs) Weight (lbs) DimensiOns (in)
Max Test D.I./C.I. Pressure Pipe Size (PSI)
4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24
Force* On Clamp
4,550 9,340 16,080 24,180 34,230 22,200 27,760 23,900 27,500 26,200
Pipe O.D.
5 718 9516 1112 1312 1534 1778 20 2218 2638
B
1458 1678 1918 2138 2518 2814 3138 3518 3734 4414
D Width
2 2 2
1
Bolt Dia. E
5
F
958 1178 1418 1658 1958 2238 2538 2818 3012 36
8 4 8
8 4
250
3 4 412 5
1 114 112
118 114
58 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
SOCKET CLAMpS
Socket Clamp for Ductile Iron or Cast Iron Pipe
General Table of Notes Contents
Fig. 600
C L
F B
Pipe O.D.
4 5 7116 9316 1138 1312 1534 1778 20 2218 2638
B
1158 1218 1438 1658 1878 2114 2512 28 3112 3334 3934
D Width
Bolt Dia. E
F
858 934 12 1414 1612 1878 23 2512 2758 2934 3514
4 412 5
118 114
4.5 6.8
114 112
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
59
2.7
8 1
Rod Attachments
1.2
Hanger Rods
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
wo cast iron or steel washers, Fig. 599, are used with each Fig. 600 socket clamp and these must be ordered separately. T Ordering: Specify washer size, gure number, name and nish.
Clevis Hangers
Fig. 599
Pipe Rings
Size Range: 3" through 24" pipe Material: Two carbon steel halfbands and two bolts and nuts. Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Clamps joints of socket ttings together to prevent distortion of pipe line under excessive water pressure. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 8), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 8). Features: An economical method of anchoring joints of socket ttings when used on other than re protection work. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish.
BEAM CLAMPS
Fig. 86: C-Clamp with Set Screw and Lock Nut Fig. 88: C-Clamp with Set Screw Only
Size Range: 38" through 34" Material: Malleable iron clamp; hardened steel cup point set screw. Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for attachment to W and M beams where thickness of ange Z (see table on page 258) does not exceed 0.75". When clamp is used with Fig. 89 retaining clip, ange thickness may not exceed 0.62". Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 23), WW-H-171-E (Type 23), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 23). UL, ULC Listed (Sizes 38", 12" and 34") and FM Approved (Sizes 38"). Installation: Follow recommended set screw torque values per MSS-SP-69 (See table on page 257). The Fig. 88 is only to be used on installations where the clamp cannot become dislodged from the beam. Features: Malleable body assures: 1) Uniform quality and strength. 2) Full thread engagement. Hardened steel cup point set screw for securing to beam ange. Ribbed design of clamp provides added strength. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name, length of retaining clip, if desired. (Add 2" to ange width of beam to arrive at proper length of retaining clip.) If required length is not standard, order next longer standard.
H E
38" 38"
C-Clamp
Fig. 86
H E
C Z
34"
Z
34"
Fig. 86
Fig. 88
FiG. 86 aND FiG. 88: LoaDs (lBs) WEiGHT (lBs) DimENsioNs (iN) TORQUE (IN-LBS)
Rod Size A
3 1 5 3
n
Torque Value
60 60 60 60
Max Load n
400 440 500
C
134 2
E
5
H
138 112
Weight Fig. 86
0.28 0.31 0.42 0.55
Fig. 88
0.26 0.29 0.40 0.53
8 2 8 4
8 4
60 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
BEAM CLAMpS
C-Clamp with Locknut
General Table of Notes Contents
Fig. 95
Size Range: 38" and 12" Material: Carbon Steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Designed for fastening ange of W and M beam. Bottom hole tapped to accommodate hanger rod. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 23) WW-H-171-E (Type 23), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 23). UL Listed (Sizes 38"). FM Approved (Sizes 38" - 12"). Installation: Follow recommended set screw torque values per MSS-SP-69 (See table on page 257). Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish. Note: If a retaining clip is desired, you may specify either Fig. 89X or Fig. 89. For length and other ordering information, refer to Fig. 89X and Fig. 89.
Set Screw
A C
Fig. 95: LOad (lbs) Weight (lbs) DimensiOns (in) TORQUE (IN-LBS) Rod Sized Retaining Clips
Rod Size A
3
Torque Value
60 125
Max Load
230
B
4
C
214
D
238
Weight
0.34
Fig. 89
8
Fig. 89X
3
8 2
8 2
8 2
3 1 1
380
0.40
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
61
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
BEAM CLAMpS
Fig. 89
Size Range: 38" through 12" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For use with Figs. 86, 88 & 95. NOT for seismic applications. How to size: Specify length of retaining strap based on beam size. Installation: Length of strap should be adequate to allow at least 1" of strap to be bent over the beam side of the ange opposite the side the beam clamp is mounted on. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name, length of retaining clip and nish (Add 2" to ange width of beam to arrive at proper length of retaining clip). If required length is not standard, order next longer standard. Fig. 89
L
Retaining Clip
B 1 114 138
D
7
Weights 4 2
1
34"
8 2 5 8 3 4
1
15
16 32 16
11
Fig. 89X
Size Range: 38" through 34" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Galvanized Service: For use with Figs. 86, 88, 92, 93, 94 & 95 in seismic applications. Approvals: Complies with MSS-SP-127. UL and ULC Listed. How to size: Specify length of retaining strap based on beam size. Installation: Length of strap should be adequate to allow at least 1" of strap to be bent over the beam side of the ange opposite the side the beam clamp is mounted on. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name, length of retaining clip and nish (Add 2" to ange width of beam to arrive at proper length of retaining clip). If required length is not standard, order next longer standard.
L
14"
Retaining Clip
Width W
1 114
T
0.058 0.070
Weight 6
0.10 0.13
8
0.14 0.17
10
0.17 0.22
14
0.24
Length L
6, 8, 10, 14
8 2 8 4
5 3
0.31
62 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
BEAM CLAMpS
Universal C-type Clamp (Standard Throat)
General Table of Notes Contents
Fig. 92
H G
34"
D BODY CASTING
Fig. 92: LOad (lbs) Weight (lbs) DimensiOns (in) TORQUE (IN-LBS)
Rod Size Set Screw A Size
3
Torque Value
60 125
Weight
0.34 0.63
C
1516 138
D
1916 11316
E
9
F
13
G
3
H
1
8 2
8 2
16 2
16
2 32
Bolts, Nuts, Pins & U-Bolts
1116
16
23
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
63
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
JAM - NUT
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Size Range: 38" and 12" Material: Ductile iron, hardened steel cup point set screw and locknut. Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for use under roof installations with bar joist type construction, or for attachment to the top or bottom ange of structural shapes where the vertical hanger rod is required to be offset from the edge of the ange and where the thickness of joist or ange does not exceed 34". Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 19 & 23) WW-H-171-E (Type 23), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 19 & 23). UL, ULC Listed and FM Approved. How to size: Size of clamp is determined by size of rod to be used. Installation: Follow recommended set screw torque values per MSS-SP-69 (See table on page 257) Features: They may be attached to horizontal anges of structural members in either the top beam or bottom beam positions. Secured in place by a cup-pointed Set Screw tightened against the ange. A Jam Nut is provided for tightening the Set Screw against the Body Casting. Thru tapping of the body casting permits extended adjustment of the threaded rod. Can be used with Fig 89X retaining clip for seismic applications. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name of clamp and nish.
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
BEAM CLAMpS
Fig. 93
Size Range: 38" and 12" Material: Ductile iron clamp, hardened steel cup point set screw and locknut. Finish: Plain and Galvanized Service: Recommended for use under roof installations with bar joist type constructions, or for attachment to the top or bottom ange of structural shapes where the vertical hanger rod is required to be offset from the edge of the ange and where the thickness of joist or ange does not exceed 1 14". Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 19 & 23), WW-H-171-E (Type 23), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 19 & 23). UL, ULC Listed and FM Approved. How to size: Size of clamp is determined by size of rod to be used. Installation: Follow recommended set screw torque values per MSS-SP-69 (See tables on page 257). Features: They may be attached to horizontal anges of structural members in either the top beam or bottom beam positions. Secured in place by a cup-pointed Set Screw tightened against the ange. A Jam Nut is provided for tightening the Set Screw against the Body Casting. Thru tapping of the body casting permits extended adjustment of the threaded rod. Wider throat for attaching to ange with up to 1 14" thickness. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name of clamp and nish.
H G
Fig. 93: LOad (lbs) Weight (lbs) DimensiOns (in) TORQUE (IN-LBS)
Rod Size A
3 1
n
Bottom
250 760
Weight
0.41 0.75
C
1516 138
D
2532 21132
E
9
F
13
G
3 7
H
5 13
8 2
8 2
60 125
16 2
16
8 16
1116
16
64 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
BEAM CLAMpS
Wide Throat Top Beam C-Clamp
General Table of Notes Contents
Fig. 94
Size Range: 58" and 34" Material: Ductile iron body, hardened steel cup point set screw and locknut. Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for use under roof installations with bar joist type construction, or for attachment to the top ange of structural shapes where the vertical hanger rod is required to be offset from the edge of the ange and where the thickness of joists or ange does not exceed 1 516". Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 19) WW-H-171-E (Type 19), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 19), UL Listed. How to size: Size of clamp is determined by size of rod to be used. Installation: Follow maximum recommended set screw torque values per MSS-SP-69. (See tables on page 257) Features: Provides clamping to bar joists which are directly under roof installations. Provides for vertical hanger rod installed offset from the edge of the beam ange. Malleable iron body assures full thread engagement of rod. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name of clamp and nish.
15/16 C
3/8
Fig. 94: LOad (lbs) Weight (lbs) DimensiOns (in) TORQUE (IN-LBS)
Rod Size A
8 3 4
5
n
/8 3 /8
3
60 60
1,200 1,600
0.66 0.83
134 178
214 238
114 138
1 1 16
3
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
65
Weight
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
BEAM CLAMpS
Fig. 227
Material: Carbon steel jaw, hook rod with nut, lock washer and plain washer. Finish: Plain Service: Recommended for use on top ange of beam and roof trusses where the ange thickness does not exceed 0.81". Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 25), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 25). UL Listed (rod sizes 38" & 12") and FM Approved when used with 38" rod size. How to size: Determine hook rod length by adding gure in column headed x to ange width (see table on page 258 for ange width). x is not indicated as a dimension on drawing. Installation: Slide stamped steel jaw over beam ange and attach hook rod and eye rod, nally tightening hook rod. Hammer jaw rmly against the underside of the beam to complete installation. Features: Two jaw sizes t beam anges thickness from 0.25" to 0.81". Clamp rmly holds to beam providing safe and extremely economical means of supporting small piping from the top ange of steel beams and roof trusses. Ordering: Specify jaw size, gure number, name, hook rod length. Standard hook rods are furnished in even inch lengths, either length ordered or next longer length.
C A
Max Load
730 940
Weight
0.38 0.67
Rod Size A
3 1
B
3
C
5
X
218 214 212 258
8 2 8 4
16 8 2 16
1 118 114
3 7
5 3
Based on 8" hook rod length. Will vary for other hook rod lengths.
66 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
BEAM CLAMpS
Adjustable Side Beam Clamp
General Table of Notes Contents
Fig. 14
Size Range: 38" through 58" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for supporting pipe from the bottom ange of beams. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 27) WW-H-171-E (Type 54), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 27). Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish.
Min.
3 2
1
Max.
1.19 8 1.67 2.23
3 1
8 2 8
7 9
16 16 16
11
3 - 412 458 - 6 618 - 712 758 - 9 3 - 412 458 - 6 618 - 712 758 - 9
2 16 3 4 15 16
1 11
500
2 16 3 4 15 16
1 11
700
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
67
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
2 16 3 4 15 16
11
300
Size Range: 3" through 7 58" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain Service: To be used where it is necessary for the hanger rod to run vertically close to the beams edge, eliminating drilling of holes in structural members. Components: Top slide, bottom hook, nut and bolt assembled. Design: Can be adjusted to t various beam ange widths Fig. 217: LOad (lbs) Weight (lbs) DimensiOns (in) and thicknesses. Max Flange Max Flange Rod Max Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A Size Weight Width Thickness Size A Load (Type 25), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 25). Fig. 217 - Type 1 Ordering: Specify size, gure number, type, name. 1 1
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Fig. 217
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
Rod Size A
Max Load
Hole Size A
Weight
BEAM CLAMpS
Spacer B
Bolt
2 8 4 8
B
138 214
Bolt Size
3
Spacer O.D.
11
Max Load
1,000 3,000
2 4
8 8
16
1116
68 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
BEAM CLAMPS
Malleable Beam Clamp without Extension Piece
General Table of Notes Contents
Fig. 218
Material: Malleable iron jaw, steel tie rod, nuts and washer. Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for attachment to structural steel. Use in conjunction with beams where beam widths are from 2 38" minimum to 7" maximum and ange thickness does not exceed 0.60". Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 30) WW-H-171-E (Type 30), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 30). UL, ULC Listed (Sizes 34" - 12" pipe size, when used with the Fig. 157 extension piece 38" - 78" rod sizes). FM Approved (Sizes 34" - 4 pipe size, when used with the Fig. 157 extension piece 38" rod size). Installation: The malleable beam clamp Fig. 218 may be used with an eye rod, or Fig. 157 extension piece. Features: Functional design insures proper t for all beam sizes. Tie rod locks clamp in place when nuts are tightened. Ordering and stocking simplied because of one universal size. Design allows hanger rod to swing from vertical providing exibility at the beam clamp. Ordering: Specify gure number, name and nish. Note: When used with Fig. 157 see page 102 extension piece, an additional inch or more of vertical adjustment is obtained.
238
2.2 312
3
3716
4
3516
5
21516
6
2916
7
178
1,365
16
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
69
Max Load n
Weight
Width of Beam Flange (in) Rod Take Out - E (in) Bolt Diam
Rod Attachments
BOLT DIA.
Hanger Rods
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
BEAM CLAMpS
Fig. 228
Universal Forged Steel (UFS) Beam Clamp with UFS (Upper) Nut Right-Hand Thread
Material: Forged steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For suspension of heavy loads from beams with ange widths to 15" and ange thickness to 1.031. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 28 without links; Type 29 with links), WW-H-171-E (Type 30 & 31), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 28 without links; Type 29 with links). Installation: Fit jaws over edges of lower beam ange and tighten nuts on tie rod to lock clamp in place. Features: Upper nut is tapped to any specied size up to the maximum rod size. Quickly, easily, economically installed. Tie rod insures a tight non-slip t to the beam. Clamps are available, tapped to any specied rod size up to the maximum rod size. Ordering: Specify clamp size, gure number, name, rod size and nish. Note: The application of a load to a structural beam by means of a beam clamp produces a transverse stress, perpendicular to the axis of the beam, in the ange to which the load is applied. Size per load, beam ange width and rod size
118" Z
Weight Z Max
3.3 7.0 10.6 19.3 31.0 0.60 1.031
B
1116 1 8
3
118" Z
8 8
112
238
228 - 3
B
For reference only, order by clamp size. Furnished with links. n Note: Load capacity based on rod sizes shown. For load capacity of other rod sizes see page 257. For actual Z dimensions see table on page 258.
3
1916
4
112 1716 2516
5
1 16
5
6
1 8
1
7
4 11 16 11516 11316
3
11
21116
12
2916
13
214
14
11516
15
158
2316
2116
70 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
BEAM CLAMpS
General Table of Notes Contents
Fig. 292: Right-Hand Thread Universal Forged Steel (UFS) Beam Clamp Fig. 292L: Left-Hand Thread with and without Weldless Eye Nut
Material: Forged steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For suspension of heavy loads from beams with ange widths to 15" and ange thickness to 1.031. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 28 without links; Type 29 with links), WW-H-171-E (Type 28 without links; Type 29 with links), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 28 without links; Type 29 with links). Installation: Fit jaws over edges of lower beam ange and tighten nuts on tie rod to lock clamp in place. Features: Weldless eye nut provides for horizontal pipe movement without binding. Weldless eye nut is furnished tapped to any specied rod size up to the maximum rod size. Tie rod assures a tight non-slip t to the beam. Self locking nut with a nylon insert prevents the nut from working loose. Ordering: Specify clamp size, gure number, name, rod size and nish. Note: The application of a load to a structural beam by means of a beam clamp produces a transverse stress, perpendicular to the axis of the beam, in the ange to which the load is applied.
Z Max
0.60
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
3,230 5,900
112 2
11,500
114 1 16
11
292 - 3 / 3 292 - 3 / 4
A
13
718 712
14
658 7
15
6116 6716
SELF LOCKING NUTS (3X) E
4116 358 278 4716 4116 338 51516 6 5516 5 658 638 578 578 538 41316 818 7 634 614 6516 51316 5316 812 7 3 3 3 1 5 8 16 8 16 7 4 7 4 7 4 6 8
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
71
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
For reference only, order by clamp size. Furnished with links. n Note: Load capacity based on rod sizes shown. For load capacity of other rod sizes see page 257. For actual Z dimensions see table on page 258.
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Max Load n
Weight
Beam Clamps
Fig. 292, Fig. 292L: LOads (lbs) Weight (lbs) DimensiOns (in)
11/8
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
STRUCTURAL ATTACHMENTS
Size Range: Fig. 55: 12" through 3 34" Fig. 55L 12" through 2" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For attachment to structural steel in conjunction with the Fig. 299 clevis and with type C variable spring hanger or Type C Constant Support. Maximum Temperature: Plain 750 F, Galvanized 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 57), WW-H-171-E (Type 57), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 57). Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name, nish and whether short or long lug is required. Order Separately: Fig. 291 pin with cotters or bolt and nut
FIELD WELD
FIELD WELD
R W T
Fig. 55, Fig. 55L: LOad (lbs) Weight (lbs) DimensiOns (in)
Fig. 55, Fig. 55L Rod Size A*
1 5 3 7
F
11 13 15
T
1
750 F
1,057 1,692 2,530 3,508 4,620 7,440 10,807 14,566 19,265 25,295 31,169 38,687 47,066 56,307 66,331 77,139
Weight
0.48 0.41 0.60 0.71 1.2 3.0 4.8 4.7 7.2 7.6 15.5 15.1 16.0 18.9 31.3 35.9
2 8 4 8
8 4 8
16 16 16 114
4 8 2 8
1 118 1 8
3
1 8
1
1 1 4
1
114 1 2
1
112 2 212
158 178 2 4
1
134 2 2 8
3
3 4 4 2
1
4 6
212 2 4
3
258 2 8
7
5 6
412
112 1 4
3
* Note: Rod size A is the assembly rod diameter. Dimension not shown on drawing
72 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
STRUCTURAL ATTACHMENTS
Two Hole Welding Beam Lug
General Table of Notes Contents
Fig. 54
Size Range: 12" through 2 14" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For single rod suspension of Fig. 81-H, type B and C constant supports. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name, nish and H dimension.
Rod Size A*
1
Max Load
1,350 2,160 3,230 5,900 9,500 13,800 18,600 24,600 32,300
Weight H Dimension 1 2
1
2 8 4
5 3
112
1 2
1
5 3 7
8 4 8
11 13 15
16 16 16 112 2 212
3 1 5
2 3 4
114
8 2 8
212 3 4 5
5 6 8 10 12
114 1 2
1
138 1 8
5
112 1 4
3
134 2 214
2 238 258
4 6
Select H dimension applicable to constant support frame size. Weight varies with H dimension. * Note: Rod size A is the assembly rod diameter. Dimension not shown on drawing
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
73
Rod Attachments
12.8
Hanger Rods
1 8
1
1 4
1
1-9
Pin or Bolt
K Hole
2W
W/2
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
FIELD WELD
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
STRUCTURAL ATTACHMENTS
Fig: 66
Size Range: 38" through 3 12" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for attachment to bottom of beams, especially where loads are considerable and rod sizes are large. Maximum Temperature: Plain 750 F, Galvanized 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 22), WW-H-171-E (Type 22), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 22). Installation: If exibility at the beam is desired, use with bolt and eye rod Fig. 278, page 98, or with weldless eye nut Fig. 290, page 102. If vertical adjustment is desired, use with threaded rod and nut and weld the attachment in an inverted position to the beam. Features: Will accommodate very heavy loads and rod sizes through 3 12". Can be installed so as to provide for either exibility or for vertical adjustment. Versatility affords economical stocking and erection. Beam size need not be considered. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish. Sizes 1" and smaller are typically supplied with a bolt and nut. Sizes 11/4" and larger are typically supplied with a pin and cotters.
FIELD WELD
FIELD WELD H
13/4" Rod Dia. and Smaller are Formed using Bolt or Pin and Eye Rod.
750 F
572 1,057 1,692 2,530 3,508 4,620 7,440 10,807 14,566 19,265 25,295 31,169 38,687 47,066 56,307 66,331
H
16 16 13 16 15 16 118 114 112 134 2 238 258 278 318 338 358 378
9
11
4 8 2 8 4 2 8
3 4 5
1 5 3
7 8
74 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
STRUCTURAL ATTACHMENTS
Steel Washer Plate
General Table of Notes Contents
Fig. 60
Size Range: 38" to 3 34 Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: A heavy duty washer plate used on top of channels or angles for supporting pipe with rods or U-bolts. Maximum Temperature: Plain 750 F, Galvanized 450 F Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish.
8 2 8 4 8
0.6 0.6 0.9 1.6 2.2 2.1 3.3 4.8 4.7 4.5 6.6 6.4 6.2 5.9 5.6 8.1 7.8
730 1,350 2,160 3,230 4,480 5,900 9,500 13,800 18,600 24,600 32,300 39,800 49,400 60,100 71,900 84,700 98,500
572 1,057 1,692 2,530 3,508 4,620 7,440 10,807 14,566 19,265 25,295 31,169 38,687 47,066 56,307 66,331 77,139
1 5 3
3 x 3 x 14 3 x 3 x 38 4 x 4 x 8
3
2 8 4 8
5 3 7
4 x 4 x 12 5 x 5 x 12
5 x 5 x 34
6 x 6 x 34
3 314 312
312 334
7 x 7 x 34
334 4
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
75
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Weight
Hole Dia. H
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
STRUCTURAL ATTACHMENTS
R
E
W
T
HOLE SIZE - H
Fig. 112, Fig. 113: LOad (lbs) Weight (lbs) DimensiOns (in)
Pipe Size A
1 114
n
Max Load n
850 1,150
B
1
C
2316
D
11116 2316
E
112
Hole Dia. H
9
R
3
T
1
W
112 134
16 4
4 8
16
76 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
BRACKETS
Iron Side Beam Bracket
General Table of Notes Contents
Fig. 202
Size Range: 38" through 58" Material: Malleable iron Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for attachment to steel or wooden beams, etc. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 34) WW-H-171-E (Type 35), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 34). UL, ULC Listed and FM Approved (Sizes 38" for use on wooden and steel beams and 12" for use on steel beams). Features: An economical, practical and adjustable means of securing hangers to beams, etc. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish.
T H E
G D C A A H B
Weight
0.26 0.54 0.94
B
138 1 16
13
C
5 3 7
D
1716 1 8
7
E
17 21 7
Hole Dia. H
7 9
G
7
T
1 11 7
1 5
n
4 8
32 8
16 4
1 16
3
32
2316
218
1716
16
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
77
32
16
Rod Attachments
Max Load n
Hanger Rods
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
BRACKETS
Fig. 206
Size Range: 38" through 58" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Clip can be fastened to side of joist or wall to support hanger rod. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 34), WW-H-171-E (Type 35) and ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 34). UL Listed and FM Approved (steel beam only). Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish.
T B H
Rod Size A
3
Max Load
Hole Size H
7
8 2 8
B L
2116 212
8 4
16 16 16
11
/8
Fig. 207
Size Range: 38" and 12" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for attachment to steel or wooden beams, etc. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 34), WW-H-171-E (Type 35), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 34). UL Listed (Sizes 38" and 12"). FM Approved (Size 38" for use on steel beam only) Features: Threaded mounting bracket provides an economical, practical and adjustable means of securing hangers to beams. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish.
14 38" 12"
BOLT HOLE
516
34
134
38"
1516
114
38 12" 58"
BOLT HOLE
BOLT HOLE
212
12"
Rod Size A
3
Bolt Size
8 2 1 2 5 8
3 1
Weight
0.17 0.42
THD. ROD
8 2
118 158
78 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
BRACKETS
Straight Eye Socket
General Table of Notes Contents
Fig. 189
Size: 38" Material: Galvanized steel Service: Attachment to structure to connect threaded hanger rod. Approvals: UL and ULC Listed, and FM Approved. Installation: Thread rod completely into hanger. Secure rod by tightening jam nut against bottom of hanger. Secure hanger to structural member with recommended fasteners. Features: Pre-formed threads for easy rod assembly. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number and name. Description
Straight Eye Socket Hanger
4 " - 4"
3/8-16 UNC
250 lbs.
FASTENERS
Description
#14 x 2" Wood Screw
1
Quantity
2 *1
Pipe Size
* 34 " - 2"
3
A
2.28
B
1.10
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
79
Rod Attachments
Notes: 1. For re protection installation follow the requirements of National Fire Protection Association, NFPA-13 and local codes. 2. To assure proper performance, installer is responsible for: a. Structural integrity of attachment member to safely handle load requirements. b. Securely tightening jam nut on the hanger rod.
Hanger Rods
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
3 3/8-16 UNC Jam Nut 1 4 " - 4" * Lag screw not required for 3/4" - 2" pipe sizes using the alternate option of (2) wood screws.
Socket Clamps
4 " - 4"
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
Pipe Sizes
Rod Size
Max. Load
BRACKETS
Fig. 190
Size: 38" Material: Galvanized steel Service: Attachment to structure to connect threaded hanger rod. Approvals: UL and ULC Listed, and FM Approved. Installation: Thread rod completely into hanger. Secure rod by tightening jam nut against bottom of hanger. Secure hanger to structural member with recommended fasteners. Features: Pre-formed threads for easy rod assembly. Off-set angle provides unlimited vertical adjustment. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number and name. Description
Off-Set Eye Socket Hanger
Pipe Sizes
3
Rod Size
3/8-16 UNC
Max. Load
250 lbs.
4 " - 4"
FASTENERS
Description
#14 x 2" Wood Screw
1
Quantity
2 *1
Pipe Size
* 34 " - 2"
3 3
4 " - 4"
3/8-16 UNC Jam Nut 1 4 " - 4" * Lag screw not required for 3/4" - 2" pipe sizes using the alternate option of (2) wood screws.
B
1.10
Notes: 1. For re protection installation follow the requirements of National Fire Protection Association, NFPA-13 and local codes. 2. To assure proper performance, installer is responsible for: a. Structural integrity of attachment member to safely handle load requirements. b. Securely tightening jam nut on the hanger rod.
80 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
BRACKETS
Light Welded Steel Bracket
General Table of Notes Contents
Fig. 194
Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for support from below or above bracket. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 31), WW-H-171-E (Type 32), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 31). FM Approved when used with 38" rod, 34" - 4" pipe sizes & 12" rod, 5" - 8" pipe sizes. How to size: Determine bracket size by dimension of standard bracket most suitable to the installation. Installation: When bolted to a wall, an additional back plate may be required of such thickness and size as to properly distribute the weight over the wall. Size and thickness of the back plate is governed by the load to be carried and the nature and conditions of the wall. Back plates furnished upon request. Features: Bracket may be installed either in position illustrated or reversed. Ends of bracket are drilled to accept hanger rods up to 34". Ordering: Specify bracket number, gure number, name and nish. Order separately: Hanger rods, 2 bolts and plate washers are available through our Regional Service Centers, order as a Figure 193.
1"
1316
Max 34"
W C
Additional Rod Attachments Available. Requires: 2 bolts, 2 plate washers (not included)
1"
1316
Max Load
Weight
3.1 7.7 12.8
W
9 13 19
C
6 2
1
D
5
1012 1612
16 8
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
81
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
2"
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
BRACKETS
Fig. 195
Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for the support of loads from below or above bracket. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 32), WW-H-171-E (Type 33), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 32). How to size: Determine size by dimensions most suitable to the installation (see dimensions of standard brackets below). Special welded steel brackets can be furnished on order. Installation: When bolted to a wall, an additional back plate may be required of such thickness and size as to properly distribute the weight over the wall. Size and thickness of the back plate is governed by the load to be carried and the nature and conditions of the wall. Back plates furnished upon request. Features: If supporting pipe by rod, rod can be installed anywhere along the length of the bracket thus providing horizontal adjustment. Ordering: Specify bracket number, gure number, name and nish. Orders for special brackets are to be accompanied by detailed sketch. Order Separately: Rod, Fig. 60, bolts, nuts, and back plates for fastening brackets to wall. Specify size and length of rod, bolts size, thickness, and drilling of back plates.
W
38"
F G Fig. 60 H
212"
114"
1" GAP
B C
13
16"
Max Load
Weight
17.4 27.3 47.7
W
12 18 24
B
18 24 30
C
15 2
1
F
4 5
G
1 2
1
H
112 134 2
2112 2712
134 2
82 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
BRACKETS
Heavy Welded Steel Bracket
General Table of Notes Contents
Fig. 199
12"
K H
Fig. 60 D
1" GAP
1" GAP
B C
B C
Bracket Number 0
Bracket no.
0 1 2 3 4 5
Max Load
Weight
24.3 51.8 68.9 86.1 140.5 166.4
W
12 18 24 30 36 42
B
18 24 30 36 42 50
C
1514 2138 2712 3314 39 46
D
138 1716 112 158 1 2
1
E
234
F
4 5
G
114 2 2 2
1
H
2 212 3 2
1
K
234 212
L
13 15
16 16
3,000
3 312 6 3 2
1
1116
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
83
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
F G
F G
Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for the support of loads from above or below bracket. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 33) WW-H-171-E (Type 34), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 33). How to size: Determine size by dimensions most suitable to the installation (see dimensions of standard brackets below). Special welded steel brackets can be furnished on order. Installation: When bolted to a wall, an additional back plate may be required of such thickness and size as to properly distribute the weight over the wall. Size and thickness of the back plate is governed by the load to be carried and the nature and conditions of the wall. Back plates furnished upon request. Features: If supporting pipe by rod, rod can be installed at any point along the length of the bracket thus providing horizontal adjustment. Ordering: Specify bracket number, gure number, name. Orders for special brackets are to be accompanied by detailed sketch. Order Separately: Rod, Fig. 60, bolts, nuts, and back plates for fastening brackets to wall. Specify size and length of rod, bolts size, thickness, and drilling of back plates.
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
Fig. 127
Size Range: 38" and 12" Material: Plastic Service: Recommended for giving a nished appearance where rod enters ceiling. Installation: Slide plate up rod until ush against ceiling. Features: Highly economical Quickly installed Held rmly to rod by design and friction Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name. (rod not included)
Weight
0.07
Outside Dia.
11316
Depth
1
8 2
Fig. 395
Size Range: 12" through 8" Material: Cast iron Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Gives nished appearance where pipe enters ceiling. Installation: Sizes 12" to 4" furnished with one machine screw; sizes 5" to 8", two machine screws. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish.
Weight
0.21 0.40 0.41 0.51 0.55 0.67 0.93 1.10 1.40 2.50 3.10 3.30
D - Dia.
278 338 358 4 414 434 512 618 718 81116 934 1134
L
3
C L
C L
118 114
SIZES 12 THRU 4
SIZES 5 THRU 8
84 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 128R
Size Range: 38" and 12" Material: Malleable iron Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for attachment to wood beams or ceiling. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish.
316"
214"
12"
3516"
3 1
8 2
180
0.16
12
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
85
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
138"
Rod Size A
Max Load
Weight
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
Fig. 153
Size Range: 38" through 34" Material: Malleable iron Finish: Plain Service: Recommended for suspension of pipe lines or conduit from level ceilings. Approvals: UL, ULC Listed and FM Approved (Sizes 38" and 12"). Installation: Flange size 38" has two holes, sizes 12", 58", and 34" have three holes. Features: Provides vertical adjustment up to 1". Good appearance. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number and name.
3 8"
Size
2",
8",
4"
Size
H (3 PLACES)
H (2 PLACES)
D E
Max Load
425 1,050 1,220 1,270
Weight
0.4 0.9 1.5 2.2
B
278 4 434 514
C
138 1 2
1
D
7 15
E
3
8 2 8 4
8 16
16 4 8 16
8 x 2 2 x 2
1 5
1 9
158 178
1 1116
16 x 2
86 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 152
Size Range: 38" through 78" Material: Malleable iron Finish: Plain Service: Upper attachment for suspending pipe from a concrete ceiling where no lateral adjustment is required. Approvals: UL, ULC Listed and FM Approved. Features: Eliminates the necessity of drilling holes in wooden forms. Reduced overall height and four slots for nail attachment gives stability to the insert while the concrete is being poured. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number and name.
E' E F
Max Load n
730 1,130 1,260 2,500
Weight
0.31 0.32 0.37 0.64 0.71
B
1132 1732 158
E
1
8 2 8 4 8
214
158
5 15
8 16
7
212
114
Based on insert only. Rating is subject to the condition that the concrete used is of sufcient strength to hold the insert.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
87
16
Rod Attachments
Hanger Concrete Inserts Ceiling Plates & Attachments Rods & Flanges
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
Fig. 282
Size Range: 38" through 78" Material: Malleable iron body and nut Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Upper attachment for suspending pipe, shafting, motors and similar equipment from a concrete ceiling; especially suitable where rod sizes cannot be readily determined in advance. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 18), WW-H-171-E (Type 18), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 18). UL, ULC Listed and FM Approved. Installation: 1. Nail insert to wooden forms. 2. Where convenient, reinforcing rods may be placed in the opening through the top of the insert, or short lengths of reinforcing rod may be wired to the insert prior to pouring concrete. However, the specied load ratings and approvals are not dependent on the use of any reinforcing rods in contact with the insert. 3. After concrete is poured and wooden forms are removed, place nut in insert and screw rod through nut until rod is rmly against the top of the insert body. The rod should not be forced against the top of the recess thereby placing unnecessary stress at the opening of the insert by the nut. Features: Cast body prevents concrete seepage. Opening in top of insert provides for use of reinforcing rods up to 78" diameter. Sides of insert are recessed for reinforcing rods up to 1" diameter. Low height, broad at bottom and widely separated nail slots minimize displacement during construction. The nut, held in place by V-type teeth on both insert and nut, can be raised and moved from side to side providing for lateral adjustment. Rod is locked in place by screwing it rmly against the top of the recess. One body size. Ordering: Specify gure number, name, nish and size of nut.
Adjustment B
11116 118
Max Load n
730 1,130 1,140 1,140 1,140
Weight
2316
1316
1.5
Insert Only
1.3
Nut Only
0.2
n
Based on insert and nut only. Rating is subject to the condition that the concrete used is of sufcient strength to hold the insert.
88 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 281
2 15/16" 2"
Max Load n
730 1,130 1,200
Weight
0.82 0.86 0.89 0.86 0.93 0.69 0.13 0.17 0.20 0.17 0.24
11/4"
27/32"
Insert Only
adj.*
Nut Only
n
Based on insert and nut only. Rating is subject to the condition that the concrete used is of sufcient strength to hold the insert.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
89
8 2 5 8 3 4 7 8 1 4 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
3 1
Rod Attachments
Hanger Concrete Inserts Ceiling Plates & Attachments Rods & Flanges
Brackets
Size Range: 38" through 78" Material: Carbon steel body; malleable iron nut Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Upper attachment for suspending pipe or conduit from concrete ceiling. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 18), WW-H-171-E (Type 19), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 18). UL, ULC Listed and FM Approved (Sizes 38" - 34"). Installation: 1. Nail insert to wooden forms. 2. Where convenient, reinforcing rods may be placed in the opening through the top of the insert, or short lengths of reinforcing rod may be wired to the insert prior to pouring concrete. However, note that the specied load ratings and approvals are not dependent on the use of any reinforcing rods in contact with the insert. 3. After concrete is poured and forms removed, insert screw driver into slot in knockout plate and snap it out. 4. The nut may be put on the rod before inserting in the insert body. Then, turn rod so that elongated nut lies across the slot; screw rod through nut until rod is rmly against the top of the recess. Features: Nut may be put on hanger rod before insertion, avoiding need of locating nut in insert body prior to inserting rod. Insert nut, when located in position, wedges against the sloping sides of insert, providing greater support than if resting on lower edge of the insert body. Wedge-shaped body is so held by concrete in compression thus increasing load carrying capacity. Easily removed knockout plate. Rod can be adjusted along complete length of slot. One body for six sizes of rod. Ordering: Specify gure number, name and size of nut.
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
Fig. 285
Size Range: 14" through 58" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Upper attachment for suspending pipe or conduit from concrete ceiling. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 18), WW-H-171-E (Type 18), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 19). UL, ULC Listed (Sizes 38" - 58") and FM Approved (Sizes 38" and 12"). Installation: 1. Nail insert to wooden forms. 2. Reinforcing rods may be located under the arched anges at the top of the insert. However, note that the specied load ratings and approvals are not dependent on the use of any reinforcing rods in contact with the insert. 3. After concrete is poured and wooden forms are removed, remove knockout by tapping along edge with pointed instrument. 4. Slip nut into insert and screw rod through nut until rod is rmly against the top of the insert body. Features: Suitable for use in concrete 2" thick due to low overall height. Highly competitive. Provides for 2" of lateral adjustment. Knockout prevents seepage of concrete from underneath the insert up into the insert body. One body size. Removable nut in four sizes. Rod can be rigidly locked in position. Ordering: Specify gure number, name, nish and size of nut.
Fig. 285:
33/4" TWO 5/32" DIA. HOLES EACH END
1 1" 1 /4"
21/2" 11/4"
Max Load n
230 400
Weight
0.46 0.49 0.49 0.48 0.41 0.07
4 8 1 2 5 8 1 4 3 8 1 2 5 8
1 3
Based on insert and nut only. Rating is subject to the condition that the concrete used is of sufcient strength to hold the insert.
90 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 286:
THREADED HOLE FOR HANGER ROD 4
Rod Size A
3 7
4 8
DISC
312
1 1 4
1 1
n Based
on the rod diameter only. Rating is subject to the conditions that the concrete used is of sufcient strength to hold the insert.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
91
1 2
Rod Attachments
Hanger Concrete Inserts Ceiling Plates & Attachments Rods & Flanges
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
Fig. 284
Size Range: 38" through 34" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain Service: Recommended for suspending pipe or conduit in metal concrete deck forms for a variety of rod sizes. May be used with a rod coupling such as the Fig. 135 or 136 to allow for extended rod lengths. Features: L and H can be specied for a custom t if your particular deck does not accommodate type A, B, or C. Standard 6" long UNC bolt is welded to bracket to ensure assembly remains intact during shipment. Ordering: Specify Figure 284, design type (A, B, C) and bolt diameter. If your specic deck will not t one of the design types and/or a different bolt size is required, specify leg height (H), opening (L) and bolt size.
Before pouring concrete, locate the Figure 284 on deck so legs rest in "valleys" of form. Drill hole in deck for bolt.
Weight
1.33 1.43 1.64 1.92 2.23 2.33 2.54 2.82 3.10 3.20 3.41 3.69
A
L
H A
730 1,350 2,160 3,230 730 1,350 2,160 3,230 730 1,350 2,160 3,230
958
134
112
12
112
16
112
n
Based on the rod diameter only. Rating is subject to the conditions that the concrete used is of sufcient strength to hold the deck hanger.
92 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 47
Size Range: 12" through 2" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Structural attachment to concrete ceiling lug is used in conjunction with Fig. 299 (see page 103) forged steel clevis and anchors of sufcient strength to hold the desired load. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish.
U (pin dia.)
J J
B T
C
Structural Attachments
Max Load n
1,350 2,160 3,230 4,480 5,900 9,500 13,800 18,600 24,600
Weight
11.1 14.6 14.8 22.0 31.9 43.8 45.6 55.7 58.2
E
478
F
9
G
3
H
112
T
1
U
8 4 7 8 1 118 138 158 178 214
5 3
16
1
8 2 4 114
4 8 2 8 4
10
5 41316
11
8 2 12 6
212 3
1 8
3
1 4
1
Based on the rod diameter only. Rating is subject to the conditions that the concrete and anchors used are of sufcient strength to hold the load.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
93
16 15 16 118
13
112 2
Rod Attachments
16
Hanger Concrete Inserts Ceiling Plates & Attachments Rods & Flanges
F Dia. (4 Places)
Brackets
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
Fig. 49
Size Range: 38" through 1 34" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Structural attachment to concrete ceiling where exibility is desired. Concrete clevis plate is normally used in conjunction with Fig. 290, page 102, weldless eye nut, or Fig. 278, page 98 welded eye rod and anchors of sufcient strength to hold the desired load. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish. Note: Sizes 38" through 1" are supplied with bolt and nut. Larger sizes are supplied with pin and cotters.
G D
C B J J D
B C
F (4 PLACES)
Weight
11.8 11.9 15.7 16.9 18.1 36.9 40.9 59.8 93.6
F
9
G
3
R
7
S
1 4
1
T
1
U
2 8 3 4 7 8 1 118 138 158 178
1 5
W
2 212 3 4 5
16 16
8 2 2 3 3 4 5
4 8
1 8
10
5
1 11
13
2 10
12 14
6 7
15
16 16 118 138
1 114
2 8 3 4 1 2
1 5
Based on the rod diameter only. Rating is subject to the conditions that the concrete and anchors used are of sufcient strength to hold the load.
94 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 52
Size Range: 38" through 1 14" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Structural attachment to concrete ceiling where vertical adjustment is desired. Normally used with threaded rod and nut and anchors of sufcient strength to hold the desired load. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish.
D E
C B J J D
B C
F (4 PLACES)
Max Load n
730 1,350 2,160 3,230 4,480 5,900 9,500
Weight
11.6 11.6 15.1 16.1 16.7 34.9 40.9
E
214 218
F
9
H
278 318 414 412 5
G
3
1 8
10
214
11
13 15
12
16 16
Based on the rod diameter only. Rating is subject to the conditions that the concrete and anchors used are of sufcient strength to hold the load.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
95
3 8 312 358
1
16
Rod Attachments
16
Hanger Concrete Inserts Ceiling Plates & Attachments Rods & Flanges
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
HANgER RODS
Fig. 142
Size Range: 38" and 12" Material: Carbon steel Finish:Plain Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and rod length.
L
Standard Length - L
312 8 312 8
Max Load
390 640
8 2
Fig. 146
Size Range: 14" through 1 12" Stocked in six, ten, and twelve foot lengths. Other even foot lengths can be furnished to order. Material: Carbon steel or Stainless Steel Gr 304 Threads: National Coarse (USS), rod threaded complete length. Finish: Plain or Galvanized. Maximum Temperature: 650 F. Ordering: Specify rod diameter and length, gure number, name and nish. Note: The acceptability of galvanized coatings at temperatures above 450F is at the discretion of the end user.
Length
Note: Other rod sizes available upon request. Class 2 t is available upon request.
96 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
HANgER RODS
Fig. 140: Right-hand Threads Fig. 253: Right and Left hand Threads
Size Range: 38" through 5" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name, rod length and nish. Specify thread length if other than standard. Note: The acceptability of galvanized coatings at temperatures above 450F is at the discretion of the end user.
D L
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
97
Rod Attachments
Size Range: 38" through 2 12" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized. Maximum Temperature: 650 F Features: Through 1 12", inside diameter of eye will accommodate a bolt diameter 18" larger than rod diameter; 1 34" and larger, inside diameter of eye will take a bolt diameter 1 4" larger than rod diameter. Ordering: Specify rod diameter, gure number, name, rod length and nish. Specify thread length if other than standard.
Rod Size A
8 2 5 8 3 4 7 8 1 114 112 134 2 214 212
3 1
L (min)
414 412 512 612 714 814 10 12 14 1512 17
Hanger Rods
Fig. 248: Right Hand Threads Fig. 248L: Left Hand Threads
Brackets
Structural Attachments
16 13 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 412 412 4
730 1,350 2,160 3,230 4,480 5,900 9,500 13,800 18,600 24,600 32,300 39,800
572 1,057 1,692 2,530 3,508 4,620 7,440 10,807 14,566 19,265 25,295 31,169
3 312 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
15
18
* Fig. 140 rod up to 1" rod size and 24" in length may be furnished as Fig 146 rod unless order states that all thread rod is not acceptable. *3/8"- 4" Diameter: UNC-2A CLASS t.
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
212
4 4 4 4 4 4 4 UN 4 UN 4 UN 4 UN
49,400 60,100 71,900 84,700 98,500 113,400 129,400 146,600 164,700 184,000
38,687 47,066 56,307 66,331 77,139 88,807 101,337 114,807 128,982 144,096
11 12 13 14
Pipe Rings
HANgER RODS
Fig. 278: Right Hand Threads Fig. 278L: Left Hand Threads
Size Range: 38" through 2 12" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Features: Through 1 12", inside diameter of eye will accommodate a bolt diameter 18" larger than rod diameter; 1 34" and larger, inside diameter of eye will take a bolt diameter 14" larger than rod diameter. Maximum Temperature: 750 F Ordering: Specify rod diameter, gure number, name, rod length and nish. Specify thread length if other than standard. Note: The acceptability of galvanized coatings at temperatures above 450F is at the discretion of the end user.
WELDED A
L (min)
414 412 512 612 714 814 10 12 14 1512 17
750 F
572 1,057 1,692 2,530 3,508 4,620 7,440 10,807 14,566 19,265 25,295 31,169
D L
Fig. 248X
A L1 L2
WELDED
Fig. 278X
98 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
HANgER RODS
Rod with Eye End
General Table of Notes Contents
Fig. 148
Size Range: 2 34" through 5" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: A large diameter rod with eye end for load ratings thru 184,000 pounds. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name, nish and L dimension. Indicate if desired thread length is other than standard. Note: The acceptability of galvanized coatings at temperatures above 450F is at the discretion of the end user.
T 5 H B E R W
650 F
49,400 60,100 71,900 84,700 98,500 113,400 129,400 146,600 164,700 184,000
750 F
38,687 47,066 56,307 66,331 77,139 88,807 101,337 114,807 128,982 144,096
B
958 11 1214 1212 1378 1518 1614 16 17 1778
E
334
H
318 338 358 378 418 438 458 478 518 538
R
358 4 414 412 478 518 512 534 6 638
35.9 42.9 54.7 67.3 80.0 97.0 127.0 131.0 154.0 175.0
20 24 28 33 37 43 48 54 60 67
19 20 21 24 25 26 30 31 32
12
4 434
112
15
5 514
18
534 614
*Weight calculated with minimum L for standard thread Furnished with 4 UN series threads
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
99
Rod Attachments
Hanger Rods
Max Load
L (Min)
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
L (MIN)
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
ROD ATTACHMENTS
Fig. 135: Straight with Sight-Hole Rod Coupling Fig. 135E: Straight Less Sight-Hole Fig 135, 135E, 135R: Fig. 135R: Reducing LOads (lbs) Weights (lbs) DimensiOns (in)
Size Range: 14" through 1" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Fig. 135: Plain; Fig.135E and Fig.135R Galvanized Service: For connecting rods to accommodate up to 1" diameter and support up to 5,900 pounds. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number and name. Rod Size A Max Load Weight Fig. 135: Straight With Sight-Hole
8 2 5 8 3 4 7 8 1
3 1
D
16 4 15 16 118 1516 112
9 3
L
118 112 178 214 258 3 8 118 134 218 214 212 234
7
730 1,350 2,160 3,230 4,480 5,900 240 730 1,350 2,160 3,230 4,480 5,900 240 730 1,350 2,160 3,230
0.09 0.12 0.24 0.42 0.66 1.00 0.03 0.09 0.14 0.26 0.34 0.55 0.75 0.13 0.13 0.19 0.26 0.41
Sight Hole L D
8 8 11 16 13 16 1 114 138
3 5
8 16 13 16 1 114
5 11
Rod Coupling
Fig. 136, 136R:
LOads (lbs) Weights (lbs) DimensiOns (in)
Rod Size A
1
Max Load
230 730 1,350 2,160 3,230 4,480 5,900
Weight
8 16 16
3 1 5 3 7
8 2 8 4 8
8 x 14 2 x 38
230 730
0.10 0.21
158 218
158 218
100 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
ROD ATTACHMENTS
Turnbuckle Adjuster
A
General Table of Notes Contents Bolts, Nuts, Pins & U-Bolts Rod Hanger Attachments Rods Concrete Inserts & Attachments Ceiling Plates & Flanges
E "B" MAX
Fig. 114
Size Range: 14" through 34" Material: Malleable iron Finish: Plain Installation: Normally used with split pipe ring, Fig. 108, see page 36. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 15), WW-H-171-E (Type 15), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 15). Maximum Temperature: 450 F Features: An economical and simple means of obtaining vertical adjustment and exibility at the pipe connection. Permits adjustment after pipe is in place. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number and name.
2 2
1
378 478
2516
1 9
2 16
Size Range: 14" through 78" Material: Malleable iron Finish: Plain Service: For attaching hanger rod to various types of building attachments Maximum Temperature: 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 16) WW-H-171-E (Type 16), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 16). UL Listed (Sizes 38" - 78") and FM Approved (Sizes 38" and 12"). Installation: Normally used with the split pipe ring Fig. 108, see page 36. Ordering: Specify rod tapping size, gure number and name.
Max Load
650 800 1,000 1,400 2,200 2,300
Weight
0.05 0.07 0.13 0.19 0.31 0.44
B
1
E
118 11132 11732 11316 2532 21132
8 2
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
101
Brackets
Structural Attachments
Fig. 110R
Beam Clamps
Socket Clamps
1 4 178 11316
1
32 32
13
Max Load
Weight
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
ROD ATTACHMENTS
Fig. 157
Size Range: 38" through 78" Material: Malleable iron Finish: Plain or Galvanized Maximum Temperature: 450 F Service: For attaching hanger rod to various types of building attachments. Approvals: UL Listed (38" - 78" rod size) and FM Approved (38" & 1 2" rod size). Installation: May be used to form an integral part of malleable iron beam clamps Fig. 218, see page 69. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish.
H
Extension piece
G
K E C B
B
114 138 112 134 178
C
2116 2516 2716 278 2
Rod Take-Out E
114 138 1716 11116 134
G
1
H
1
K
9 11
8 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
3
2 8 4 2
16 16 3 4
7
16
Size Range: 38" through 2 12" F Material: Forged steel A Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For use on high temperature piping installations. G Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 17), WW-H-171-E (Type 17), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 17). C D E Features: B Supports loads equal to the full limitation of the hanger rod. Provides exible connection when used with straight thread rod. H (max) Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish. If other than standard combination Fig. 290, 290L: LOads (lbs) Weights (lbs) DimensiOns (in) of eye nut number and rod size, Max Load Eye Nut specify eye nut number and special Rod Size Weight B C D E F G H A Number rod tapping size. 650 F 750 F 3 Note: The acceptability of 8 730 572 0.28 13 5 1532 1316 32 11732 3132 8 1 0 1 2 1,350 1,057 0.28 galvanized coatings at temperatures 5 8 2,160 1,692 0.62 above 450F is at the discretion of 1 11 112 1316 2 2 138 16 114 1 3 4 3,230 2,530 0.60 the end user. Larger eye nuts 7 8 4,480 3,508 1.70 3 featuring smaller rod sizes are 2 11116 4 21132 11516 1 134 2 1 5,900 4,620 1.70 commonly available. 1
1 4 112 134 2 214 212 9,500 13,800 18,600 24,600 32,300 39,800 7,440 10,807 14,566 19,265 25,295 31,169 3.60 3.50 16.40 15.90 15.40 14.90 212 4 11316 4 1 338 238 4 114 214 214 3
112
614
334
102 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
ROD ATTACHMENTS
Forged Steel Clevis
General Table of Notes Contents Bolts, Nuts, Pins & U-Bolts Rod Hanger Attachments Rods Concrete Inserts & Attachments Ceiling Plates & Flanges Brackets Structural Attachments Beam Clamps
P D T GRIP T
Fig. 299
W B
Max Load
650 F 730 1,350 2,160 3,230 4,480 5,900 9,500 13,800 18,600 24,600 32,300 39,800 49,400 60,100 71,900 84,700 98,500 113,400 750 F 572 1,057 1,692 2,530 3,508 4,620 7,440 10,807 14,566 19,265 25,295 31,169 38,687 47,066 56,307 66,331 77,139 88,807
Weight
Without Pin 0.9 0.7 0.7 2.5 2.5 4.0 3.8 6.0 8.0 16.0 26.0 25.5 36.0 35.0 90.0 88.0 86.0 84.0 With Pin 1.0 0.9 0.9 3.0 3.4 5.1 5.5 8.5 12.9 23.3 35.1 36.0 50.0 51.5 116.0 118.0 120.0 122.0
D
1 16
7
N
5
Pin Dia. P
2 8 3 4 7 8 1 118 138 158 178 214 212 234 3 314 312 334 4 414
1 5
T
5
W
1116 1516 112
Grip
1 5
Clevis No.
2 212 3 312 4 5 6 7
16 16
4 5 6 7 8 9
212 3 312 4 5 6 7
2 8 4 8
8 3 4 7 8 1 114 112
5 3
212
10
112
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
103
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
Size Range: 38" through 4" Material: Forged steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For use on high temperature piping installations. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 14), WW-H-171-E (Type 14), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 14). Features: Available with pin and cotter pins, if required. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish. If pin and cotter pins are required, specify with pin. If other than standard combination of clevis number and rod size is required, specify clevis number, special rod tapping size, pin size, grip. Note: The acceptability of galvanized coatings at temperatures above 450F is at the discretion of the end user.
ROD ATTACHMENTS
Fig. 230
Size Range: 38" through 2 12" Material: Forged steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Provides adjustment up to 6" for 12" Fig. 230 and 3" for 6" Fig. 230. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 13), WW-H-171-E (Type 13), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 13). Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, A name and nish. Note: The acceptability of galvanized coatings at temperatures above 450F is at the discretion of the end user.
1 2B B" ROD TAKE OUT
Turnbuckle
Fig. 230: LOads (lbs) Weights (lbs) DimensiOns (in)
Max Load Rod Size A 650F 750F
3 1 5 3 7
8 2 8 4 8
730 1,350 2,160 3,230 4,480 5,900 9,500 13,800 18,600 24,600 32,300 39,800
572 1,057 1,692 2,530 3,508 4,620 7,440 10,807 14,566 19,265 25,295 31,169
1 114 112 1 4
3
2 214 212
Tapped right hand and left hand thread. Larger rod sizes or openings available upon request
Fig. 233
Size Range: 1 14" through 5" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Services: Provides adjustments up to 12" with loads up thru 184,000 pounds. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 13), WW-H-171-E (Type 13), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 13). Ordering: Specify rod size, A gure number, name, nish and opening dimension.
F
Turnbuckle
Max Load
9,500 13,800 18,600 24,600 32,300 39,800 49,400 60,100 71,900 84,700 98,500 113,400 129,400 146,600 164,700 184,000
F
218 238 3316 314 312 31316 4716 5 61316
C L
Sight Holes
Furnished with 4 UN series threads. *Tapped right hand and left hand thread.
104 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 291
Size Range: 12" through 4" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Maximum Temperature: 650 F Service: For use with type C variable spring hanger, type C constant support (Fig. 81-H only) and Fig. 66 welded beam attachment. Ordering: Specify pin diameter, gure number, name, nish and if cotter pins are required. Note: The acceptability of galvanized coatings at temperatures above 450F is at the discretion of the end user.
L W E D
Weight
0.12 0.18 0.29 0.47 0.67 1.00 2.10 3.30 4.80 7.20 9.30 12.50 16.60 20.00 23.90 25.10 34.80
L
278 318 358 4 4
1
W
218 238 278 312 314 4 438 5 578
H
5
2 8 4 8
32
8 x 114
8
7
16 x 112
3
32 16 x 2
1 1
32
4 x 212
1 3
4 x 3 8 x 3
3 5
6 8
3
8 x 314 8 x 334
3
8 x 4 2 x 5
2
1
2 x 6
9 4
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
105
Size Range: American Standard hexagon head bolts with American Standard hexagon nuts are stocked in sizes 38" through 1 18" UNC thread series. Other sizes are available upon request. Lengths of bolts are measured from under head to extreme point. Finish: Plain or Electroplated Ordering: Specify bolt size, name and length.
Machine Bolts
Size Range: American Standard hexagon nuts sizes 14" thru 1 12". American Standard heavy hexagon at nuts sizes 1 34" thru 3 34". Finish: Plain or Electroplated Ordering: Specify bolt or rod size and name.
Hex Nuts: DimensiOns (in)
Hexagon Nuts
HeavY Hex Nuts: DimensiOns (in)
Width
16 16 3 4 15 16 118 1516 112 178 2116 214
7 9
Thickness
64 32 29 64 9 16 43 64 25 32 57 64 3 1 32 11364 1516
15 11
Width
234 318 312 378 414 458 5 538 534
Thickness
12532 2132 21964 23564 21316 3116 3516 3916 31316
106 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Rod Max Normal 650 F Pipe Load Size Max Side Size A 650 F 750 F Load
2 4 1 114 112 2 212 3 312 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30 36
1 3
n
580
454
145
1,460
1,144
365
2,700
2,114
675
5 3
8 4
11,800
9,240
0.11 0.12 0.12 0.28 0.30 0.33 0.73 0.78 0.84 0.90 1.0 2.0 2.3 4.9 7.7 8.3 9.2 13.5 14.6 16.9 19.1 23.2
16 1 8 138 11116 2 7 2 16 21516 3916 4116 4916 558 634 834 1078 1278 1418 1618 1818 2018 2418 3018 3618
15 1
1316 138 158 2116 238 21316 3716 4116 4916 5116 618 738 938 1158 1334 15 17 1918 2118 2518 3118 3718
2 4
3
218
278 3 314 334 4 414 412 5 618 718 838 958 1014 1114 1258 1358 1558 1858 2158
F E
212
2 4
1
434
358
Loads, weights and dimensions shown do not apply for Fig. 137S. Max load rating for carbon steel is based on 2 x load rating for rod. Max load rating for stainless steel is 0.85 times the maximum stated load ratings listed above.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
107
Beam Clamps
Wt.
Socket Clamps
Clevis Hangers
Pipe Rings
U-Bolts
Rod Size A
1
Max Load
580 1,460
Weight
0.11 0.12 0.12 0.28 0.30 0.33 0.73 0.78 0.84 0.90 1.00 2.00 2.30
B
15
C
1 16 138 158 2116 238 21316 3716 4116 4916 5116 618 738 938
3
D
2 4
3
E
218 212
F
2 16 2732 2332 2132
5
C B A
4 8
2,700
4,320
16 1 8 3 8 11 16
F E D
2116 2516
C L
214 2732
PLASTIC COATING
334
21316
Fig. 120
Size Range: 12" through 10" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for support, or guide of relatively light loads. Normally used with two hex nuts. Maximum Temperature: 650 F. Ordering: Specify pipe size x rod size, gure number and name. Hex nuts must be ordered separately. Note: The acceptability of galvanized coatings at temperatures above 450F is at the discretion of the end user.
Max Load
Weight
0.06 0.07 0.07 0.08 0.09 0.10 0.28 0.31 0.35 0.38 0.45 0.95 1.20 2.30
Rod Size A
B
16 118 138 11116 2 2716 21516 3916 4116 4916 558 634 834 1078
15
C
1 16 138 158 11516 214 21116 3516 31516 4716 41516 6 714 914 1112
3
D
1 16 2116 2316 238 2716 21116 3116 338 358 378 4916 5116 6116 714
15
C B A
580
134
E D
1,460
C L
2,700 4,320
1 5
2 8
214 212
108 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
STRApS
Strap Short
Straps Pipe Supports Index Technical Data Master Format 3 Part Specs. Application Examples Special Design Products Snubbers Sway Strut Assembly Vibration Control & Sway Brace Constant Supports Spring Hangers
1
Fig. 262
Size Range: 12" through 4" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Maximum Temperature: 650 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 26), WW-H-171-E (Type 26), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 26). Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish. Note: The acceptability of galvanized coatings at temperatures above 450F is at the discretion of the end user.
Pipe Size
B
Max Load
w/Lag w/Bolts Screws to Steel
Weight
0.20 0.23 0.26 0.36 0.54 0.60 1.40 1.60 1.80 1.90
C
234 318 312 334 418 518 5916 6116 6916 718
D
2 16 11 16 1116 138 114 134 178 2316 238
1 11
E
118 1716 158 218 212 234 358 4 458 5
C L
D E
300
410
450
610
4 438 434 5 538 638 Two #18 x 3 61316 steel wood 7516 screws or 13 two 38" bolts 7 16 838 to steel
114
112
Fig. 126
Size Range: 38" through 4" Material: Malleable iron Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For support of standard conduit, cable and steel pipe on walls or sides of beams. Not recommended for use horizontally on ceilings, bottoms of beams and similar installations since the factor of safety is greatly reduced when so used. Maximum Temperature: 450 F Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish. Specify nominal size of conduit or pipe or outside diameter of lead cable with which the clamp is to be used. Fig. 126: Weights (lbs) Pipe Size
C L
One-Hole Clamp
DimensiOns (in)
Dia. of Hole - A
1
Weight
0.03 0.03 0.05 0.09 0.12 0.16 0.25 0.49 0.82 1.30
A
n
16 8
3 7
16 16 4
8 8
11 3
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
109
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
STRApS
Fig. 243
Size Range: 12" through 6" pipe Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain Service: Restraint of pipe in specied direction while permitting movement in non-restrained direction. Maximum Temperature: 650 F Ordering: Specify gure number, name, and pipe size. Larger sizes available upon request.
Pipe Strap
L
3 312 4 412 5 512 6 612 712 934
T
1
W
2
Pn
116
C L FIELD WELD L T W
1,500 2,500
4 6
2,800 3,000
Fig. 244
Size Range: 12" through 6" pipe Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain Service: Restraint of pipe in specied direction while permitting movement in non-restrained direction. Maximum Temperature: 650 F Ordering: Specify gure number, name, and pipe size. Larger sizes available upon request.
Pipe Strap
Rated Load Ps Pn
250 1,500
L
1 1316 1716 134 2 212 3 378 434 634
T
1
W
2
Weight
0.39 0.47 0.56 1.62 1.81 2.20 3.56 5.74 7.16 15.32
Pn
116
500
2,000
Ps
C L FIELD WELD L T W
650 700
2,300
4 6
110 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
pIpE SUppORTS
Pipe Stanchion
Straps Pipe Supports Index Technical Data Master Format 3 Part Specs. Application Examples Special Design Products Snubbers Sway Strut Assembly Vibration Control & Sway Brace Constant Supports Spring Hangers Sway Brace Seismic Pipe Guides & Slides Pipe Roll Pipe Shields & Saddles Trapeze
Size Range: 2" through 18" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Stanchion type of support for stationary pipe where vertical adjustment is required. Maximum Temperature: Plain 650 F, Galvanized 450 F Ordering: Specify gure number, type, pipe size, top stanchion size, material specication and D dimension. For base plates that require holes, also specify hole size, and the center line to center line of the holes.
C L
Vent Hole
Vent Hole
Vent Hole
DimensiOns (in)
Top Stanchion
112 212 4 5
212
Bottom Stanchion
2 Std. 3 Std. 5 Sch. 80 6 Sch. 80
3 3
Base Plate
8 x 6 x 6 8 x 10 x 10 3 8 x 10 x 10 3 8 x 10 x 10
3 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18
Weight (Lbs)
Indicates available stanchion size for pipe or elbow size. Weights based on a "D" dimension of 2'-0".
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
111
pIpE SUppORTS
Pipe Stanchion
Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Maximum Temperature: Plain 650 F, Galvanized 450 F To Order Specify: Type A, B, C: Figure Number, Type, Pipe Size, Stanchion Size, Material Specication and D Dimension. Type P: Figure Number, Type, Saddle Size, Stanchion Size, Material Specication and H Dimension. Type T: Figure Number, Type, Saddle Figure Number and Size, Stanchion Size, Material Specication and H Dimension. For base plates that require holes, also specify hole size, and the center line to center line of the holes.
C L C L C L H
1
Stanchion
Stanchion Stanchion
Base Plate
Base Plate
Base Plate
Fig. 63, Type P Square Cut End for use with Figure 258 or 259 Pipe Saddle Support (See pages 114 & 117)
Fig. 63, Type T Square Cut Threaded End for use with Figure 264 or 265 Adjustable Pipe Saddle Support (See pages 115 & 116)
DimensiOns (in)
Stanchion Base Plate Size
112
3
212
10 12 14 16 20 24
2 212 3 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 20 24
3
8 x 6 x 6
8 x 8 x 8
8 x 10 x 10 8 x 14 x 14 2 x 18 x 18 2 x 20 x 20 2 x 22 x 22 2 x 24 x 24 2 x 30 x 30 Fig. 63 Stanchion
1 1 1 1
Weight (Lbs) 9.5 11.6 16.4 23.7 31.8 47.0 59.0 100.0 164.0 201.0 230.0 282.0 374.0 515.0 Indicates available stanchion size for pipe or elbow size for Types A, B, or C stanchions. Weights based on a "D" dimension of 2'-0". See Figure 258, 259, 264, or 265 dimensional data for required stanchion pipe size (nominal pipe size A).
112 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
pIpE SUppORTS
Adjustable Pipe Saddle
Straps Pipe Supports Index Technical Data Master Format 3 Part Specs. Application Examples
8" A C
Fig. 192
Size Range: 2" through 12" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Stanchion type support for stationary pipe where vertical adjustment is required. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 38), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 38). Ordering: Specify pipe size to be supported, gure number, name and nish.
C L
120
Pipe Size
2 212 3 312 4 5 6 8 10 12
Rod Size A
5
E
9716 91116 10 1014 1012 11 111116 121116 1378 1478
Weight
E
4 x 1
4 x 114 8 x 112
1
1 114
Size Range: 2" through 12" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Stanchion type support where vertical adjustment is required, plus the additional stability provided by U-bolt attachment to stationary pipe. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 37), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 37). Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish.
C L
Rod Size A
5
C
2 16 3516 31516 4716 514 618 714 938 1112 1312
11
E
9 16 91116 10 1014 1012 11 111116 121116 1378 1478
7 1
G
4 x 1
Weight
1.2 1.4 1.6 2.6 3.0 3.2 4.9 6.2 10.5 11.8
8 8
4 x 114 8 x 112
1
1 114
2 x 2
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
113
Snubbers
Fig. 191
2 x 2
1.0 1.4 1.6 2.6 3.0 3.2 4.9 6.2 10.5 11.8
8"
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
pIpE SUppORTS
Fig. 258
Size Range: 4" through 36" Material: Sizes 4" through 12" are Cast Iron. Sizes 14" through 36" are Carbon Steel. Sizes 4" through 12" are available in Carbon Steel by special request only. Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Stanchion type support for stationary pipe. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 36), WW-H-171-E (Type 36 & 37), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 36). Installation: Slip saddle base into riser pipe. Ordering: Specify size to be supported, gure number, name, nish and material. Order Separately: Figure 63P Square Cut End Stanchion. Specify "H" and pipe size to be supported by Figure 258.
C L
C L C B
Stanchion
3" A NOM. PIPE SIZE
Base Plate
Fig. 63, Type P Square Cut End for use with Figure 258 or 259 Pipe Saddle Support
Weight
9.1 10.8 11.8 14.3 19.3 23.1 15.0 16.0 23.0 24.0 26.0 30.0 32.0 41.0 42.0 46.0
B
4316 41316 5716 61516 8716 91516 1012 1112 1312 1412 1512 1712 1812 2058 2158 2358
Width C
Max Load
358
3,800
5,300 6,700
5 7,300 834
The above load ratings are applicable to the saddle only and are not applicable to the stanchion or other means used to support the saddle.
114 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
pIpE SUppORTS
Adjustable Pipe Saddle Support
Straps Pipe Supports Index Technical Data Master Format 3 Part Specs. Application Examples Special Design Products Snubbers Sway Strut Assembly Vibration Control & Sway Brace Constant Supports
3"
Fig. 264
C L
C L C B
A
212
B
312 334 4 414 478 512 678 812 91516 101516 1238 1378 1538 1512 171516 1812 21516 2212 2412
D
112
E
8 814 812 914 10 1012 1134 1312 15 1614 1734 1912 21 21516 2334 24516 27 2814 3014
Min
212
3 312
13 1314 1312 14 1434 1514 1612 1814 1934 2034 2214 24 2512 251316 2814 281316 3112 3234 3434
Max
Width C
3
Max Load
1,800
358
3,800
458
5,300 6,700
* The special cast iron reducer may be furnished with a hexed shaped smaller end. * Standard Wall Pipe The above load ratings are applicable to the saddle only and are not applicable to the stanchion or other means used to support the saddle.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
115
Spring Hangers
Size Range: 2 12" through 36" Material: Cast iron saddle, locknut nipple and special cast iron reducer, assembled. Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Stanchion type support where vertical adjustment of stationary pipe is required. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 38), WW-H-171-E (Type 39), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 38). Installation: Adjustment is obtained by turning the locknut nipple. The lower end of the nipple is staked, upsetting the threads to prevent separation of nipple and coupling during adjustment. Features: Vertical adjustment of approximately 4 12" Saddle supports a broad range of pipe sizes Ordering: Specify pipe size to be supported, gure number, name and nish. Order Separately: Figure 63T Square Cut Threaded End Stanchion. Specify "H" and pipe size to be supported by Figure 264.
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
pIpE SUppORTS
Fig. 265
Size Range: 4" through 36" Material: Cast iron saddle, steel yoke and nuts, steel locknut nipple and special cast iron reducer. (14" through 36" carbon steel saddle with steel yoke. 4" through 12" steel saddle available upon special request) Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Stanchion type support where vertical adjustment is required, plus the additional stability provided by U-bolt attachment to pipe. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 38), WW-H-171-E (Type 39), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 38). Installation: Adjustment is obtained by turning the locknut nipple. The lower end of the nipple is staked, upsetting the threads to prevent separation of nipple and coupling during adjustment. Features: Vertical adjustment of approximately 4 12" Saddle supports a broad range of pipe sizes Ordering: Specify pipe size to be supported, gure number, name and nish. Order Separately: Figure 63T Square Cut Threaded End Stanchion. Specify "H" and pipe size to be supported by Figure 265.
C
C L
C L
3"
B
4316 41316 5716 61516 8716 91516 1012 1112 1312 1412 1512 1712 1812 2058 2158 2358
E
912 1018 1034 1214 1334 1458 151316 161316 1918 2018 21516 23516 24516 26716 27716 29716
Min
312
14 1458 1514 1634 1814 1918 20516 21516 2358 2458 251316 271316 281316 301516 311516 331516
Max
Width C
358
Max Load
3,800
* The special cast iron reducer may be furnished with a hexed shaped smaller end. * Standard Wall Pipe The above load ratings are applicable to the saddle only and are not applicable to the stanchion or other means used to support the saddle.
116 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
pIpE SUppORTS
Pipe Saddle Support with U-Bolt
Straps Pipe Supports Index Technical Data Master Format 3 Part Specs. Application Examples Special Design Products Snubbers Sway Strut Assembly Vibration Control & Sway Brace Constant Supports Spring Hangers
B
Fig. 259
Size Range: 4" through 36" pipe Material: Cast iron stanchion saddle with steel yoke and nuts. 14" through 36" carbon steel saddle with steel yoke. 4" through 12" steel saddle available on special request. Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Stanchion type support with additional stability provided by U-bolt attachment to pipe. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 37), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 37). Installation: Same as pipe saddle support Fig. 258, except that yoke is attached to saddle after pipe is in place. Features: U-bolt yoke provides stability. Ordering: Specify pipe size to be supported, gure number, name, material and nish. Order Separately: Figure 63P Square Cut End Stanchion. Specify "H" and pipe size to be supported by Figure 259.
C
C L
C L
3"
Weight
10.8 12.1 12.7 21.3 25.7 31.2 28.0 31.0 40.0 43.0 46.0 52.0 55.0 69.0 73.0 81.0
B
4316 41316 5716 61516 8716 91516 1012 1112 1312 1412 1512 1712 1812 2058 2158 2358
Width C
Max Load
358
3,800
Stanchion
Base Plate
Fig. 63, Type P Square Cut End for use with Figure 258 or 259 Pipe Saddle Support
* Standard Wall Pipe The above load ratings are applicable to the saddle only and are not applicable to the stanchion or other means used to support the saddle.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
117
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
TRApEZE
Fig. 46
Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Trapeze assembly is to be suspended by two rods with Fig. 60 washer plates and is designed for top loading exclusively. Ordering: Specify size number, gure number, name, nish, C to C dimension and hole size H. If holes J or hole D are required, also specify hole size and dimensions K and M or B. Note: Larger C to C dimensions are available upon request.
L N K C TO C M K N
B D HOLE
(2 PLACES)
J HOLE
(2 PLACES)
H HOLE
28
30
36
42
48
54
60
4 x 2 x 2 4 x 3 x 2 4 x 4 x 4 4 x 6 x 4 4 x 8 x 4
118 158 1 8
7
15
17
19
21 23
1
23 25
1
25 27
1
27 29
1
29 31
1
31 33
1
33 35
1
39 41
1
47
1
53
1
59
1
65
16 x 4 x 3
1 1 1
23 4 25 4 27 4 29 4 31 4 33 4 35 4 41 4 47 4 53 4 59 4 6514 3034 3234 3434 3634 4234 4834 5434 6034 6634 32 34 36 38 44 50 56 62 68
238 278
338 4
Size
1 2 3 4 5 6
Fig. 46: Maximum LOad (lbs); Based On C tO C DimensiOns at Max Temperature Of 250 F
12
2,600 6,700
14
2,300 5,700
16
1,900 5,000
18
1,700 4,500 5,800 10,200
20
1,500 4,000 5,200 9,100
22
1,400 3,600 4,800 8,300
24
1,300 3,300 4,400 7,500
26
1,200 3,100 3,900 7,000
28
1,100 2,800 3,600 6,500
30
1,000 2,700 3,500 6,100 9,600
36
8,80 2,200 2,900 5,100 8,000
42
2,500 4,300 6,800
48
2,200 3,800 6,000
54
1,900 3,300 5,300 8,800
60
1,700 3,000 4,800 8,000
118 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
TRApEZE
Fig. 45
Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Ordering: Fig. 45 channel assembly; channel size, rod size, name, nish and C to C. Note: that L = (C to C) + 2M + W Note: Can also be used with a U-bolt Fig. 137 & Fig. 60 washer plates to secure pipe to the center of channel assembly.
L M CC W
Channel Assembly
8 16
4 16
8 16
1 1116 4
1
114 138 4
1
112 158 5
1
134 178 5
3
2 214 5
3
214 212 5
3
212 234 6
3
234 3 6
3
3 314 6
3
314 312 6
3
312 334 6
3
334 4 7
3
16
11
13
15
3
1
3
1
4 8
4
3
2 8
2 8
2 8
4 8
4 8
4 8
4 8
4 8
4 8
4 2
4 2
4 2
8
3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 1 1 1
3 4 5 6 8 10 12 15
8,800
7,500
6,600
5,800
5,200 9,100
4,800 8,300
4,400 7,500
3,900 7,000
3,600 6,500
26,600 24,000 21,800 20,000 18,400 17,100 16,000 13,300 11,400 10,000
53,500 49,400 45,800 42,800 35,700 30,600 26,700 23,800 21,400 57,000 48,900 42,800 38,000 34,200 111,000 95,300 83,400 74,100 66,700
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
119
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
114
112
134
214
212
234
314
312
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
H DIA.
Pipe Roll
Straps
TRApEZE
Fig. 50
Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Ordering: If two holes H are required: Specify Fig. 50 angle (nominal size, C to C, H, total weight and load) If two holes H and hole D are required: Specify Fig. 50 angle (nominal size, B, C to C, D, H, total weight and load) If two holes H and two holes J are required: Specify Fig. 50 angle (nominal size, C to C, H, J, K, M, total weight and load)
L N K C TO C M K H HOLE N G
(2 PLACES)
D HOLE
(2 PLACES)
J HOLE
Weight Per/Ft
2.34 3.19 4.70 5.90 7.20 9.40 12.80
G
7
N
114
118 1 8
3
8 4
112
1 134 2 114 2
3 x 8
3 1
3 x 2 4 x 12
134 212
120 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 167
Size Range: 12" through 24" pipe with up to 2" thick insulation Material: Carbon steel Finish: Galvanized Service: Recommended for outside of foam or ber glass insulation for distribution of loads to preclude crushing of insulation without breaking the vapor barrier. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 40), WW-H-171-E (Type 41), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 40). How to size: Refer to shield size selection table below. Ordering: Specify size, gure number and name. Data applicable to shields for thicker insulation or larger pipe sizes is available upon request.
Weight
0.5 0.7 0.8 1.0 1.1 1.3 1.4 1.6 1.9 2.7 3.1 4.0 4.6 5.1 5.6 10.2 11.1 12.3 12.7 13.6 14.5 21.2 22.4 23.6 24.8 25.9 27.1 28.3 31.0 31.8 33.0
Stock Size
Insulation OD
1.90 2.38 2.88 3.50 4.00 4.50 5.00 5.56 6.64 7.64 8.64 7.64 8.64 9.64 10.76 11.76 12.76 14.00 15.00 16.00 17.00 18.00 19.00 20.00 21.00 22.00 23.00 24.00 26.00 27.00 28.00
Fig. 260
11/2 2 21/2 3 31/2 4 5 5 6 8 8 8 8 10 10 12 12 14 16 16 18 18 20 20 24 24 24 24 30 30 30
4 1A
3
2A 3A 4A 5A 6A
12
3A 4A 5A
7A 8A 9A 10B 11B 13C 15C 17C 18C 20C 22C 24C 27C
16 Ga.
10A 11B 12B 14C 16C 18C 19C 21C 23C 25C 28C
16 Ga.
18
14 Ga.
24 12 Ga.
X1A 1A 2A 3A 4A 5A 6A 7A 8A 9A 11B
1A 2A 3A 4A 5A 6A 7A 8A 9A 11B
2A 3A 4A 5A 6A 7A 8A 9A 10A 12B
INSULATION THICKNESS
Note: As actual foam or ber glass insulation thicknesses vary, verify that the radius of the selected shield is suitable for the required application. Shields are designed for a maximum span of ten feet on 15 P.S.I. compressive strength insulation. For compressive strengths greater than 15 P.S.I., spans may be increased proportionately up to maximum allowable for steel pipe. Refer to MSS-SP-69 for specic guidelines on compressive strength and maximum span.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
121
Index
Technical Data
C L
3A 4A 5A 6A 7A
5A 6A 7A
Shading in gray indicates this shield ts loosely inside the Fig. 260. To be used properly, the Fig. 260 requires a spacer.
INSULATION O.D.
Application Examples
Snubbers
9A
Constant Supports
2A
6A
Spring Hangers
1A
112 4A 5A
2 6A 7A 7A 8A 8A
18 Ga.
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Fig. 168
Size Range: 12" through 8" pipe or copper tube with up to 2" insulation Material: Carbon steel Finish: Galvanized Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 40), WW-H-171-E (Type 41), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 40). Service: To be used with Fig. 65 or Fig. 260 clevis. Designed to prevent damage to insulation by hanger. Ribs keep shield centered in hanger. How to size: Refer to shield size selection table below. Ordering: Specify size, gure number and name. Note: Data applicable to shields for thicker insulation or larger pipe size is available upon request.
Rib-Lok Shield
1 2 3 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2
1
2 6 7
Stock Sizes
Weight
0.41 0.50 0.61 0.69 0.78 0.99 1.09 1.28 1.51 2.24 2.48 2.76 3.03 3.28
Fig. 260
2 212 3 312 4 5 5 6 8 8 10 10 12 12
1 2
4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 13
2 3 4 5
3 4 5 6
18 ga. x 8
8 9 10 11 12 14
9 10 12
18 ga. x 12
Shading in gray indicates this shield ts loosely inside the Fig. 260. To be used properly, the Fig. 260 requires a spacer.
2
5 6 7
INSULATION O.D. INSULATION THICKNESS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 11
8 9 10 11 12 14
C L
2"
122 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Size Range: 34" through 36" Material: Figs. 160, 161, 162, 163, 164, and 165 are curved carbon steel plate. Figs. 165A and 166A are alloy steel manufactured from ASTM A 387 Grade 22 Chrome Molybdenum steel plate. Figs. 165A and 166A have a welded-in center plate in all sizes. All other saddles have a welded-in center plate for pipe sizes 12" and larger. All saddles are 12" long with side edges turned up. Finish: Plain Service: Designed for use on insulated high temperature systems where heat losses are to be kept to a minimum and to protect insulation against damage. Maximum Temperature: 650 F carbon steel, 950 F alloy steel. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 39A & 39B), WW-H-171-E (Type 40A & 40B), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 39A & 39B). Features: Permits nished, weather tight covering at all points of pipe support. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number and name. Data for 42" size available on request. Installation: It is recommended that saddle be welded to the pipe.
C L
C L
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
123
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Fig. 160: 1" Fig. 163: 212" Fig. 165A: 4" (Alloy)
Fig. 161: 112" Fig. 164: 3" Fig. 166A: 512" (Alloy)
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Fig. 160, 161, 162, 163, 164, 165, 165A, 166A: LOads (lbs) Weight (lbs) DimensiOns (in)
Size of Pipe Roll Max Load n Weight
Figs. 171, 175, 177 Figs. 174, 181 Figs. 271, 274, 277
1,200
1,200
114
1,200
1 2
1
1,200
1,200
212
1,200
1,200
312
1,200
1,200
7,200
1.4 2.1 2.8 1.4 2.1 2.8 1.4 2.1 2.8 3.6 1.5 2.1 3.2 3.6 1.7 2.3 3.2 3.6 4.5 1.7 2.8 3.2 4.1 4.5 1.9 2.8 3.6 4.1 4.9 2.3 3.2 3.6 4.5 4.9 2.3 3.2 3.6 4.5 4.9 6.1 11.6 15.7
2-312
2-312
2-312 4-6 2-312 4-6 2-312 4-6 2-312 4-6 2-312 4-6 8-10 4-6 8-10 4-6 8-10 12-14
2116 234 3516 2516 278 312 212 3116 358 438 258 314 4 412 3 312 414 434 538 314 4 412 518 558 312 4516 41316 5716 6 4 4916 518 558 6516 414 478 538 51516 6916 758 958
218 234 3516 214 278 312 2716 3116 358 438 258 314 4 458 21516 312 414 41316 538 314 4 458 518 534 312 4516 41316 5716 6 4 4916 518 558 6516 414 478 538 51516 6916 758 912
214 278 338 2716 3 312 2916 3316 31116 438 21116 3516 378 412 3116 3916 4316 434 514 3516 31516 412 5 512 3916 414 41116 5516 6116 31516 412 5 51116 638 4316 434 514 6 658 7916 9516
10 14
12 16
n
Maximum recommended loads are applicable only when saddle is used on a at bearing surface or roller hangers and tack welded to pipe. When saddle is used with a pipe roll, the maximum load for the assembly is the smaller of the two loads. Saddles may require notching when used with a U-bolt.
124 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 160, 161, 162, 163, 164, 165, 165A, 166A: LOads (lbs) Weight (lbs) DimensiOns (in)
Size of Pipe Roll Max Load n Weight
Figs. 171, 175, 177 Figs. 174, 181 Figs. 271, 274, 277
1,200
7,200
1,800
12 14 16 10 12 14 16 18 12 14 16 18 20 14 16 18 20 24 16 18 20 24
7,200
18 12 14 16 18 20 14 16 18 20 16 18 20 18 20
1,800
81116 1014 714 758 818 81116 934 91116 1118 8116 858 918 958 101316 11 12516 834 9516 978 10516 11516 11916 1278
1018 111316 812 9 9916 10116 1114 912 10116 10916 1118 1018 101316 1138 1134
978 1158 8516 81316 9516 10 1118 1212 914 10 1012 11 12316 1238 131116 10116 101116 11316 1158 1258 1278 1414
10
5,000
11,140
5,000
16-20
14
11,140
22-24
n
Maximum recommended loads are applicable only when saddle is used on a at bearing surface or roller hangers and tack welded to pipe. When saddle is used with a pipe roll, the maximum load for the assembly is the smaller of the two loads. Saddles may require notching when used with a U-bolt.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
125
Index
Technical Data
22-24 12-14
Application Examples
12
16-20
7,200
Snubbers
1,800
7,200
Constant Supports
16
12-14
Spring Hangers
2.3 3.2 3.6 4.5 4.9 6.1 11.6 15.7 3.8 4.4 5.7 6.5 7.7 10.2 12.9 16.3 5.8 6.3 7.2 7.7 10.2 16.9 22.6 5.8 7.7 8.2 8.8 10.8 18.9 24.3 7.8 9.9 10.5 11.4 14.0 28.0 35.5 7.8 9.9 10.5 11.4 14.0 27.6 35.5
6 8
8 10
4-6 8-10
10 12 16 8 10
14 16 8 10 12
718 81116 412 5116 512 6316 6916 7916 758 918 6 612 714 71116
8316 978 514 6 612 714 758 834 81316 10716 7116 7916 8516 834
12
41316 512 6 6916 718 8316 818 10116 538 578 6716 718 758 9 918 1058 7116 7916 8516 9 1018 10116 1178 8516 9116 9916 1018 1114 11516 121516 912 10316 101116 1118 1238 1212 1414 10316 1078 11516 1134 1278 13116 1434
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Fig. 160, 161, 162, 163, 164, 165, 165A, 166A: LOads (lbs) Weight (lbs) DimensiOns (in)
Size of Pipe Roll Max Load n Weight
Figs. 171, 175, 177 Figs. 174, 181 Figs. 271, 274, 277
16
18
13,370
7,200
20
13,370
7,200
24
13,370
7,200
30
13,370
7,200
36
13,370
8.4 10.4 11.1 13.3 15.3 30.1 40.0 9.1 10.4 12.4 13.3 15.3 40.3 52.1 10.4 11.6 12.4 13.4 22.8 44.8 52.1 12.3 13.4 14.3 20.3 23.1 45.4 52.1 13.3 14.0 20.0 21.4 24.0 47.9 55.6 18.0 18.9 20.2 21.6 24.1 48.3 55.8
18 20 24 30 20
20
16-20
24 30 24
22-24
26-30 22-24
30
26-30
30
26-30
36-42
36-42
1114 11316 12516 1278 1418 14516 1658 12516 1278 13916 14316 1514 151116 1758 13916 1418 141116 1514 17 17316 181516 16516 1678 1712 18116 1914 1912
1114 1134
1118 11916 12316 12716 1358 1378 1558 12316 121116 13116 1358 1434 1518 1658 13116 1358 14316 1434 1578 1618 1778 1514 1534 16716 17 18316 18716 1934 1878 1938 191516 2012 2112 2134 2338 2218 2258 23316 231116 241116 25 2612
n
Maximum recommended loads are applicable only when saddle is used on a at bearing surface or roller hangers and tack welded to pipe. When saddle is used with a pipe roll, the maximum load for the assembly is the smaller of the two loads. Saddles may require notching when used with a U-bolt.
126 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
pIpE ROLL
Fig. 177
Pipe Size
C L A H
Weight
1.1 1.2 1.2 1.3 2.3 2.4 2.7 3.8 4.7 7.6 11.0 13.7 19.4 31.2 42.5 46.6 66.2 102.5 186.8
B
3 3 8
3
C
112 1 8
7
H
1116 1 4
1
1 1 4
1
138 158 11516 214 12 2916 21316 3716 4 518 638 7716 838 9716 18 1012 1158 24 14 17716
3 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30
4 5 6 8 10 14 16 18 20 24 30 No Recom.
5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18
4 8
20 24 30
1 4
1
112
35 2
1
30 4
1
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
127
Index
2878
2414
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
Size Range: 1" through 30" Material: Cast iron roll and sockets; steel roll rod, continuous thread rods and hex nuts Finish: Plain, Galvanized or Resilient Coated Service: For support of pipe where longitudinal movement due to expansion and contraction will occur and where vertical adjustment up to 6" may be necessary. Maximum Temperature: 450 F at roller, 300 F at Resilent coated roller. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 41), WW-H-171-E (Type 42), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 41). Installation: Normally used directly above steel beams, brackets angles, etc. Features: Advantages of pipe rollers with a protective resilient coated covering. Non conductive pipe rollers - prevent the passing of current from pipeline to structure. Corrosion resistant - for protection against severe weather conditions, moderate corrosive conditions such as marine atmospheres and weather resistant to ultra-violet radiation. Low coefcient of friction between pipe and resilient coated pipe roller. How to size: (1) If roll is to support bare pipe, select the size directly from nominal pipe size (see below). (2) If used with pipe covering protection saddle, see page 123 for size of pipe roll. (3) If roll is to support covered pipe, the O.D. of the covering should not be greater than the O.D. of the pipe for which the roll was designed. Ordering: Specify size of roll, gure number and name. Be certain to order oversized rolls when insulation and protection saddles makes this necessary.
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Pipe Guides Pipe Roll Pipe Shields & Slides & Saddles
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
pIpE ROLL
Size Range: 1" through 30" Material: Cast iron roll and sockets, steel roll rod Finish: Plain, Galvanized or Resilient Coated Service: For suspension of pipe from two rods where longitudinal expansion and contraction may occur. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 41), WW-H-171-E (Type 42), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 41). Adjustment: Adjustable socket permits vertical adjustment at the roll. Maximum Temperature: 450 F at roller, 300 F at resilient coated roller. How to size: (1) If the roll is to support non-insulated pipe, select the size directly from nominal pipe size (column 1) in table below. (2) If used with pipe covering protection saddle, see page 123 for size of pipe roll. Features: Provides for vertical adjustment; nut at bottom of hanger rod ts into the socket preventing loosening or turning due to vibration. Pipe roll is designed for two point surface contact with pipe or saddle. Features: Advantages of pipe rollers with a protective resilient coated covering. Non conductive pipe rollers - prevent the passing of current from pipeline C L to structure. Corrosion resistant - for protection against severe weather conditions, moderate corrosive conditions such as marine atmospheres and weather A resistant to ultra-violet radiation. Low coefcient of friction between pipe and resilient coated pipe roller. Ordering: Specify pipe roll size. E F D Order should include gure number, name and nish in all cases. C Hanger rods and nuts to be ordered separately. B Be certain to order oversized rolls when insulation and protection saddles G makes this necessary.
600 660 700 750 1,070 1,350 1,730 2,400 3,130 3,970 4,200 4,550 6,160 7,290
16
2 8 4 8
8
1
11
16 4
2 8 4 8
3 7
8 1
1 114 112
3 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30
128 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
pIpE ROLL
Fig. 178
Material: Spring cushion hanger Fig. 178 consists of a set of two springs and four cast iron retainers only. Finish: Plain (retainers), Painted (springs) Service: Generally used with Fig. 171 single pipe roll as shown in above photo. Recommended for installations where formal load and movement calculations are not required, or calculated movement does not exceed 14". Maximum Temperature: 450 F at roller Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 49), WW-H-171-E (Type 50), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 49). Ordering: Specify gure number, name and rod size. If used with Fig. 171 single pipe roll, pipe roll must be ordered separately. The retainers are casted to the dimensions as shown, but center hole can be drilled or reamed larger to satisfy the hanger rod required, up to the max rod size.
C L
Weight
4.5 14.0 22.0
C
22132 418 418
D
6716 6116 9116
1,500 3,000
1,200 2,400
16 16
2 8
15
* At maximum recommended deection, spring can be compressed an additional 14" before becoming solid. n Maximum capacity of double spring hanger. ** Can be drilled to max. rod size.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
129
Index
112
Technical Data
535
428
16
Max Load at Deection Rate Spring Max of Hanger Deection * Deection n (lbs / inch)
Application Examples
Snubbers
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Pipe Guides Pipe Roll Pipe Shields & Slides & Saddles
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
pIpE ROLL
Fig. 181
Size Range: 2 12" through 24" Material: Cast iron roll; carbon steel yoke, roll rod and hex nuts Finish: Plain, Galvanized or Resilient Coated Service: For suspension of pipe from a single rod where longitudinal movement may occur because of expansion or contraction. Maximum Temperature: 450 F at roller, 300 F at resilient coated roller. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 43), WW-H-171-E (Type 44), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 43). Features: Advantages of pipe rollers with a protective resilient coated covering. Non conductive pipe rollers - prevent the passing of current from pipeline to structure. Corrosion resistant - for protection against severe weather conditions, moderate corrosive conditions such as marine atmospheres and weather resistant to ultra-violet radiation. Low coefcient of friction between pipe and resilient coated pipe roller. How to size: If the roll is to support bare pipe, select the size directly from nominal pipe size (see below). If used with pipe covering protection saddle, see page 123 for size of pipe roll to be used. Ordering: Specify pipe roll size, gure number, name and nish. Be certain to order oversized rolls when insulation and protection saddles are required.
H E C L B
Max Load
225 310 390 475 685 780 965 1,200 1,400 1,600 1,800
Weight
1.7 2.2 2.5 3.2 6.3 9.3 14.5 18.8 27.7 39.1 49.1 57.8 75.9 119.3
Rod Size A
1
B
534 638 7 7916 918 10516 121116 15116 17716 1878 201316 2334 26 32516
C
314 378 438 41516 6 718 914 1114 1314 1412 1612 1812 2012 2458
D
11516 214 2916 21316 3716 4 518 638 7716 838 938 10716 1158 131516
H
11116 158 11116 158 11516 178 2 2116 214 2 11516 21316 212 438
2 8 4 8
1 114 112
130 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
pIpE ROLL
Fig. 175
Size Range: 2" through 30" pipe Material: Cast iron roll, steel chair, roll rod, bolts and hex nuts Finish: Plain, Galvanized or Resilient Coated Maximum Temperature: 450 F at roller, 300 F at resilient coated roller. Service: For support of pipe where longitudinal movement due to expansion and contraction may occur, but where no vertical adjustment is required. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 44), WW-H-171-E (Type 45), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 44). Installation: Two bolts and nuts provide anchorage to oor or top of steel beam or bracket or chair may be welded to supporting steel. Features: Advantages of pipe rollers with a protective resilient coated covering. Non conductive pipe rollers - prevent the passing of current from pipeline to structure. Corrosion resistant - for protection against severe weather conditions, moderate corrosive conditions such as marine atmospheres and weather resistant to ultra-violet radiation. Low coefcient of friction between pipe and resilient coated pipe roller. How to size: (1) If roll is to support bare pipe, select the size directly from nominal pipe size (see below). (2) If used with pipe covering protection saddle, see page 123 for size of pipe roll. (3) If roll is to support covered pipe, the O.D. of the covering should not be greater than the O.D. of the pipe for which the roll was designed. Ordering: Specify size of roll, gure number, name and nish. Be certain to order oversized rolls when insulation and protection saddles are required.
Roller Chair
C L
C G
F B
Max Load
600 660 700 750 1,070 1,350 1,730 2,400 3,130 3,970 4,200 4,550 6,160 7,290
Weight
1.1 1.4 1.6 2.6 2.9 3.7 5.9 9.0 13.8 18.9 28.07 34.93 44.35 56.34 87.52 151.25
W
4 478 538 618 658 778 914 1158 1418 1618 1834 21 2318 2458 2938 341316
B
1 4
1
C
112 158 134 2116 2516 212 234 3 358 418 41116 538 6 612 778 834
G Width
11/4
H
158 11516 214 2916 21316 3716 4 518 638 7716 838 938 10716 1158 14 17716
2 3 318 338 514 512 612 814 914 1014 1214 1538
11/2
1
2 x 112 8 x 112
5 3
2 21/2 3 4 6
8 x 2 4 x 2
4 x 212 8 x 312
3 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30
4 5 6 8 10 14 16 18 20 24 30 No Recom.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
131
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
8 x 112
Snubbers
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Pipe Guides Pipe Roll Pipe Shields & Slides & Saddles
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
pIpE ROLL
Size Range: 2" through 24" Material: Cast iron roll and plate Finish: Plain, Galvanized or Resilient Coated Service: For support of pipe where small longitudinal movement due to expansion and contraction may occur and where no vertical adjustment is required. Maximum Temperature: 450 F at roller, 300 F at resilient coated roller. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 45) WW-H-171-E (Type 46), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 45). Installation: Consist of sitting the unit in place. Weight of pipe and material hold unit in place. How to size: (1) If roll is to support bare pipe, select the size directly from nominal pipe size (see below). (2) If used with pipe covering protection saddle, see page 123 for size of pipe roll. Features: An economical, practical means of supporting pipe with limited horizontal movement due to expansion and contraction. Features: Advantages of pipe rollers with a protective resilient coated covering. Non conductive pipe rollers - prevent the passing of current from pipeline to structure. Corrosion resistant - for protection against severe weather conditions, moderate corrosive conditions such as marine C L atmospheres and weather resistant to ultra-violet radiation. Low coefcient of friction between pipe and resilient coated TRAVERSE pipe roller. E B A H Ordering: Specify pipe roll size, gure number, name and nish. G Be certain to order oversized rolls when insulation and protection saddles are required. Note: Fabricated carbon steel base plates for extended travel are available upon request. Refer to Fig. 75 SD and 76 SD for additional K K J pipe roll designs.
D D
Max Load
390
Weight
A
314 312 31316 4116 4516 41516 512 7916 81116 1014 1078 1238 1312 1412 1658
B
134 218 238 258 234 338 4 514 638 712 818 938 1038 1138 1338
4.0
434
258
178
134
2 16 4 8
11
3 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20
132 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
pIpE ROLL
D J'
G L M E
312 378 418 438 41316 5716 6116 81116 91316 1138 12 1358 1458 1558 1734 2178 2534 2878
138 218 238 258 234 338 4 514 638 712 818 938 1038 1138 1338 1634 20 2318
838
538
234
178
978
334 6 8 9
638
16
11
16
1
4 2
3716
778
3
978
9116
6 612 8 9
1 114 1 2
1
118 112 1 4
3
1 16
1 5
12
1 16 18 4
17
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
133
Index
Technical Data
13
16
1114 1014
734
Application Examples
D'
J'
Snubbers
Constant Supports
D'
Spring Hangers
Pipe Guides Pipe Roll Pipe Shields & Slides & Saddles
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
pIpE ROLL Fig. 274: with Base Plate Fig. 275: without Base Plate Fig. 274P:Cast Iron Base Plate only
Size Range: 2" through 42" Material: Cast iron base plate, stand roll; steel adjusting screws Finish: Plain, Galvanized or Resilient Coated Service: For support of pipe lines where longitudinal movement due to expansion and contraction may occur and where vertical and lateral adjustment during installation may be required. Maximum Temperature: 450 F at roller, 300 F resilient coated roller. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 46), WW-H-171-E (Type 47), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 46). Installation: Base plate is provided with two holes for anchorage to oor, pier, structural support and similar constructions, as well as to welded steel brackets Fig. 195 page 82 and Fig. 199, page 83. Adjustable pipe roll stand without base plate, Fig. 275, can be used for supporting tunnel piping, etc., by resting ends of adjusting screws on structural steel angles, channels, etc. Adjustment: Vertical adjustment is obtained by use of the four adjusting screws located on corners of stand. Lateral adjustment is secured by stand sliding on each of adjusting screws. Features: Advantages of pipe rollers with a protective resilient coated covering. Non conductive pipe rollers - prevent the passing of current from pipeline to structure. Corrosion resistant - for protection against severe weather conditions, moderate corrosive conditions such as marine atmospheres and weather resistant to ultra-violet radiation. Low coefcient of friction between pipe and resilient coated pipe roller. How to size: (1) If roll is to support bare pipe, select the size directly from nominal pipe size (see below). If used with pipe covering protection saddle, see page 123 for size of pipe roll. (2) Ordering: Specify pipe roll size, gure number, name and nish. For further dimensions of stand, see Fig. 271, page 133. Be certain to order oversized rolls when insulation and protection saddles are required. R Note: Refer to Fig. 75 SD and 76 SD for additional pipe roll designs. Standard line of carbon steel base plates available.
W J
C L
K B H' E G V R S M E
Weight
Fig. 274 15.2 Fig. 275 7.8 Fig. 274P 7.4
V Max
7
512
378
8 1
3
678 4
3
4 818 1058
5 4
3
5 8
1
1 8
1
1
13
634 8 858 10 2
1
1 134 118
16 4
7
178 3 4
1 1
1316 1 8
3 1
1 1 4
1
1 114 1 2
1
3 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30
11
1 8
1
4 2
2 4
112
134 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
pIpE ROLL
Fig. 76CP
Description: Fabricated roller for large diameter pipe requiring cathodic isolation due to cathodic protection. Ten standard sizes for pipe of 30" - 72" and loads up to 60,000 lbs. Smaller sizes are available upon request. The base can be bolted or welded to the support structure. Alternative attachment congurations are available upon request. Contact Anvil EPS division 1-855-EPS-PIPE for further information and how to order. Installation: The two piece fabricated roller is designed for one of the two rollers on each side of the assembly to be in contact with the pipe. Patent pending technology in the rollers isolate the pipe from the assembly. Used for piping cathodic protection.
Non-Conductive Roller
C L OF PIPE
6 31/2
15/16 C
B D
43/16
C L OF PIPE
A
2318 26 2878 3034 31316 32116 341516 371116 40916 4338
B
13 8
5
C
8 16
3
D
81516 91516 101516 111116 121316 1314 14516 1512 16916 1758
E
0 1 2 234 114 11116 234 31516 5 6116
A
24316 27316 3018 3312
B
1358 1614
C
8316 101316
D
9116 10316 11516 13916
E
1 4 138 238 2
60,000
1614
101316
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
135
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Pipe Guides Pipe Roll Pipe Shields & Slides & Saddles
1 /4
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Fig. 255
Size Range: 1" through 24" pipe and insulation thickness of 1" through 4" (Also available in copper tube sizes, see page 26) Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For maintaining alignment of piping through its axial expansion and contraction cycles. Normally, two or more pipe alignment guides are used on a single piping run to avoid a pivoting effect within the piping system. It is recommended that the rst guide be located a maximum of four pipe diameters from an expansion joint. The second guide should be placed a maximum of 18 pipe diameters from an expansion joint. Additional guides should be employed in accordance with the guide spacing data shown on next page. Supports are usually required between the intermediate guides to comply with standard support practice. Maximum Temperature: 650 F Installation: (1) Attach outer housing to structure by bolting or welding. (2) Remove upper section of housing to open position. (3) Attach spider clamp to pipe and completely insulate. W (4) Set pipe and spider clamp into outer housing. (5) Replace upper section of housing to closed position and secure. Note: Spider attachments to pipe must be properly C L B located during installation to insure that a minimum C of one-half the spider width remains within the length of the outer housing for all conditions of D operation. See table on opposite page for maximum T recommended travels. If larger travels are required, special guides can be furnished to special order. E H DIA How to size: Size by nominal pipe size and insulation 4 HOLES J INSULATION THICKNESS thickness in accordance with the selection table on Pipe Alignment Guide the opposite page. Figure 255, Size A & B Ordering: Specify size number, pipe size, insulation, W thickness, gure number, name and nish. Caution: The primary function of the Figure 255 is to maintain axial alignment of a system. Other components should be incorporated into the system to carry the primary loading of the system. Guides C L B are designed such that minor loading amounts may C be transferred to the guide in any given direction, D up to 20% of dead weight load for typical maximum T spans of a given pipe diameter. Pipe Size (in)
1" to 6" 8" to 16" 18" to 24"
PIPE
F G
PIPE
L (in)
4 6 8
Maximum Movement
4 6 8
H DIA 4 HOLES
E J INSULATION THICKNESS
F G
136 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 255
Guide SiZe Number
Pipe Size
1 1 4
1 1
1
A
Dimensions (in) W
81316 101316 13516 1578 18 2214 28 3238 3758
1 2 2 212 3 312 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 C D C D E F C D E F G B B B
C C D E
C D D E F E F G H J G
E F G
1 512 8
F G H J
H J
50
38 52 66 85 103 118 120 130 145 155 180
Maximum Distance (feet) Between Intermediate Guides for Pressure (psig) 100 150 200 250 300 350 400 500
27 37 47 62 75 85 87 95 105 110 128 22 32 40 51 62 70 72 78 87 92 105 20 27 35 45 54 60 62 68 75 90 90 18 25 31 40 50 55 57 61 68 73 83 17 23 28 36 45 50 52 57 62 68 75 15 22 27 35 42 46 48 52 58 62 70 14 19 25 32 40 43 45 49 55 58 65 13 17 23 29 35 40 41 45 50 53 60
600
12 16 20 27 32 35 37 41 45 49 54
* For pipe sizes not shown refer to the Expansion Joint Manufacturers Association Guidelines
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
137
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Fig. 256
Size Range: 1" through 24" pipe and insulation thickness of 1" through 4" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For maintaining alignment of piping through its axial expansion and contraction cycles. Normally, two or more pipe alignment guides are used on a single piping run to avoid a pivoting effect within the piping system. It is recommended that the rst guide be located a maximum of four pipe diameters from an expansion joint. The second guide should be placed a maximum of 18 pipe diameters from the expansion joint. Additional guides should be employed in accordance with the guide spacing data on next page. Supports are usually required between the intermediate guides to comply with standard support practice. Maximum Temperature: 750 F Installation: (1) Attach outer housing to structure by bolting or welding. (2) Swing upper section of housing to open positions. (3) Attach spider clamp to pipe and completely insulate. (4) Set pipe and spider clamp into outer housing. (5) Replace upper section of housing to closed position and secure. Note: Spider attachments to pipe must be properly located during installation to insure that a minimum of one-half the spider width remains within the length of the outer housing for all conditions of operation. See table on opposite page for maximum recommended travels. If larger travels are required, special guides can be furnished to special order. How to size: Size by nominal pipe size and insulation thickness in accordance with the selection table on opposite page. Ordering: Specify size number, pipe size, insulation thickness, gure number, name and nish. Caution: The primary function of the Figure 256 is to maintain axial alignment of a W system. Other components should be incorporated into the system to carry the primary loading of the system. Guides are designed such that minor loading amounts C L B may be transferred to the guide in any given direction, up to 20% of dead weight load for typical maximum spans of a given pipe diameter.
T E J INSULATION THICKNESS
L (in)
6 8 10
Maximum Movement
6 8 10
PIPE
H DIA 4 HOLES
F G
138 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 256
Guide SiZe Number
Pipe Size
1 1 4
1
1
A A A B B B B C C D
A A A B B B B C C D E F F
A A A B B B B C C D E F F G G
B B B B B C C C D D E F F G G
B B B C C C C C D E E F F G G H H J
112 2 2 2
1
A B C D E F G H J
212
3 3 2
1
4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24
512
50
38 52 66 85 103 118 120 130 145 155 180
Maximum Distance (feet) Between Intermediate Guides for Pressure (psig) 100 150 200 250 300 350 400 500
27 37 47 62 75 85 87 95 105 110 128 22 32 40 51 62 70 72 78 87 92 105 20 27 35 45 54 60 62 68 75 90 90 18 25 31 40 50 55 57 61 68 73 83 17 23 28 36 45 50 52 57 62 68 75 15 22 27 35 42 46 48 52 58 62 70 14 19 25 32 40 43 45 49 55 58 65 13 17 23 29 35 40 41 45 50 53 60
600
12 16 20 27 32 35 37 41 45 49 54
* For pipe sizes not shown refer to the Expansion Joint Manufacturers Association Guidelines
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
139
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Dimensions (in) W B C D E F G H T
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Overview
Application Anvil PTFE pipe slide assemblies are designed to support the pipe and provide for lateral and axial movement due to thermal expansion and contraction of the piping system. Assemblies are fabricated using PTFE slide bearings to provide a low coefcient of friction, minimizing frictional stress on the pipe and support structure. Features Pre-engineered to save calculation and installation time. PTFE slide bearing pads are composed of 100% virgin Polytetrauoroethylene polymer. Capable of supporting constant loads up to 2000 PSI at 70 F Coefcient of friction typically ranges between 0.06 and 0.2 depending on bearing surface area, bearing load (sample ranges shown in chart for given pressures at 70F). Consult your Anvil representative for further information. The low coefcient of friction for the PTFE slide assemblies permits a smooth, unrestrained movement of the pipe and reduces overturning movements on supporting structures. PTFE is chemically inert and resists attack by chemicals, humidity and other elements found in harsh environments provided that the steel supports are suitably protected. Self-lubricating, maintenance-free. Provides resistance to galvanic corrosion between pipe and support structure. Maximum temperature: 400 F at PTFE Allows for up to 4" insulation thickness as standard. Greater than 4" insulation available on special request. Special designed slides and tees available on request. Selection (1) Determine the support location based on allowable span and loading conditions. (2) Calculate the load for each slide assembly location. (3) Determine the lateral and axial movement of the pipe and the direction of movement, cold to hot. (4) Select pipe slide or tee gure number and attachment conguration, welded or bolted. (5) Select the method of slide plate attachment to support structure, welded or bolted. Designate whether guided or non-guided slide plate is required. (6) Maximum recommended loads shown for pipe slides and structural tees are for vertical loading. Transitional loads for pipe (7) structural tees are to be determined by customer. Installation (1) Determine offset of pipe slide-slide plate interface to allow maximum pipe movement in direction of greatest thermal displacement. Attach PTFE slide to pipe by welding or clamping with standard Fig. 212 pipe clamp or Fig. 432 special pipe clamp. (2) (3) Attach slide plates to supporting structure by bolting or welding. Verify setting to insure full bearing between the PTFE slide and slide base surfaces under all pipe movement conditions. (4)
140 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Overview (cont.)
.2
Coefficient of Friction
Factor
1.00 0.85 0.55 0.40 0.25
.1
500 3.45
1000 6.89
1500 10.3
2000 13.8
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
141
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Fig. 257: Structural Tee Slide Assembly Fig. 257A: Structural Tee Fig. 436: Fabricated Tee Slide Assembly Fig. 436A: Fabricated Tee
Size Range: All sizes within maximum load rating. PTFE Pipe Slide Assembly "T" Style (Type 1) Material: Carbon steel tee, PTFE bonded slide plates and Structural Tees carbon steel base. Finish: Plain, Painted or Galvanized Service: For the support of piping where horizontal movement resulting from expansion and contraction takes place and where a low coefcient Fig 257 of friction is desired. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 35), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 35). Maximum Load: As indicated at 70 F see page 141 for rating factor at Fig 436 higher temperatures. Maximum Temperature: 750 F Temperature Range at PTFE: -20 F to 400 F Features: No lubrication required. Designed to minimize heat loss. PTFE Slide Allows up to 3" of insulation on Types 1, 2, 4 & 5 and up to 2 12" of insulation on Types 3 & 6. Allows up to 10" travel standard Weld in place design. PTFE Slide Plate Base Available Options: Increased travels. Increased tee heights. Note: In the PH-92 and PH-92R Catalogs: End plates. The Fig. 257 & 436 (slide T section only) formerly referred to as Clamps, Fig. 212 or Fig. 432. Fig. 280 & 435 Base plate with mounting holes The Fig. 257 & 436 (slide base plate) formerly referred to as Fig. 438 High temperature option, 1000F (Fig. 436) Stainless steel (slide base plate) tee slide with an insulated PTFE slide The acceptability of galvanized coatings at temperatures above Ordering: Specify gure number, type, name, nish and any other 450F is at the discretion of the end user. option desired.
Max Load
Down Side * Up H **
Welded Slide
W BL Weight H ** W
Bolted Slide
BL Hole Locations Bolt Size Weight
4 4 8 6 1112 4 8 6 1112
12 2 4 2 5 12 2 4 2 5
Fig. 257
Fig. 436
7.00 11.93 16.10 16.95 12.47 18.81 19.66 7.00 15.42 19.59 20.44 15.97 22.30 23.15
8 1112 8 1112
4 5 4 5
15.25 16.10 16.95 18.36 19.21 20.06 18.74 19.59 20.44 21.85 22.70 23.55
* Side load is only applicable if appropriate endplates are added to slide or T Section ** With the Fig. 432 clamp, add the material thickness. The Tees are now being notched for the material thickness when welding on the Fig. 212 See page 147.
142 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
Structural Tee
Fabricated Tee
Fig. 257
Fig. 436
Type 2
Fig 257, Type 2
Type 3
Fig 257, Type 3
Type 4
Fig 257, Type 4 Note: Base Plate is larger than Type 1 1"
1"
38
1"
1"
3 8
FIG.436 NOTCHED TO REDUCE HEAT LOSS FIG.257 FEATURES LINE CONTACT WITH PIPE
BL 12"
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
143
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
Type 5
Type 6
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Fig. 439: Structural "H" Slide Assembly Fig. 439A: Structural "H"
Size Range: 6" through 36" Material: Carbon steel H section, PTFE bonded slide plates and carbon steel base. Finish: Plain, Painted or Galvanized Service: A heavy duty slide support where horizontal movement resulting from expansion and contraction takes place and where a low coefcient of friction is desired. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 35), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 35). Maximum Load: As indicated at 70 F see page 141 for rating factor at higher temperatures. Maximum Temperature: 750 F Temperature Range at PTFE: -20 F to 400 F Features: No lubrication required. Allows up to 4" of insulation. Allows up to 10 travel standard. Weld in place design. Available Options: Increased travels. Increased H Section heights. Clamps, Fig. 212 or Fig. 432. Base plate with mounting holes. The bolt spacing for the bolted base plates is equal to the W dimention minus 1 12" and the BL dimention minus 1 12" for all pipe sizes and the hole diameter is 916" for all sizes. Ordering: Specify gure number, type, name, nish and any other option desired. Notes: Types 1, 2, and 3 provide for longitudinal movement only. Types 4 and 5 provide for both longitudinal and transverse movement of piping.
Structural "H"
Mounting Plate
PTFE Slides
Note: In the PH-92 and PH-92R Catalogs: The Fig. 439 (slide H section only) formerly referred to as Fig. 437. The Fig. 439 (slide base plate) formerly referred to as Fig. 438 (slide base plate). The acceptability of galvanized coatings at temperatures above 450F is at the discretion of the end user.
B
Type
1&4 2&5 3 1&4
D*
Type
2&5 3
Max Load
Down Side Up Type Type 3 2, 3, 5
514
5516
D B
518
538
5716
734 834 958 1034 1078 1218 1258 1334 1558 1958 23
12,000 3,000
1,200
16,000 4,000
1,600
24,000 6,000
2,400
* With clamps; add material thickness of a Fig. 212 for bolted bases add 516" to height H dimension. ** With the Figure 432 special clamp, add the material thickness of Figure 432. See page 146.
144 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 439
Welded: DimensiOns (in)
Pipe Size
6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30 36
Type
1 2&3
Pipe Size
6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30 36
Type 1 to 5
5 /2
1
10 121/2 141/2 17 19 21 23
7 /2
1
10 121/2 2 1412 17 19 21 23 3 6
8 10 12 14 16 18
WELDED SCHEMATICS
12
BOLTED SCHEMATICS
12
Type 1
W BL
12
Type 1
C W G BL
12
Types 2&3
/16 W BL
12
Types 2&3
/16 C W G BL
12
BL
C W
G BL
12
12
Type 5
1 W BL
Type 5
1 C W G BL
Options
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
145
Index
Technical Data
Notes: Types 1, 2, and 3 provide for longitudinal movement only. Types 4 and 5 provide for both longitudinal and transverse movement of piping.
Application Examples
Snubbers
Type 4
Type 4
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
812
Trapeze
BL
Hole Spacing C G
Pipe Supports
Straps
Fig. 432
Size Range: 2" through 24" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Maximum Temperature: Plain 750 F, Galvanized 450 F for carbon steel pipe only Service: Used with and where pipe slides cannot be welded directly to pipe or copper tube. When used with berglass, plastic, or aluminum pipe, a thin protective liner should be inserted between the pipe and the clamp. Clamp is designed for use with Figure 257 and Figures 436 and 439 slides and tees. Ordering: Specify gure number, pipe size, name and nish.
Special Clamp
M N
L Q
M
5 512 6 612 7 8 958 1158 1334 1534 1778 1978 2178 2378 2818
N
4 412 5 512 6 7 812 1012 1258 1458 1612 1812 2012 2212 2678
R Stock Size
Weight
2 3 3 4 4 5 12 15 18 21 41 46 52 57 67
412
/8 x 6
8 6
3
/16 x 8
2 8
1
12
/4 x 12
146 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 212
Size Range: 2" through 30" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Maximum Temperature: Plain 750 F, Galvanized 450 F Service: Pipe clamp for gure numbers 257, 436, and 439 slides and tees. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish. Note: Two clamps are required. T section 257/436 or H section 439 are notched to accommodate clamps and to eliminate the increase in height of the slide assembly.
G F C L
C E
Pipe Size
2 212 3 312 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30
B
218 258 278 3316 312 4316 478 6 7716 8716 914 1014 1158 1234 1514 19
C
1
D
234 314 312 31316 414 41516 534 678 8916 9916 1058 1158 13 1418 1678 2118
E
218 258 278 3316 312 4316 478 6 7716 8716 914 1014 1158 1234 1514 19
H
234 314 312 31316 414 41516 534 678 8916 9916 1058 1158 13 1418 1678 2118
G Width
Weight
2.2 2.4 2.8 3.0 4.6 5.2 10.8 13.0 27.2 30.4 41.0 44.6 63.2 71.6 106.2 227.8
8 4
11/4 11/2 2
8 21/2 3 4
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
147
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Fig. 770
Q Brace Clamp
Size Range: Service Pipe: 1" through 6" Sch. 10 and Sch. 40 IPS UL and FM Approved Service Pipe: 1" through 6" Flow Pipe FM Approved Brace Pipe: 1" or 11/4" Sch. 40 IPS Material: Carbon steel Finish: Brace Rod Plain or Galvanized, Channel bracket EG Service: Used to rigidly brace piping systems subjected to sway and seismic disturbances. Pipe clamp component of Anvil's 700 series sway brace assembly. Primarily a lateral brace clamp and applicable as a riser/four way brace. Approvals: UL and ULC Listed (UL 203A:2009), and FM Approved (FM 1950:2010). Complies with seismic bracing requirements of NFPA-13. Ofce of Statewide Health Planning and Development (OSHPD) State of California approved. Features: Used to brace schedules 10 IPS, 40 IPS (UL and FM), and Sch. 7 IPS ow pipe (FM). Field adjustable design requires no threading of bracing pipe OPA-2804-10 Can be used as a component of a four-way brace support Functions as a lateral brace application Installation Instructions: 1. Minimum brace pipe extension 2" beyond channel bracket or brace clamp rod end. Note: 6" sizes are supplied with retaining plate that assembles between sprinkler system pipe and brace pipe. Not required for FM applications. 2. The brace clamp channel bracket can be installed inside or outside the service pipe at the end of the brace pipe. 3. The Q brace clamp must be a minimum of 6" away from a pipe joint in order to not weaken the pipe joint. 4. Riser/4-way brace - The Q brace clamps must be installed within 6" of each other. 5. Adjust brace angle as necessary. 6. Tighten hex nuts until spring indicating clip is completely attened and the required torque of 14 Ft-Lbs is achieved. For sizes 2" - 3", 4" x 1", 5" x 1", and 6" continue tightening to a torque of 16 Ft-Lbs. Ordering: Specify service pipe diameter, brace pipe diameter, gure number, name and nish.
1" or 11/4" Sch. 40 Brace Pipe Rod End Fig. 770 Q Brace Clamp
Channel Bracket (shown outside service pipe) Indicator Clip 2" Min.
Typical Assembly (Brace Pipe Below Service Pipe)
148 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 770
Plain View
11/4
11/2
1600
Torque Value
14 16
See page 14 for notes on sway brace-seismic components concerning installation, performance and warranty.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
149
Index
Technical Data
1000
* See FM Approval guide for approved ow pipe. ** The allowable FM approved capacity of brace subassemblies have been determined by resolving the load rating to the horizontal direction and dividing by a safety factor of 1.5 to allow the values to be used directly for Allowable Stress Design. For Load Resistance Factor Design (LRFD) capacities, the above values will need to be multiplied by 1.5. *** Brace Pipe Angles are determined from vertical.
Application Examples
UL Max Load
Sch. 10 Sch. 40
Weight
1" Brace Pipe .82 .86 .90 .96 1.02 1.09 1.23 1.32 1.49 11/4" Brace Pipe .87 .90 .95 1.00 1.06 1.13 1.26 Not Listed 1.53
Fig. 770 UL MAX LOAD: LOads (lbs) Weight (lbs) DimensiOns (in)
Snubbers
Elevated View
Max. 6"
21/2
Constant Supports
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Fig. 776
Brace Clamp
Size Range: Service Pipe: 21/2" through 8" Sch. 10 and Sch. 40 IPS Service Pipe: 21/2" through 6" FM Approved Flow Pipe Brace Pipe: 1" or 11/4" Sch. 40 IPS Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Used to rigidly brace piping systems subjected to sway and seismic disturbances. Pipe clamp component of Anvil's 700 series sway brace assembly. Utilized only as a lateral brace clamp. Approvals: FM Approved (FM 1950:2010). Complies with seismic bracing requirements of NFPA-13. Ofce of Statewide Health Planning and Development (OSHPD) State of California approved. Features: Used to brace schedules 10 IPS, 40 IPS, and Flow pipe Field adjustable design requires no threading of bracing pipe OPA-2804-10 Can be used as a component of a four-way brace support Brace clamp design for installation of brace pipe above or below horizontal service pipe. Installation Instructions: 1. Installation of this component must be a minimum of 6" from any pipe joint, so that any deformation does not affect the pipe joint. 2. Minimum brace pipe extension 1" beyond clamp stirrup. 3. Tighten hex bolt until heads bottom out on surface Ordering: Specify service pipe diameter x brace pipe diameter, gure number, name and nish.
150 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 776
Fig. 776 FM MAX LOad: LOads (lbs) DimensiOns (in) Angles (DegreeS)
Service Pipe Size (1" or 11/4" Brace Pipe) Brace Angle*** 30-44 45-59 60-74 75-90 30-44 45-59 60-74 75-90 30-44 45-59 60-74 75-90 30-44 45-59 60-74 75-90 30-44 45-59 60-74 75-90 30-44 45-59 60-74 75-90 FM Max Load** (Horizontal) Sch. 10 Sch. 40 620 880 1000 1200 620 880 1000 1200 690 980 1200 1300 670 940 1100 1200 670 940 1100 1200 540 770 940 1000 Flow Pipe 600 850 1000 1100 520 740 910 1000 520 740 910 1000 520 740 910 1000 560 790 970 1000
Weight
1" Brace Pipe 1.26 1.44 1.55 1.66 1.74 1.98 11/4" Brace Pipe 1.50 1.58 1.68 1.87 1.95 2.29
See page 14 for notes on sway brace-seismic components concerning installation, performance and warranty.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
151
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
* See FM Approvals for approved ow pipe. ** The allowable FM approved capacity of brace subassemblies have been determined by resolving the load rating to the horizontal direction and dividing by a safety factor of 1.5 to allow the values to be used directly for Allowable Stress Design. For Load Resistance Factor Design (LRFD) capacities, the above values will need to be multiplied by 1.5. *** Brace Pipe Angles are determined from vertical.
Snubbers
Constant Supports
Pipe Roll
21/2
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Fig. 775
Size Range: Service Pipe: 21/2" through 8" Sch. 10 and Sch. 40 IPS OPA-2804-10 Service Pipe: 21/2" through 6" Flow Pipe Brace Pipe: 1" or 11/4" Sch. 40 IPS Material: Carbon steel clamp, ductile iron brace connector Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Used to rigidly brace piping systems subjected to sway and seismic disturbances. Pipe clamp component of Anvil's 700 series sway brace assembly. Can be utilized as either a lateral brace clamp or a longitudinal brace clamp. Approvals: UL and ULC Listed (UL 203A:2009), and FM Approved (FM 1950:2010). Complies with seismic bracing requirements of NFPA-13. Ofce of Statewide Health Planning and Development (OSHPD) State of California approved. Features: No threading of bracing pipe Functions as a lateral or longitudinal brace clamp Installation Instructions: 1. Installation of the pipe must be at a minimum 6" away from a pipe joint. 2. Position pipe clamp at desired location and loosely tighten the clamp hex bolts. Ensure that the spacer and brace pipe connector are positioned between the pipe clamp ears. 3. Place the Schedule 40 brace pipe into the brace pipe connector until it bottoms out. 4. Tighten shear bolt until the head shears off. Then position the brace pipe to the appropriate angle. The use of an impact wrench is not recommended. 5. Tighten the pipe clamp hex bolts equally and alternately until metal-to-metal contact is achieved with the following torque values. Clamp Bolt Minimum Torque Values : 21/2" thru 3" Dia. Clamps (80 Ft-Lbs) , 4" & 5" Dia. Clamps (100 Ft-Lbs), 6" Dia. Clamp (120 Ft-Lbs), 8" Dia. Clamp (140 Ft-Lbs), 6. Note: For 6" and 8" service pipe, a thread lubricant such as Gruvlok Xtreme Lubricant should be used to ease assembly of pipe clamp hex bolts and nuts. Ordering: Specify service pipe diameter x brace pipe diameter, gure number, name and nish.
1" or 11/4" Sch. 40 Brace Pipe 1" or 11/4" Sch. 40 Brace Pipe
152 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 775
J Shear Bolt
C L Y
21/2 3 4 5 6 8
1600 2015
* See FM Approval guide for approved ow pipe. ** The allowable FM approved capacity of brace subassemblies have been determined by resolving the load rating to the horizontal direction and dividing by a safety factor of 1.5 to allow the values to be used directly for Allowable Stress Design. For Load Resistance Factor Design (LRFD) capacities, the above values will need to be multiplied by 1.5. *** Brace Pipe Angles are determined from vertical. See page 14 for notes on sway brace-seismic components concerning installation, performance and warranty.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
153
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
1000
Snubbers
2 /2
1
1.38
Constant Supports
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Fig. 778
Size Range: Structural Steel: Minimum Thickness 1/8" (FM), 3/16" (UL), Maximum Thickness 3/4" OPA-2804-10 Service Pipe: 1" through 8" Material: Ductile iron beam attachment, shear head bolts and hex head mounting bolt Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Used to rigidly brace piping systems subjected to sway and seismic disturbances. Structural attachment component of Anvil's 700 series sway brace assembly. Recommended for use under roof installations with bar joist construction or for attachment to the top or bottom ange of structural steel beams. Can be utilized as a structural connection for either a lateral brace or a longitudinal brace. Approvals: UL and ULC Listed (UL 203A:2009), and FM Approved (FM 1950:2010). Complies with seismic bracing requirements of NFPA-13. Ofce of Statewide Health Planning and Development (OSHPD) State of California approved. Features: Permits secure quick connection to structural members where drilling and/or welding of brace connection is not allowed or is not easily accomplished Shear head bolt design ensures that the proper installation torque is accomplished for a tight non-slip t to the structural member. Bar joist beam attachment is designed for concentric loadings of seismic connections and fasteners. Installation Instructions: 1. Place Fig. 778 on the structural steel beam. Steel member must fully engage throat of Fig. 778. 2. Tighten the set bolts equally and alternately until bolt heads shear off (30-40 Ft-Lbs). 3. Attach 700 Series Anvil Brace Fittings using the included 1/2" mounting bolt and adjust orientation as needed for proper brace angle. Ordering: Specify gure number, name and nish.
/4"
Set Bolts
H
1
Fig. 778
L
4.13
W
2.25
Weight
2.58
154 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 778
1
Fig. 778 (Shown in Vertical Position) Fig. 771 Sway Brace Swivel Attachment
Section A-A
Elevated View
Steel Joist
Typical Assembly
(Bar Joist)
/16 /4 1 /2
1
Fig. 778 FM MAX LOADS*: LOads (lbs) DimensiOns (in) Angles (Degrees)
Beam Flange Thickness
1
Brace Angle** 30-44 45-59 60-74 75-90 30-44 45-59 60-74 75-90
/8 - 3/4
See page 14 for notes on sway brace-seismic components concerning installation, performance and warranty.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
155
Index
Technical Data
Structural Note: Steel Joist Manufacturers require that all seismic bracing connections be within 6" of the cord panel point. Installation of the Fig. 778 must be limited to the outer third sections of the joist span.
* The allowable FM approved capacity of brace subassemblies have been determined by resolving the load rating to the horizontal direction and dividing by a safety factor of 1.5 to allow the values to be used directly for Allowable Stress Design. For Load Resistance Factor Design (LRFD) capacities, the above values will need to be multiplied by 1.5. ** Brace Pipe Angles are determined from vertical.
Application Examples
/8 - 3/4
Perpendicular to Beam 440 740 920 1010 380 540 660 700
Parallel to Beam 620 880 940 1050 370 520 640 720
Snubbers
Perpendicluar to Beam
Parallel to Beam
Constant Supports
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
/2" Min.
6" Max.
Pipe Supports
Straps
Fig. 772
Size Range: Beam Widths: 4" through 15" OPA-2804-10 Flange Thickness: 1/2" through 11/4" Minimum Flange Thickness: 3/8" (FM), 1/2" (UL) Type A: Flange Thickness Range: 1/2" - 3/4" Type B: Flange Thickness Range: 7/8" - 11/4" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Used to rigidly brace piping systems subjected to sway and seismic disturbances. Structural attachment component of Anvil's 700 series sway brace assembly. For attachment to the bottom ange of structural steel beams. Can be utilized as a structural connection for either a lateral brace or a longitudinal brace. Approvals: UL and ULC Listed (UL 203A:2009), and FM Approved (FM 1950:2010). Complies with seismic bracing requirements of NFPA-13. Ofce of Statewide Health Planning and Development (OSHPD) State of California approved. Features: Permits secure quick connection to a structural steel beam where drilling and/or welding of a brace connection is not allowed or is not easily accomplished. Adjustable sizes to insure a proper t for a wide range of beam widths and ange thicknesses. Steel beam attachment is designed for concentric loadings of seismic connections and fasteners. Functions as a lateral or longitudinal structural connection of a sway brace assembly Installation Instructions: 1. Place Figure 772 on structural beam by loosening 1/2" hex bolts to correctly position C-clamp bodies. 2. C-clamp bodies should fully bottom out on the ange of beam. 3. Tighten 1/2" shear bolt until the head shears off. The use of an impact wrench is not recommended. 4. Tighten 1/2" hex head bolt into C-clamp bodies until lock washers bottom out on C-channel and the required torque of 55 Ft-Lbs is achieved. 5. Attach 700 Series Anvil Brace Fittings to the center bolt and adjust orientation as needed for proper brace angle. Ordering: Specify gure number, type, L channel Dim. (length), name and nish.
Shear Bolt
D
1 /2" Dia. Hex Head Mounting Bolt (Included)
Fig. 772 UL Max lOads: LOads (lbs) Weight (lbs) DimensiOns (in)
Type
A
Length (L)
9 12 14 9 12 14 17
Parallel to Beam
1000
D
1
Weight
3.15 3.74 4.19 3.15 3.90 4.35 4.90
/2 - 3/4
1600
/8 - 11/4
1000
1000
156 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 772
Fig. 772 FM Max lOads* LOads (lbs) Weight (lbs) DimensiOns (in) Angles (Degrees)
Type Length (L)
9 12 14 17 12 14 17 9 12 14 17 12 14 17 9 12 14 17 12 14 17 9 12 14 17 12 14 17
X Lateral
Z Longitudinal
Weight
3.15 3.74 4.19 4.74 3.90 4.35 4.90 3.15 3.74 4.19 4.74 3.90 4.35 4.90 3.15 3.74 4.19 4.74 3.90 4.35 4.90 3.15 3.74 4.19 4.74 3.90 4.35 4.90
30 - 44 BRACE ANGLE
A
3
/8 - /4
3
30 - 44
540
470
/8 - 11/4
30 - 44
470
330
45 - 59 BRACE ANGLE
3
/8 - /4
3
45 - 59
710
480
/8 - 11/4
45 - 59
740
640
60 - 74 BRACE ANGLE
3
/8 - 11/4
60 - 74
910
790
75 - 90 BRACE ANGLE
3
/8 - /4
3
75 - 90
980
640
/8 - 11/4
75 - 90
1000
880
See page 14 for notes on sway brace-seismic components concerning installation, performance and warranty.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
157
Index
Technical Data
* The allowable FM approved capacity of brace subassemblies have been determined by resolving the load rating to the horizontal direction and dividing by a safety factor of 1.5 to allow the values to be used directly for Allowable Stress Design. For Load Resistance Factor Design (LRFD) capacities, the above values will need to be multiplied by 1.5. ** Brace Pipe Angles are determined from vertical.
Application Examples
/8 - 3/4
60 - 74
880
580
Snubbers
Constant Supports
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Fig. 772
17" 12"-15"
W12x65 W12x72 W12x79 W14x90 W14x99 W24x104
B (7/8" - 11/4" Flange Thickness) 12" 14" 17" 7"-10" 9"-12" 12"-15"
W8x67 W21x93 W24x94 W10x77 W10x88 W10x100 W10x112 W14x82 W16x89 W16x100 W18x97 W18x106 W18x119 W24x94 W27x94 W27x114 W12x96 W12x106 W12x120 W12x136 W14x109 W14x120 W14x132 W21x111 W21x122 W21x132 W21x147 W24x117 W24x131 W24x146 W24x162 W27x146 W27x161 W27x178
Beam Size
See page 14 for notes on sway brace-seismic components concerning installation, performance and warranty.
158 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 779
Multi-Connector Adapter
6"
3 1 1
/8*
1 1
/2 /2 /8 /4
7 9
9 9
5 3
11 13
See page 14 for notes on sway brace-seismic components concerning installation, performance and warranty.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
159
Index
Technical Data
* 3/8" Mounting Bolt Fig. 777 Swivel Joint Connector ** 1/2" Mounting Bolt Series 700 Anvil Brace Fittings Size #1 with 3/8" mounting bolt is not UL Listed.
Application Examples
H1 Diameter
H2 Diameter
Service Pipe
Weight
Snubbers
2"
Constant Supports
Size Range:Service Line: 1" through 8" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Used to rigidly brace piping systems subjected to sway and seismic disturbances. Structural attachment component of Anvil's 700 series sway brace assembly. The multi-connector's two fasteners distributes the sway brace tting attachment load to the structure, which maximizes the load capacity of the brace tting. Can be utilized as a structural connection for either a lateral brace or longitudinal brace. Approvals: UL and ULC Listed (UL 203A:2009). Complies with seismic bracing requirements of NFPA-13. Installation Instructions: 1. NFPA 13 guidelines should be followed. 2. UL Maximum Load: 3,740 Lbs. Ordering: Specify size, gure number, name and nish.
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Fig. 773
Size Range: 34" thru 2" Swivel Ring Hanger, Figure 69 Material: Carbon steel Finish: Galvanized Service: Designed to be used with Anvil Figure 69, Adjustable Swivel Ring Hanger, for bracing steel service pipe against up thrust during a seismic disturbance or sprinkler head activation. Approvals: UL and ULC Listed (UL 203A:2009). Complies with seismic bracing requirements of NFPA-13. Features: One universal size accommodates ring hangers from 3/4" to 2". Quick and simple to install by just snapping the surge restrainer into a locking position onto the ring hanger. Installation Instructions: 1. The threaded hanger rod must protrude a minimum of 12" beyond the bottom of the knurl nut. 2. Snap the surge restrainer onto the threaded rod above and below the knurl nut. 3. When in the proper locking position, the maximum gap between the surge restrainer and the steel service pipe is an 1/8". Ordering: Specify gure number and name.
Surge Restrainer
Rod Size
3
UL Max Load
300
Weight
.08
/4 thru 2
/8
/8" Max.
See page 14 for notes on sway brace-seismic components concerning installation, performance and warranty.
160 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 777
Rod Size
3
UL Max Load
Restraint: 1,000 Hanger: Up to 4" Pipe
Weight
0.19
/8
Hanger Assembly
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
161
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
Constant Supports
Size Range: 3/8" rod diameter, Service Line: 1" through 4" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Zinc Plated Restraint Service: Used to restrain pipe systems. A lateral restraint connector that is attached to a structure or structural attachment for a branch line restraint assembly, consisting of a Figure 69 and Figure 773 "Surge Restrainer." Hanger Service: Used to adapt 3/8" threaded rod to angled building structures. Approvals: UL Listed (UL 203A), cULus Listed (UL203). Complies with hanging and seismic bracing requirements of NFPA-13. Features: Comes assembled and ready for installation 3/8-16UNC threaded hole to receive threaded rod Installation Instructions: 1. Install upper 3/8" mounting bolt into structure or structural attachment (restraint only) and tighten upper hex nut with split ring washer, include an additional hex nut to lock the upper nuts into place or thread the upper mounting bolt into a 700 Series attachment (restraint only). 2. Screw the hanger rod into the threaded hex union until it bottoms. Back off one turn and securely tighten rod nut to assure proper performance 3. Must be installed within 6 inches of a vertical hanger, when used as a component of a restraint device. 4. Adjust angle as necessary. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish.
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Fig. 771
Size Range: Brace Pipe: 1" or 114" Sch. 40 IPS OPA-2804-10 Service Line: 1" through 8" Material: Ductile iron, shear head bolts and hex head mounting bolt Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Used to rigidly brace piping systems subjected to sway and seismic disturbances. Brace pipe tting component of Anvil's 700 series sway brace assembly. Functions as a sway brace attachment that is directly attached to Fig. 772 Adjustable Beam Attachment, Fig. 778 Bar Joist Attachment and Fig. 779 Multi-Connector Adapter. Can be utilized as a brace tting for either a lateral brace or a longitudinal brace, that can be mounted on horizontal or vertical structures. Approvals: UL and ULC Listed (UL 203A:2009), and FM Approved (FM 1950:2010). Complies with seismic bracing requirements of NFPA-13. Ofce of Statewide Health Planning and Development (OSHPD) State of California approved. Features: Requires no threading of bracing pipe Sway brace tting designed for concentric loadings of seismic connections and fasteners. Installation Instructions: 1. Mount Figure 771 Sway Brace Fitting to structure using suitable fasteners as dened by NFPA-13. 2. Place the Schedule 40 brace pipe into the brace pipe connector until it bottoms out. 3. Tighten shear bolt until the head shears off. The use of an impact wrench is not recommended. 4. Then position the brace pipe to the appropriate angle. 5. Ensure that the brace tting hex bolt is tightened to a minimum torque value of 40 Ft-Lbs. Ordering: Specify brace pipe diameter, gure number, name and nish.
Fig. 771 Sway Brace Swivel Attachment 1" or 11/4" Sch. 40 Brace Pipe
Typical Assembly
(Bar Joist)
Typical Assembly
162 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
Fig. 771
Y Socket Depth
Bolt Diameter A
1
H
2.85 2.98
L
1.65
W
1.69
Y
1.38
Weight
1.95 2.28
Brace Angle*
30 - 44 45 - 59 60 - 74 75 - 90
FM Max Load
1800 2500 3100 3400
UL Max Load
2765
See page 14 for notes on sway brace-seismic components concerning installation, performance and warranty.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
163
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
* Brace Pipe Angles are determined from vertical. The allowable FM approved capacity of brace subassemblies have been determined by resolving the load rating to the horizontal direction and dividing by a safety factor of 1.5 to allow the values to be used directly for Allowable Stress Design. For Load Resistance Factor Design (LRFD) capacities, the above values will need to be multiplied by 1.5.
Snubbers
Fig. 771 FM MAX LOADS: LOads (lbs) DimensiOns (in) Angles (Degrees)
Constant Supports
/2
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
SpRINg HANgERS
Fig. 82, Fig. B-268, Fig. 98, Triple Spring, and Quadruple Spring Fig. C-82, Fig. C-268, Fig. C-98, Triple-CR, and Quadruple-CR Spring
(Corrosion Resistant)
Figure 98 Design features: Precompression. Precompressing the spring into the hanger casing provides the following advantages: (1) Saves up to 50% in headroom by reducing the length of the hanger. (2) Reduces the installed height of the overall hanger assembly. (3) Prevents the spring supporting force from exceeding the normal safe limits of variations. (4) Saves valuable erection time because spring is precompressed close to 12" of the working range. Calibration: all Anvil Variable Spring Hangers and supports are calibrated for accurate loading conditions. Load indicator is clearly seen in the slot, simplifying reading of the scale plate. Load is read from bottom of indicator. Cold set at the factory upon request. Spring and casing are fabricated of steel and are rugged and compact. Piston cap serves as a centering device or guide maintaining spring alignment. Casing protects the spring from damage and weather conditions. Standard Finish: Painted with semi-gloss primer. Corrosion Resistant: Anvil offers corrosion-resistant and weatherresistant Variable Spring Hangers to ll vital needs in the chemical and renery industries as well as in modern outdoor power plant construction. For protection against severe weather conditions or moderate corrosive conditions, the parts of the hanger are galvanized per ASTM A-153, except the spring which has a protective coating and the load column for Type F which is electro-galvanized. Advantages of a Protective Coating: Protects from a wide range of corrosives. Does not affect the ex life of the spring. Recommended for ambient temperatures up to 200 F Travel stop: The functional design of the pre-compressed variable spring hanger permits the incorporation of a two-piece travel stop that locks the hanger spring against upward or downward movement for temporary conditions of underload or overload. The complete travel stop, the up travel stop only for cold set purposes or the down travel stop only which may be employed during erection, hydrostatic test (Anvil permits a hydrostatic test load of 2 times the normal operating load for the spring hanger) or chemical cleanout will be furnished only when specied. The travel stop UP TRAVEL is painted red and is STOP installed at the factory INDICATOR METAL with a caution tag (Load is read from STRAPS bottom of indicator) attached calling attention that the device must be DOWN TRAVEL removed before the pipe STOP CAUTION line is put in service. TAG Permanently attached travel stops available upon request.
IO UT CA N
Approvals: WW-H-171E (Types 51, 56 and 57), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Types 51, 52 and 53). Specications: Anvil Variable Spring Hangers are welded in strict accordance with ASME Section IX. Size Range: The Anvil Variable Spring Hanger in ve series and seven types is offered in twenty-three sizes (Fig. B-268 only is offered in twentyve sizes). The hanger can be furnished to take loads 10 lbs. to 50,000 lbs. Ordering: (1) Size (2) Type (3) Figure number (4) Product name (5) Desired supporting force in operating position (6) Calculated amount and direction of pipe movement from installed to operating position. (7) Customers identication number (if any) When ordering Type F spring specify if roller or guided load (8) column is to be furnished. When ordering Type G, specify total load and load per spring plus (9) center to center rod dimensions. (10) If required, specify with travel stop (11) When ordering corrosion resistant, specify C-268, C-82, C-98, Triple-CR, or Quadruple-CR completely galvanized except coated spring coil. Note: To help alleviate the problem of lifting large size spring hangers into position for LIFTING installation, this product is LUGS Hole available with lifting lugs (if required) on sizes weighing one hundred pounds or more.
164 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/spring-hangers.com or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
SpRINg HANgERS
Pipe Supports Index Technical Data Master Format 3 Part Specs. Application Examples Special Design Products Snubbers Sway Strut Assembly Vibration Control & Sway Brace Constant Spring Sway Brace Supports Hangers Seismic Pipe Guides & Slides Pipe Roll Pipe Shields & Saddles Trapeze
Fig. 82, Fig. B-268, Fig. 98, Triple Spring, and Quadruple Spring (cont.) Fig. C-82, Fig. C-268, Fig. C-98, Triple-CR, and Quadruple-CR Spring
How to Determine Type: The type of variable spring hanger to be used depends upon the physical characteristics required by the suspension problem (e.g., amount of head room, whether pipe is to be supported above or below the spring, etc.). Consideration should be given to the seven standard types offered (see illustration below). Special variable spring hangers can be fabricated for unusual conditions.
(Corrosion Resistant)
Type E
Type F
Type G
Recommended Service: Pipe hangers located at points that are subject to vertical thermal movement and for which a constant support hanger is not required (see recommended service for constant support hanger, page 183). Type D & E spring hangers may accommodate less than 4 of rod swing depending on size, gure number, and application. Installation: Securely attach hanger to the building. Attach lower hanger rod and turn the load coupling until the load indicator is positioned at the desired setting indicated on the load scale plate.
Adjustment of Hanger: Once installed in the line; the hanger should be adjusted until the load indicator moves to the white button marked C (cold position). On inspection of the system, after a reasonable period of operation, the load indicator should be at the red button marked H (hot position). If it is not, the hanger should be readjusted to the hot position. No other adjustment is necessary. How to Determine Series: Complete sizing information is given on the hanger selection chart on pages 166 and 167. The sizing information is applicable to hangers of all series. As noted on the hanger selection charts that the total spring deection in the casing leaves a reserve (overtravel) above and below the recommended working load range.
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/spring-hangers.com or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
165
Straps
SpRINg HANgERS
Spring Hanger Size and Series Selection
How to use hanger selection table: In order to choose a proper size hanger, it is necessary to know the actual load which the spring is to support and the amount and direction of the pipe line movement from the cold to the hot position. Find the actual load of the pipe in the load table. As it is desirable to support the actual weight of the pipe when the line is hot, the actual load is the hot load. To determine the cold load, read the spring scale, up or down, for the amount of expected movement. The chart must be read opposite from the direction of the pipes movement. The load arrived at is the cold load. If the cold load falls outside of the working load range of the hanger selected, relocate the actual or hot load in the adjacent column and nd the cold load. When the hot and cold loads are both within the working range of a hanger, the size number of that hanger will be found at the top of the column.
Fig. 82, Fig. B-268, Fig. 98, Triple & Quadruple Spring
0
43 44 46 48 50 52 54 56 58 59 61 63 65 67 69 71 73 74 76 78 80 82 84 86 88 89 91 93 95 30 15 7 5 4
00
19 20 22 24 26 28 30 31 34 35 38 40 41 43 45 47 49 50 53 55 56 58 60 62 64 66 68 70 72 15
1
63 66 68 71 74 76 79 81 84 87 89 92 95 97 100 102 105 108 110 113 116 118 121 123 126 129 131 134 137 42 21 10 7 5
2
81 84 88 91 95 98 101 105 108 111 115 118 122 125 128 132 135 138 142 145 149 152 155 159 162 165 169 172 176 54 27 13 9 7
3
105 109 114 118 123 127 131 136 140 144 149 153 158 162 166 171 175 179 184 188 193 197 201 206 210 214 219 223 228 70 35 17 12 9
4
141 147 153 159 165 170 176 182 188 194 200 206 212 217 223 229 235 241 247 253 258 264 270 276 282 288 294 300 306 94 47 23 16 12
5
189 197 206 213 221 228 236 244 252 260 268 276 284 291 299 307 315 323 331 339 347 354 362 370 378 386 394 402 410 126 63 31 21 16
6
252 263 273 284 294 305 315 326 336 347 357 368 378 389 399 410 420 431 441 452 462 473 483 494 504 515 525 536 546 168 84 42 28 21
7
336 350 364 378 392 406 420 434 448 462 476 490 504 518 532 546 560 574 588 602 616 630 644 658 672 686 700 714 728 224 112 56 37 28
8
450 469 488 506 525 544 563 581 600 619 638 656 675 694 713 731 750 769 788 806 825 844 863 881 900 919 938 956 975 300 150 75 50 38
9
600 625 650 675 700 725 750 775 800 825 850 875 900 925 950 975 1,000 1,025 1,050 1,075 1,100 1,125 1,150 1,175 1,200 1,225 1,250 1,275 1,300 400 200 100 67 50
2 0
1 2
1
1 0
112
14 14 15 16
17 18 19 20
4 2
1
1 2
1
21 21 22 23
24 25 26 27
10 2
712 112
5 1
212
1
114
1
28 28 29 30 31
Note: General rule for series selection use Fig. 82 for up to 12" of movement up to 1" use Fig. B-268, up to 2" use Fig. 98, up to 3" use a Triple, up to 4" use a Quadruple. Double check to assure desired variability is achieved.
166 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/spring-hangers.com or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
SpRINg HANgERS
Pipe Supports Straps
Figure No.
21 22 82 B-268 98 Triple Quad.
1,020 1,063 1,105 1,148 1,190 1,233 1,275 1,318 1,360 1,403 1,445 1,488 1,530 1,573 1,615 1,658 1,700 1,743 1,785 1,828 1,870 1,913 1,955 1,998 2,040 2,083 2,125 2,168 2,210 680 340 170 113 85
1,350 1,406 1,463 1,519 1,575 1,631 1,688 1,744 1,800 1,856 1,913 1,969 2,025 2,081 2,138 2,194 2,250 2,306 2,363 2,419 2,475 2,531 2,588 2,644 2,700 2,756 2,813 2,869 2,925 900 450 225 150 113
1,800 1,875 1,950 2,025 2,100 2,175 2,250 2,325 2,400 2,475 2,550 2,625 2,700 2,775 2,850 2,925 3,000 3,075 3,150 3,225 3,300 3,375 3,450 3,525 3,600 3,675 3,750 3,825 3,900 1,200 600 300 200 150
2,400 2,500 2,600 2,700 2,800 2,900 3,000 3,100 3,200 3,300 3,400 3,500 3,600 3,700 3,800 3,900 4,000 4,100 4,200 4,300 4,400 4,500 4,600 4,700 4,800 4,900 5,000 5,100 5,200 1,600 800 400 267 200
3,240 3,375 3,510 3,645 3,780 3,915 4,050 4,185 4,320 4,455 4,590 4,725 4,860 4,995 5,130 5,265 5,400 5,535 5,670 5,805 5,940 6,075 6,210 6,345 6,480 6,615 6,750 6,885 7,020 2,160 1,080 540 360 270
4,500 4,688 4,875 5,063 5,250 5,438 5,625 5,813 6,000 6,188 6,375 6,563 6,750 6,938 7,125 7,313 7,500 7,688 7,875 8,063 8,250 8,438 8,625 8,813 9,000 9,188 9,375 9,563 9,750 3,000 1,500 750 500 375
6,000 6,250 6,500 6,750 7,000 7,250 7,500 7,750 8,000 8,250 8,500 8,750 9,000 9,250 9,500 9,750
10,610 14,100 18,750 25,005 11,053 14,588 19,531 26,047 11,495 15,275 20,313 27,089 11,938 15,863 21,094 28,131 12,380 16,450 21,875 29,173 12,823 17,038 22,656 30,215 13,265 17,625 23,438 31,256
1 1
1 0
112 0
2 0
10,317 13,708 18,213 24,219 32,298 10,650 14,150 18,800 25,000 33,340 10,982 14,592 19,388 25,781 34,382 11,315 15,035 19,975 26,563 35,424 11,647 15,477 20,563 27,344 36,466 11,980 15,920 21,150 28,125 37,508 12,312 16,362 21,738 28,906 38,549 12,645 16,805 22,325 29,688 39,591 12,977 17,247 22,913 30,469 40,633
3 1
112
10,000 13,310 17,690 23,500 31,250 41,675 10,250 13,642 18,132 24,088 32,031 42,717 10,500 13,975 18,575 24,675 32,813 43,759 10,750 14,307 19,017 25,263 33,594 44,801 11,000 14,640 19,460 25,850 34,375 45,843 11,250 14,972 19,902 26,438 35,156 46,885 11,500 15,305 20,345 27,025 35,938 47,926 11,750 15,637 20,787 27,613 36,719 48,968 12,000 15,970 21,230 28,200 37,500 50,010 12,250 16,302 21,672 28,788 38,281 51,052 12,500 16,635 22,115 29,375 39,063 52,094 12,750 16,967 22,557 29,963 39,844 53,136 13,000 17,300 23,000 30,550 40,625 54,178 4,000 2,000 1,000 667 500 5,320 2,660 1,330 887 665 7,080 3,540 1,770 1,180 885 9,400 4,700 2,350 1,567 1,175
112
412
114
1
212
1
5 1
712 112
10 2
Note: General rule for series selection use Fig. 82 for up to 12" of movement up to 1" use Fig. B-268, up to 2" use Fig. 98, up to 3" use a Triple, up to 4" use a Quadruple. Double check to assure desired variability is achieved.
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/spring-hangers.com or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
167
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
SpRINg HANgERS
Variable Spring Check List for Requesting a Quote or Ordering
Anvil International Precision Park 160 Frenchtown Rd. North Kingstown, RI 02852
For technical information regarding Variable Springs Call or Email: Phone Number: (401) 886-3020 Email: eps_contact@anvilintl.com
Finish: Standard Primer: __________ Galvanized: __________ Special Coating: _______________ Quantity: _______________ Figure No.: Options a re: 82, B-268, 98, Triple, Quadruple or: C-82, C-268, C-98, Triple-CR, Quadruple-CR Size: Options are: #0 through #22 (B-268 / C-268 also available in #00 and #000) ______________________ Type: Options are: A through G* ___________________________ Hot (Operating or Design) Load (lbs): _______________ (optional)** Cold/Installed (Factory Set) Load (lbs): _______________ (optional)** Vertical Movement: _______________ + (up) or (down) (optional)** Mark Number: _______________ (If Required) Travel Stops: Yes: _______________ No: _______________ If travel stops are ordered and hot & cold loads are not provided, then the spring will be set to mid range load. Lifting Lugs: Yes: _________ No: __________ Available on sizes weighing 100 lbs or more. Notes: * Type G Springs must also include the C-to-C dimension & the load per spring. ** Anvil will determine the appropriate Figure Number and will calculate the Cold Load when only the Hot Load and movement are specied.
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/spring-hangers.com or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
168 PH-1.14
SpRINg HANgERS
MIN.=Z MAX.=Z+3 1/2" ROD SIZE "A" ROD NOT FURNISHED LENGTH OF R.H. TH'D SEE TABLE BELOW
Weight
5 6 8 8 9 14 15 16 26 29 31 65 71 65 71 89 93 111 133 162 330 376 480 556 705
Rod Size A
1
2 2
5 5
71516 71316
10 10 16 1218 10716 10716 1318 1314 1314 16116 1818 1814 2012 2334 27516 3338
7
658
838
9116 8 16 1138 978 912 1138 1138 1138 141316 1634 16 1838 2158 2378 2934
15
15
16
5 3
6 6 7 7 8 9 10 10 11
858
1034
114
10 4
3 3
1 4
1
858
11 8 1578 1678
1234 1234
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/spring-hangers.com or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
169
Index
Technical Data
858
1034
114
Application Examples
4 4
518 518
15
16 16
16 16
13 16 1316 3
15
5916
61516
15
16
16
1 1 138 11 16 9 16
Snubbers
Casing Length B
Casing Diam C
Flange Diam D
Thread Depth G
DEFL. (IN.) LOAD (LB.) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. B-268 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
SpRINg HANgERS
H
DEFL. (IN.) LOAD (LB.) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. B-268 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
LOAD INDICATOR B
LOAD INDICATOR B
ROD SIZE "A" ROD NOT FURNISHED LENGTH OF R.H. TH'D. SEE TABLE BELOW
Fig. B-268 Type B Type B is furnished with a single lug for attachment to the building structure. The lug permits use of a clevis, welded beam attachment or a pair of angles for attachment where headroom is limited.
ROD SIZE "A" ROD NOT FURNISHED LENGTH OF R.H. TH'D. SEE TABLE BELOW
Type C is furnished with two lugs for attachment to the building structure. These two lugs permit the use of an eye rod, Fig. 55L or a single plate for attachment where headroom is limited.
R
114 114 114 114 114 112 2 2 212 3 4 4
Z
13 16 1316 3
2 2 2 8 4
5 5 5 5 6 6 7 7 8 9 10 10 11
11
16 16 16 16 16
11
4 4 5916 6 8
5
15
16 16 16 16
8 8 8
4 4 4 4 8 2 8 8 4 4
15
11
15
858 81316
5 13
1 1 138 11 16 9 16
5
10 10 16 1218 10716 10716 1318 1314 1314 16116 1818 1814 2012 2334 27516 3338
7
15
1116 114 158 2 2 238 258 278 318 338 358 378
15
5 5 3
1 1
170 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/spring-hangers.com or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
SpRINg HANgERS
MUST BE PINNED BY CUSTOMER RIGHT HAND THREADS ROD SIZE "A" ROD NOT FURNISHED LENGTH OF R.H. TH'D. SEE TABLE BELOW COUPLING POSITION AT MAXIMUM LOAD
3 1/2"
Fig. B-268 Type D Type D permits adjustment of the hanger from the top. This type has a piece of tubing which passes through a hole in the top cap. Type D is especially adapted for use where the hanger is set above the supporting beams and pipe is suspended below.
2 2
5 5 5 6 6 7 7 8 9 10 11
15
16 16
114 114 112 134 214 3 3 312 4 4916 5 5916 614 658
318 318 3 3 3 3 3 3
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 7
15
1234 1234
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/spring-hangers.com or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
171
Index
Technical Data
114
Application Examples
10
15
16
Snubbers
518
13
16
114
318
10 1134 11116 111516 121116 111116 12516 13 13516 1414 1434 1558 1678 141116 151316 1838 1914 1934 22916 2518 251116 2838 32316 35916 42
Rod Size A
Casing Length B
Casing Diam C
Flange Diam D
Rod Length Y
Rod Take-out Q
Fig. B-268 Type E Type E is designed to permit adjustment from either above or below the hanger, when it is installed upon the supporting member and pipe is suspended below. A coupling tapped right hand both ends is furnished.
DEFL. (IN.) LOAD (LB.) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. B-268 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
Pipe Roll
LOAD INDICATOR
ROD SIZE "A" ROD AND NUT NOT FURNISHED LENGTH TO SUIT CUSTOMER
DEFL. (IN.) LOAD (LB.) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. B-268 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
LOAD INDICATOR
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
SpRINg HANgERS
Type F is for use under a base elbow or piping that must be supported directly from the oor. If more than 14" of horizontal translation occurs of loads resting on the at load ange or other at surface junction between the type F spring hanger and the load, a double roller design pipe roll is recommended. Pipe rolls, as illustrated above, will be furnished on request. For dimension of the pipe roll, refer to Fig. 271, see page 133.
ase type variable springs will be furnished with an extended load column B on special order. Guided Load Columns and roller are available on request. djustment to the required load rating is made by inserting a bar into A holes provided in the load column and turning the column. The 2" increment between minimum and maximum X dimensions is the amount of eld adjustment available and is in excess of the amount required for load adjustment.
000 11 51116 7316 9316 5 1 3 4 518 712 7 834 8 4 1.9 378 16 00 12 758 918 1118 0 12 634 814 1014 5 1 3 1 14 758 4 518 712 7 834 8 4 918 1118 1.9 378 16 3 7 7 2 15 8 8 9 8 11 8 3 23 8 9916 11916 3 1 3 5916 4 25 61516 712 7 834 4 4 2.875 538 16 5 26 81116 1014 1214 6 40 81516 1012 1212 5 3 7 3 3 1 7 46 6 8 8 8 9 8 10 8 4 8 3.5 638 4 1018 111116 131116 8 47 9 91 10916 1218 1418 1 5 3 1 9 1 13 3 1 1 10 98 12 4 8 8 10 4 13 4 10 16 16 2 4 2 13 16 151316 4.5 838 2 11 90 10916 1218 1418 12 95 10916 1218 1418 5 3 1 9 1 3 1 1 13 115 8 8 10 4 13 4 10 16 16 2 4 2 4.5 838 2 1314 141316 161316 14 119 15 130 1314 1034 141316 161316 4.5 1 9 1 15 3 1 1 16 150 151516 858 13 4 10 16 16 2 4 2 17 16 191516 838 2 1138 2.0 17 173 18 20 22 18 343 1814 20516 22516 3 5 1 19 380 2012 1234 1578 1714 1534 22 4 8 22916 24916 2.5 1212 2 3 13 13 20 471 23 4 25 16 27 16 21 496 27516 29716 31716 3 5 1 1234 1678 1714 1534 22 4 8 3.0 1212 2 22 654 3338 3512 3712 * Hanger take-out or installed height. With pipe movement up, cold to hot, installed height should be the mid-point between the minimum and maximum X dimension, plus thickness of load ange. With pipe movement down, cold to hot installed height should be mid-point between the minimum and maximum X dimension, plus the amount of vertical movement and load ange thickness. Note: Sizes 16" and larger are furnished with a hexagon nut at the top of a solid load column to facilitate adjustment with a wrench.
172 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/spring-hangers or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
SpRINg HANgERS
P W
N
FIG. B-268 SIZE TYPE G MARKNO. SPG.RATE LB./IN. 2 1/2 2 1/4 2 1 3/4 1 1/2 1 1/4 1 3/4 1/2 1/4 0 DEFL. (IN.) LOAD (LB.)
LOAD INDICATOR
Max C-C
24 24
Z
13 16 1316 3
518
15
16
1516 1916 2116 2716 134 158 11116 212 314 3716 31316 314 318 31516 418 4 4 418 4516 438
C3 x 4.1
112
7 16
15 5
5916
61516
15
16
C3 x 4.1
30
10 10716 1218 10716 10716 1318 1314 1314 16116 1818 1814 2012 2334 27516 3338
658
838
15
16
C3 x 4.1
36
5 3
6 7 7 8 9 10 10 11
858
1034 1034
114
36 33
112 112
8 8
5
1138 15 8
7
1 16
15
36 42 40 48
12 4
3
2 4
3
3 3
1234
1678
358
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/spring-hangers or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
173
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
8 8
5
10 4
3
1 4
1
C4 x 5.4
36
1 4
1
8 8 81316
1 1 138 11 16 9 16
Snubbers
518
15
16
138 134
C3 x 4.1
112
Min R.H. Casing Casing Flange Thread Thread Length Dia. Dia. Engagement Length B C D F
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
SpRINg HANgERS
Fig. 82 Type C
D S T R H
LOAD INDICATOR T
0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4
B J
DEFL. (IN.) LOAD (LB.) SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. -82 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
SIZE MARKNO.
FIG.
-82 TYPE
LOAD INDICATOR B
F "A"
C
F
"A"
MIN.=Z MAX.=Z+134"
Fig. 82 Type D
K "A" LOAD INDICATOR LOAD SCALE & NAME PLATE D
Fig. 82 Type E
D LOAD INDICATOR FIELD PINNED OR TACKED ROD SIZE "A"
Fig. 82 Type F
LOAD COLUMN D
0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4
DEFL. (IN.) LOAD (LB.) SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. -82 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
LOAD INDICATOR
B X
LOAD SCALE & NAME PLATE F C Q R.H. TH'DS. F C E' FIELD PINNED
FOUR SLOTS
C 134"
Fig. 82 Type G
"A" C - C ROD DIMENSION AS SPECIFIED MIN = Z MAX = Z + 134" P W F N
DEFL. (IN.) LOAD (LB.) SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. -82 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
B
0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4
he Anvil variable short spring hanger, Fig. T 82, embodies all of the Fig. B-268 features and is designed to the same exacting specications. This is useful in conned areas where thermal movement of the piping is relatively small. The minimum and maximum loads for the individual sizes of the Fig. 82 are exactly the same as those for the Fig. B-268. This hanger is offered in the seven basic types as shown here. The load table and instructions for sizing and ordering this hanger are found on page 164 through 167.
LOAD INDICATOR
174 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/spring-hangers or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
SpRINg HANgERS
Casing Min Rod R.H. Flange Hanger Thread Size Thread Length Dia. Dia. Size Engage A Length D B C F Rod Take Out By Type Z
A E B,C J E Q G N
Type A
Types B, C
R Clevis Opening S
7
Type D
Rod Nut Height Thk. T Length Allow. Spacer Y K M
1
Weight Type
A,B,C D,E F G*
Bottom Flange
Bolts
5
Thick
1
Min
Max
1714
1534
22
3.00
1212
n
Hanger take-out or installed height. With pipe movement up, cold to hot, installed height should be the mid point between the minimum and maximum X dimension, plus thickness of load ange. With pipe movement down, cold to hot installed height should be mid-point between the minimum and maximum X dimension, plus the amount of vertical movement and load ange thickness. (Type F only). * Weight based on 24" center-to-center dimension. See page 172 for Type F roller and guided load column information. Attachment rods and nuts not furnished.
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/spring-hangers or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
175
Index
Technical Data
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
16
24 30 36 36 36 33 36
4 4 4
4 4 4 4 4 4
4 8 2 2 2 8
16 4 2 2 2 2
81516 91516 91516 101516 81516 91516 81516 91516 10716 11716 10916 11916 10916 11916 1258 1358 1378 1478 15116 16116 16116 17116 18316 19316 2018 2118 2438 2538
1 1 1
Application Examples
Snubbers
Length X n
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
434
3
5 8
1
15
16
15
16
13
16
112
114
1116
112
134
4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1034 1138 15 8
7
114 11516 2 4
3
16 8
7
3 8
5
3 3 4 4 2
1
2 2 212 3 4 4
412 5
5 5
8 8 4
1 1
134
714 814 858 714 714 834 858 878 878 1058 858 1178 13 14 1234 1618 18 1234 2214
1034
114
15
16
112 2
114 112
114 158
8 2
134 214
134
1034
114
114
134
Pipe Roll
15
16
5116 5116 6316 51516 618 738 6316 6316 738 738 738 9516 10916 101116 1134 14 1358 1758
218
16
11
16
112
114
114
134
7316 8516 218 8116 858 2 978 81116 81116 1038 2 1138 1138 2 131116 6 141516 13 16 16 1838 6 2058 2078 7 2538
614 6 7 638
2 8
1
1 4 118 5 8 114 118 178 218 178 178 218 11516 118 234 212 212 1116 2116 7 16 1 118 3 8 238
3
16
11
16
1 2
1
1 4
1
712 734 838 778 814 858 9116 91116 91516 1114 1134 10716 1114 1258 1358 1418 1578 1758 19316 2058 23516 25 2958
114
134
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
SpRINg HANgERS
Double Spring
Fig. 98 Type C
D S R
H H M
DEFL.(IN.) LOAD (LB.) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 11/4 11/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 23/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. -98 SIZE TYPE MARKNO. DEFL.(IN.) LOAD (LB.) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 11/4 11/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 23/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. -98 SIZE TYPE MARKNO. DEFL.(IN.) LOAD (LB.) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 11/4 11/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 23/4 3 3 1/4
Fig. 98 Type B
D
Fig. 98 Type D
T
K D ROD SIZE "A"
LOAD INDICATOR
J B
3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. -98 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
MIN.=Z MAX.=Z+7"
MIN.=Z MAX.=Z+7"
MIN.=Z MAX.=Z+7" C
Fig. 98 Type E
D
Fig. 98 Type F
LOAD FLANGE LOAD COLUMN
Fig. 98 Type G
C-C ROD DIMENSION AS SPECIFIED C ROD SIZE "A"
DEFL.(IN.) LOAD (LB.) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 11/4 11/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 23/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. -98 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
N W
SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. -98 SIZE TYPE MARKNO. DEFL.(IN.) LOAD (LB.) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 11/4 11/2
1/2 3/4 1 11/4 11/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 23/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. -98 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
LOAD INDICATOR
FOUR SLOTS
F MUST BE PINNED BY CUSTOMER R.H. TH'DS. F ROD SIZE "A" 7" COUPLING POSITION AT MAXIMUM LOAD
C E
*ROD, NUTS & WASHERS NOT FURNISHED LENGTH OF R.H. THD (SEE TDIM. TABLE)
he Anvil Variable Double Spring Hanger, Fig. 98, embodies all of the Fig. B-268 features and is designed T to the same exacting specications. Each basic unit consists of two springs arranged in series within a single casing. A centering guide is provided to assure the permanent alignment of the spring assembly. This hanger is offered in the seven basic types as shown here. The load table and instructions for sizing and ordering this hanger may be found on page 164 through 167.
176 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/spring-hangers or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
SpRINg HANgERS
Pipe Supports Index Technical Data Master Format 3 Part Specs. Application Examples Special Design Products Snubbers Sway Strut Assembly Vibration Control & Sway Brace G* Constant Spring Sway Brace Supports Hangers Seismic Pipe Guides & Slides Pipe Roll Pipe Shields & Saddles Trapeze Rod R.H. Hanger Size Thread Size A Length Casing
Length B
Type A
Thread Lug Depth Hole G Size
7
Types B, C
Pin Hgt H
1
Type D
Rod Length Y Nut Height Allow. Spacer K M
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
9 9 10
10 10 11 12 12 13 14 14 15
1258 1438 1578 14 1514 1658 161116 1858 19916 20316 2258 1814 1912 2434 2478 2478 2978 34 3314 3734 4414 4978 62
5 8
1
15
16
5916 61516
15
16
658
838
15
16
858
1034
114
858
1034 1034
114
8 8
5
1138
11516
1234 1578 12 4 16 8
3 7
234 3 8
5
112 12316 1418 15 7 13 16 15 8 9 112 15316 1718 114 178 13716 1538 3 1 15 16 17 8 9 238 151516 1778 134 178 151516 18116 18316 20516 9 2316 181116 201316 134 7 3 21116 18 8 21 8 9 2138 2378 234 1678 1938 12 258 338 1778 2078 1 1 23 4 26 4 12 312 2318 2718 314 2318 2718 12 314 4116 28916 321516 7 13 3 32 16 37 16 4316 418 3118 37316 3512 4218 7 4 4218 4834 418 3516 45716 521116 7 5818 6618 418
16
11
16
1 2 1 4
1
16
11
16
112 114
13
16
112 114
1116
15
16
8 2 8 8 4 4
5 5 3 3
1 1
1938 2118 2212 2034 22 2338 231116 2558 26916 27716 2978 2512 2714 3238 3338 3334 3878 4312 43316 4818 55316 6058 7318
114
512
114
512
112
512
512
512
512
512 512
Weight Type
A,B,C D,E F
Bottom Flange
Bolts
5
Thick
1
Length X n
Min Max
3
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
n
8 4 4 4 4 4 4 4
4 4 8 2 2 2 8 8
16 16 4 2 2 2 2 2
14 16 151516 17716 1558 1678 1814 1838 20516 2114 2178 24516 191516 21316 26716 26916 26916 3178 36 35516 391316 46516 5178 64
3
16 16 171516 C3 x 4.1 19716 1758 1878 C3 x 4.1 2014 2038 22516 C3 x 4.1 2314 2378 26516 C4 x 5.4 211516 23316 28716 C5 x 6.7 28916 28916 C6 x 10.5 3378 C8 x 11.5 38 5 37 16 411316 C12 x 20.7 48516 5378 C15 x 33.9 66
8 4
112 2 2 3 4 4 4 4
12 14 16 22 25 27 41 49 61 97 114 96 108 144 153 172 218 273 512 600 802 940 1,240
12 14 16 21 24 26 40 48 52 94 108 95 104 139 147 163 202 247 477 548 723 845 1,140
20 21 23 35 39 41 62 72 75 136 150 134 144 181 188 201 241 287 550 624 807 872 1,184
37 41 45 55 61 65 93 109 133 207 241 209 223 305 323 368 462 572 1,056 1,231 1,633 1,965 2,566
Hanger take-out or installed height. With pipe movement up, cold to hot, installed height should be the mid point between the minimum and maximum X dimension, plus thickness of load ange. With pipe movement down, cold to hot installed height should be mid-point between the minimum and maximum X dimension, plus the amount of vertical movement and load ange thickness. (Type F only). * Weight based on 24" center-to-center dimension. See page 172 for Type F roller and guided load column information. Attachment rods and nuts not furnished.
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/spring-hangers or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
177
Straps
SpRINg HANgERS
Triple Spring, Triple Spring-CR
Triple Type A
ROD SIZE* "A" G D LOAD INDICATOR R T H
Triple Type B
D
Triple Type C
D S T R H
Triple Type D
K D ROD SIZE "A"
M
DEFL.(IN) LOAD (LB) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 LB IN SPG.RATE TRIPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO. DEFL.(IN) LOAD (LB) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 LB IN SPG.RATE TRIPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO. DEFL.(IN) LOAD (LB) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 LB IN SPG.RATE TRIPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO. DEFL.(IN) LOAD (LB) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 LB IN SPG.RATE TRIPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO.
LOAD INDICATOR
LOAD INDICATOR
LOAD INDICATOR
Triple Type E
D MUST BE PINNED OR TACKED BY CUSTOMER LOAD INDICATOR
Triple Type F
D LOAD FLANGE
Triple Type G
C-C ROD DIMENSION AS SPECIFIED NOT TO EXCEED C-C MAX ROD SIZE "A" C
DEFL.(IN) LOAD (LB) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 LB IN SPG.RATE TRIPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO.
LOAD INDICATOR
DEFL.(IN) LOAD (LB) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 LB IN SPG.RATE TRIPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO.
N B
DEFL.(IN) LOAD (LB) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 LB IN SPG.RATE
D MUST BE PINNED BY CUSTOMER R.H. TH'DS. F Q F 1012" COUPLING POSITION AT MAXIMUM LOAD
he Anvil Variable Triple Spring Hanger embodies all of the Fig. B-268 features and is designed to T the same exacting specications. Each basic unit consists of three springs arranged in series within a single casing. A centering guide is provided to assure the permanent alignment of the spring assembly. This hanger is offered in the seven basic types as shown here. The load table and instructions for sizing and ordering this hanger may be found on page 164 through 167.
178 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/spring-hangers or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
SpRINg HANgERS
Pipe Supports Straps
General Dimensions Hanger Size Rod R.H. Casing Casing Min Size Thread Length Dia. Thread A Length B C F
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 1 1 4
1 1 3 5 1 1
B&C J
2058 2314 2512 221116 24 16
9
D Y
2818 3034 33 30316 32 16
1
E Q
1118
G N
112
201516 221516
7
24 21316 5 16
9 15
251316 23 11 8
1
27916 25 2678
15
15
25 8
1
25 8
1
26 8
5 1
34 8
1
26 16 28 16
15
12 8 13
25 16
15
34 16
3
16
112
71116
2978 3114
26 16
11 9
26 16
11 9
2 378 4 10 16
9
28 4
3 5
13 14 14 15
28 16 3614 36 4
3 5
858
114 1 8
3 3
28 16 114 3614 36 4
3 5
30 16
9
2 4
1
30 8 7916 38516
13
3258 40516
13
3814 39 8
5 1
46116 47 16
5 3
1112
36 8 44116 5014 4918 5578 6558 73516 9112 1234 1234 858
1 8 11516
1 4
1
7 16
9
234
234
5578 6558
58116
17 17 18
358
358
73516 9112
Attachment rods and nuts not furnished. See page 172 for Type F roller and guided load column information.
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/spring-hangers or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
179
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
16
Snubbers
11516
11116
7116
212
38 16 40 16
13
3314
858
114
114
3314
1112
134
16
16
23 16
16
1 4
7 4
24 8
15
16
16
2134
16
114
734
23916
25916
112
Pipe Roll
Depth Thread G
Type A
Type D
Type F
Type G
Trapeze
SpRINg HANgERS
Quadruple Spring, Quadruple Spring-CR
Quadruple Type A
D G ROD SIZE* "A" LOAD INDICATOR R T H
Quadruple Type B
D
Quadruple Type C
D S T R H
Quadruple Type D
K D
M
QUADRUPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO. LB/IN SPG.RATE 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 7 3/4 8 8 1/4 8 1/2 8 3/4 9 9 1/4 9 1/2 9 3/4 10 DEFL.(IN) LOAD (LB) QUADRUPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO. LB/IN SPG.RATE 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 7 3/4 8 8 1/4 8 1/2 8 3/4 9 9 1/4 9 1/2 9 3/4 10 DEFL.(IN) LOAD (LB)
QUADRUPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO. SPG.RATE 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 7 3/4 8 8 1/4 8 1/2 8 3/4 9 9 1/4 9 1/2 9 3/4 10 DEFL.(IN) LB/IN
LOAD INDICATOR
LOAD INDICATOR
SPG.RATE 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 7 3/4 8 8 1/4 8 1/2 8 3/4 9 9 1/4 9 1/2 9 3/4 10 DEFL.(IN)
LB/ IN
LOAD INDICATOR
MIN.=Z MAX.=Z+14"
MIN.=Z MAX.=Z+14"
MIN.=Z MAX.=Z+14"
C
Quadruple Type E
D
Quadruple Type F
D LOAD FLANGE
Quadruple Type G
C-C ROD DIMENSION AS SPECIFIED NOT TO EXCEED C-C MAX ROD SIZE "A" C
QUADRUPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO. SPG.RATE 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 7 3/4 8 8 1/4 8 1/2 8 3/4 9 9 1/4 9 1/2 9 3/4 10 DEFL.(IN) LB/ IN
QUADRUPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO. SPG.RATE LB/IN 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 7 3/4 8 8 1/4 8 1/2 8 3/4 9 9 1/4 9 1/2 9 3/4 10 DEFL.(IN) LOAD (LB)
LOAD INDICATOR
LOAD SCALE & NAME PLATE
N B
LOAD (LB)
B
DEFL.(IN) LOAD (LB) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 LB IN SPG.RATE
FOUR SLOTS
LOAD INDICATOR
C E'
MUST BE PINNED BY CUSTOMER R.H. TH'DS. ROD SIZE "A" F F Q
he Anvil Variable Quadruple Spring Hanger embodies all of the Fig. B-268 features and is designed T to the same exacting specications. Each basic unit consists of four springs arranged in series within a single casing. A centering guide is provided to assure the permanent alignment of the spring assembly. This hanger is offered in the seven basic types as shown here. The load table and instructions for sizing and ordering this hanger may be found on page 164 through 167.
14"
180 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/spring-hangers or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
SpRINg HANgERS
Pipe Supports Straps
General Dimensions Hanger Size Rod R.H. Casing Casing Min Size Thread Length Dia. Thread A Length B C F
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 1 1 4
1 1 3 5 1 1
B&C J
2658 3018 3318 2938 3178 34 8
5
D Y
3718 4058 4358 3978 4238 45 8
1
E Q
1518
G N
112
261516 281516
7
33716
35716
33 8
1
34 16 36 16
15 15
32 16
15
32 16
15
34 16
7
45 8
1
3478 1518 2
5
3678 2
16
3678 38 16
11 13
658
15
16
15
16
3678 38 16
11
3838 40 16
3 5
49116 50 8
7
112
7916
381316 401316 40 8
5 7
42 8
5
17
35 3712 114 1 8
3 3
2 378 4 15 2
1
39116 41916 4
214 1 212 3
17
4734 48 8
3 1
858
1512
491316 511316 50 16
7 3
1 4 112 1 4
3
18 19 19 20
48 8 5778 66 8
1 1
1 8 858 11516
1 4
1
48 8 5778 66 8
1 1
51 6078 69 8
1 1
61 16 71716 80 16
3
50 16 7116
52316 4
15 16
9
4 4 16
9
68 16
3
70 16
3
64 8 7318 8618 9578 12018 1234 358 358 1234 234 234
78 16
11
14 8
7
66 16
5
8818
15716
214
5 5916
75516 88516
21
614 658
Attachment rods and nuts not furnished. See page 172 for Type F roller and guided load column information.
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/spring-hangers or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
181
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
12418 138716
9516
98 12214
Snubbers
11516
15116
138
312
591516 611516
52 16
7
16
38 16
13
40 16 4514
51 8
1
4334
56116
1512
134
40 8 7116
4278 3
451316 471316
16
15
16
3038
16
114
734
32316
34316
15
16
16
2858
16
114
734
30716
32716
112
Pipe Roll
Depth Thread G
Type A
Type D
Type F
Type G
Trapeze
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Model R
he exclusive geometric design of Anvil Model R Constant T Support Hanger assures perfectly constant support through the entire deection of the pipe load. This counter-balancing of the load and spring moments about the main pivot is obtained by the use of carefully designed compression type load springs, lever, and spring tension rods. s the lever moves from the high to the low position, the load A spring is compressed and the resulting increasing force acting on the decreasing spring moment arm creates a turning moment about the main pivot which is exactly equal and opposite to the turning moment of the load and load moment arm. s the lever moves from the low to the high position, the load A spring is increasing in length and the resulting decreasing force acting on the increasing spring moment arm creates a turning moment about the main pivot which is exactly equal and opposite to the turning moment of the load and load moment arm.
Load Pivot
L
Main Pivot Fixed Load Spring Spring Pivot Moveable Trunion Spring Pivot Plate Spring Tension Rod Load Adjustment Bolt
VERTICAL
9.921
E B
A D
B Z
VERTICAL
D W X L Y HORIZONTAL Z P
W SIN
D Y HORIZONTAL
W
L A
W SIN
High Position
Middle Position
Low Position
(1)
sin = X Y sin = X Z
The spring force F is equal to the spring constant K times the spring deection E; thus: (6) F = KE; Therefore equation (5) may be written as: (7) Spring Moment = KE YZsin
X = sin YZ
and (3)
X = YZsin
To obtain perfect constant support the load moment must always equal the spring moment. Therefore: (8) LW sin = KEYZsin maybe written as: (9) LW = KEYZ
he load L is suspended from the lever at point A and at any point T within the load travel range the moment of the load about the main lever-pivot P is equal to the load times its moment arm, thus: (4) Load moment = L (Wsin), where (Wsin) is the load moment arm he spring is attached at one of its ends to the xed pivot B. The T springs free end is attached by means of a rod to the lever-pivot D. This spring arrangement provides a spring moment about the main lever-pivot P which opposes the load moment and is equal to the spring force F times its moment arm; thus: (5) Spring Moment = F YZsin , where
he spring and the rod are so arranged that the spring deection E T always equals the distance between pivots B and D. Therefore, equation (9) may be written as: (10) LW = KYZ or, (11) L = (KYZ)/W ince equation (11) holds true for all positions of the load within its S travel range and K, Y, Z, and W remain constant it is therefore true that perfect constant support is obtained.
182 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Pipe Supports Index Technical Data Master Format 3 Part Specs. Application Examples Special Design Products Snubbers Sway Strut Assembly Vibration Control & Sway Brace Constant Spring Supports Hangers Sway Brace Seismic Pipe Guides & Slides Pipe Roll Pipe Shields & Saddles Trapeze
Model R Fig. 80-V, C-80-V Vertical Constant Support Model R Fig. 81-H, C-81-H Horizontal
Model R Fig. 81-H, Horizontal Size Range: Anvil Model R constant support hangers are made in two basic designs, 80- V (vertical design) and 81-H (horizontal design). Combined, the 80-V and 81-H constant supports are made in nine different frame sizes and 110 spring sizes to accommodate travels from 1 12" to 20" and loads from 27 lbs to 87,500 lbs. Single rod suspension: Available in Types A, B and C, Fig. 80-V (see page 190 through 192) and Fig. 81-H (see page 198 through 200). How to select hanger sizes: Determine the total load to be supported by the hanger as well as the actual travel that is, the actual vertical movement of the pipe at the point of hanger location. Refer to the Load-Travel table for constant support hangers (see page 186 through 189) and select a size hanger which will accommodate the known load and actual travel. It must be noted that the travel shown in the table is a total travel that is, the maximum vertical movement which the hanger will accommodate. The total travel of the hanger should always be greater than the calculated travel of pipe line to allow for some discrepancy between calculated travel and actual travel. It is suggested that the total travel for constant supports should be equal to actual travel plus 1" or 20% whichever is greater. How to determine type: After the size of the constant support is determined, consideration of available room for suspending the pipe and hanger will indicate whether a vertical (80-V series, page 190 - 197) or horizontal (81-H series, page 198 - 204) hanger is desirable. How to determine design: After the hanger size and design are determined, the type of constant support to be used depends upon the physical installation required by the suspension problem, i.e., whether the hanger is to be installed above, between or below steel members (see line cuts referring to Types A, B, C, etc.). It will be noted that the Type F is made in horizontal design only and the type G is made in the vertical design only. Special constant support hangers can be fabricated for unusual conditions. J-rod and K-hole diameter: Tapping or drilling for standard rod size will be furnished as shown in the J-rod and K-hole selection charts unless otherwise specied. Upper attachments, turnbuckles and clamps should be tapped to agree with the rod as shown in the selection chart. Standard rod diameters are based on the load to be carried by the upper rod which includes the weight of the hanger assembly as well as the pipe line. Tapped connections for hanger rod sizes 3" and smaller are UNC-Thread Series, Class 2 t. 3 14" and large rod tappings are 8UN Series Threads.
Model R Fig. 80-V, Vertical Finish: Standard nish; painted with semi gloss primer. Corrosion resistant; galvanized with coated coil or painted with CZ11 and coated coil. Recommended Service: When piping stress is critical and pipe is subject to vertical movement in excess of 12" due to thermal expansion, and also at locations where it is necessary to avoid any transfer of stress from support or onto critical terminals or connecting equipment. Approvals: WW-H-171E (Types 52, 58 and 59), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Types 54, 55 and 56). Features: Because of exclusive geometric design, mathematically perfect constancy of support is maintained throughout the full range of load adjustment. Compactness design provides smaller and more versatile units. Increased load and travel capacity. Each hanger is individually calibrated before shipment to support the exact load specied. All model R constant supports have a wide range of load adjustability. No less than 10% of this adjustability is provided either side of the calibrated load. White button marked C denotes cold setting of hanger; red button marked H denotes hot or operating setting. Field load adjustment is made by turning the single load adjustment bolt. Covered spring provides protection and good appearance. J-rod swings at least 4 from vertical. Non-resonant to all vertical vibrations.
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
183
Straps
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Model R
Ordering: Specify: (1) Hanger size number (2) Figure number (3) Type (4) Name of hanger (5) Loads to be supported (pounds) (6) Total travel (inches) (7) Actual travel (inches) (8) Direction of movement cold to hot (9) Customers hanger mark. (10) When ordering Type G, specify C-C rod dimension as well as load per spring and total load. (11) For Types A, B, C, Fig. 81-H when required specify for single rod suspension. (12) Constant Support Hangers are also available corrosion-resistant as gures C-80-V and C-81-H. Installation: (1) Securely attach the hanger to the building structure at a point where the load coupling is directly over the desired point of attachment to the pipe in the operating position. (2) Make certain that the moving parts of the hanger will be unobstructed. (3) Attach the lower J-rod between the pipe attachment and the load coupling. Make certain that the lower J-rod has enough thread engagement before taking up the load. A sight hole is provided for this. (4) Turn the load coupling, as you would a turnbuckle, until the travel indicator rotates to the desired cold setting (white button) marked C indicated on the position scale. If the constant support incorporates a travel stop see below. (5) After the line is in operation, check hanger for indicated hot setting. If necessary, make adjustment by turning the load coupling to bring the indicator to the hot position (red button) marked H. No other adjustment is normally required since the load as calibrated at the factory is equal to the load specied to be supported. Adjustment: When the hanger is installed, its supporting force should be in balance with the portion of the piping weight assigned to it. Each hanger is individually calibrated before shipment to support the exact load specied. All model R Constant Supports have a wide range of load adjustability. Special instructions for eld recalibration of individual hangers may be obtained from Anvil representatives. No less than 10% adjustability is provided either side of the calibrated load for plus or minus eld load adjustment. The percentage increase or decrease from the factory calibrated load should be carefully calculated. The calibrated load setting of each hanger is indicated by a die-stamp on the load adjustment scale. Load adjustments should be made from this reference point, with each division on the patented scale equal to 2% except sizes 84-110 where each division is valued at 1%. The load adjustment is made by turning the single load adjustment bolt. For example, a calibrated load of 3,000 pounds revised to 2,760 pounds is a decrease of 240 pounds. 240/3,000 = 8%. By turning the load adjusting bolt the arrow moves in the Decrease direction four divisions. Note: Field Recalibration of load does not decrease total travel.
(Continued)
Load adjustment scale shown applies to size 1 through 83 only. The load adjustment scale for sizes 84 through 110 1 division equals 1%.
Travel stop: The functional design of the Constant Support Hanger permits the incorporation of a travel stop that will lock the hanger against upward or downward movement for temporary conditions of underload or overload, such as may exist during erection, hydrostatic test or chemical clean-out. Anvil Constant Supports are designed for hydrostatic test load of at least 2 times the normal operating load for the Constant Support. The travel stop for sizes 19 - 110 consists of two plates, with matched serrations, attached to the hanger frame with two or more cap screws and with a socketed piece which engages the position indicator. It is installed at the factory to hold the hanger in the cold position. A series of serrations can be engaged to lock the hanger at any position along the total travel range. The travel stop, which is furnished only when specied, is painted red. The stop must be removed before the piping system is put into operation, but not before the hanger is installed and fully loaded. The travel stop is released by removing the cap screws. A tag marked Caution and containing instructions for removal of the travel stop is attached to the hanger. Note: See installation procedures PE-217-80 for a travel stop description on sizes 1-18.
184 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Pipe Supports
3" Lugs to be attached to each side of frame and will need stabilizing rigging when being lifted
sizes 64 thru 83
Type A
Type A
Type D
Type E
Type F
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
185
Index
Type D
Type E
Type G
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
Hole
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Model R lifting lugs: To help alleviate the problem of lifting large size Constant Supports into position for installation, this product is available with lifting lugs (if requested) on sizes ten and larger.
Straps
Model R
(Continued)
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Hanger Size No.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 B (avg. in.)
2
108 130 153 175 210 245 280 338 395 450 545 638 733 883 1,030 1,180 1,420 1,663 1,905 2,025 2,145 2,335 2,525 2,710 2,910 3,110 3,310 3,630 3,950 4,270 4,535 4,795 5,060 5,295 5,525
212
86 104 122 140 168 196 224 270 316 360 436 510 586 706 824 944 1,136 1,330 1,524 1,620 1,716 1,868 2,020 2,168 2,328 2,488 2,648 2,904 3,160 3,416 3,628 3,836 4,048 4,236 4,420 4,696 4,968 5,240 5,616 5,988 6,360 6,976 7,588 8,200 8,724 9,284 9,760 10,376 10,988 11,600
3
72 87 102 117 140 163 187 225 263 300 363 425 489 589 687 787 947 1,109 1,270 1,350 1,430 1,557 1,683 1,807 1,940 2,073 2,207 2,420 2,633 2,847 3,023 3,197 3,373 3,530 3,683 3,913 4,140 4,367 4,680 4,990 5,300 5,813 6,323 6,833 7,270 7,737 8,133 8,647 9,157 9,667 10,367 11,067 11,847 12,623 13,400 14,713 16,023 17,333 18,423 19,510 20,600 21,890 23,176 24,463
312
62 74 87 100 120 140 160 193 226 257 311 365 419 505 589 674 811 950 1,089 1,157 1,226 1,334 1,443 1,549 1,663 1,777 1,891 2,074 2,257 2,440 2,591 2,740 2,891 3,026 3,157 3,354 3,549 3,743 4,011 4,277 4,543 4,983 5,420 5,857 6,231 6,631 6,971 7,411 7,848 8,286 8,886 9,486 10,154 10,820 11,486 12,611 13,734 14,857 15,791 16,723 17,657 18,763 19,665 20,968
4
54 65 77 88 105 123 140 169 198 225 273 319 367 442 515 590 710 832 953 1,013 1,073 1,168 1,263 1,355 1,455 1,555 1,655 1,815 1,975 2,135 2,268 2,398 2,530 2,648 2,763 2,935 3,105 3,275 3,510 3,743 3,975 4,360 4,743 5,125 5,453 5,803 6,100 6,485 6,868 7,250 7,775 8,300 8,885 9,468 10,050 11,035 12,018 13,000 13,818 14,633 15,450 16,418 17,383 18,348
412
48 58 68 78 93 109 124 150 176 200 242 284 326 392 458 524 631 739 847 900 953 1,038 1,122 1,204 1,293 1,382 1,471 1,613 1,756 1,898 2,016 2,131 2,249 2,353 2,456 2,609 2,760 2,911 3,120 3,327 3,533 3,876 4,216 4,556 4,847 5,158 5,422 5,764 6,104 6,444 6,911 7,378 7,898 8,415 8,933 9,809 10,682 11,555 12,282 13,007 13,733 14,593 15,451 16,309
5
43 52 61 70 84 98 112 135 158 180 218 255 293 353 412 472 568 665 762 810 858 934 1,010 1,080 1,164 1,244 1,324 1,452 1,580 1,708 1,814 1,918 2,024 2,118 2,210 2,348 2,484 2,620 2,808 2,994 3,180 3,488 3,794 4,100 4,362 4,642 4,880 5,188 5,494 5,800 6,220 6,640 7,108 7,574 8,040 8,828 9,614 10,400 11,054 11,706 12,360 13,134 13,906 14,678
512
39 47 56 64 76 89 102 123 144 164 198 232 267 321 375 429 516 605 693 736 780 849 918 985 1,058 1,131 1,204 1,320 1,436 1,553 1,649 1,744 1,840 1,925 2,009 2,135 2,258 2,382 2,553 2,722 2,891 3,171 3,449 3,727 3,965 4,220 4,436 4,716 4,995 5,273 5,655 6,036 6,462 6,886 7,309 8,026 8,740 9,455 10,049 10,642 11,236 11,940 12,642 13,344
6
36 43 51 58 70 82 93 113 132 150 182 213 244 294 343 393 473 554 635 675 715 778 842 903 970 1,037 1,103 1,210 1,317 1,423 1,512 1,598 1,687 1,765 1,842 1,957 2,070 2,183 2,340 2,495 2,650 2,907 3,162 3,417 3,635 3,868 4,067 4,323 4,578 4,833 5,183 5,533 5,923 6,311 6,700 7,356 8,011 8,666 9,211 9,755 10,300 10,945 11,588 12,231
612
33 40 47 54 65 75 86 104 122 138 168 196 226 272 317 363 437 512 586 623 660 718 777 834 895 957 1,018 1,117 1,215 1,314 1,395 1,475 1,557 1,629 1,700 1,806 1,911 2,015 2,160 2,303 2,446 2,683 2,919 3,154 3,355 3,571 3,754 3,991 4,226 4,462 4,785 5,108 5,468 5,826 6,185 6,791 7,396 8,000 8,503 9,005 9,508 10,103 10,697 11,291
7
31 37 44 50 60 70 80 97 113 129 156 182 209 252 294 337 406 475 544 579 613 667 721 775 831 889 946 1,037 1,129 1,220 1,296 1,370 1,446 1,513 1,579 1,677 1,774 1,871 2,006 2,139 2,271 2,491 2,710 2,929 3,116 3,316 3,486 3,706 3,924 4,143 4,443 4,743 5,077 5,410 5,743 6,306 6,867 7,429 7,896 8,362 8,829 9,382 9,933 10,484
712
29 35 41 47 56 65 75 90 105 120 145 170 195 235 275 315 379 443 508 540 572 623 673 723 776 829 883 968 1,053 1,139 1,209 1,279 1,349 1,412 1,473 1,565 1,656 1,747 1,872 1,996 2,120 2,325 2,529 2,733 2,908 3,095 3,253 3,459 3,663 3,867 4,147 4,427 4,739 5,049 5,360 5,885 6,409 6,933 7,369 7,804 8,240 8,756 9,270 9,785
8
27 33 38 44 53 61 70 85 99 113 136 160 183 221 258 295 355 416 476 506 536 584 631 678 728 778 828 908 988 1,068 1,134 1,199 1,265 1,324 1,381 1,468 1,553 1,638 1,755 1,871 1,988 2,180 2,371 2,563 2,726 2,901 3,050 3,243 3,434 3,625 3,888 4,150 4,443 4,734 5,025 5,518 6,009 6,500 6,809 7,316 7,725 8,209 8,691 9,174
812
448 476 505 549 594 638 685 732 779 854 929 1,005 1,067 1,128 1,191 1,246 1,300 1,381 1,461 1,541 1,652 1,761 1,871 2,052 2,232 2,412 2,566 2,731 2,871 3,052 3,232 3,412 3,659 3,906 4,181 4,455 4,730 5,193 5,655 6,118 6,503 6,886 7,271 7,726 8,180 8,634
138
178
214
234
314
358
418
458
518
512
612
678
738
778
186 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Hanger Size No.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 B (avg. in.) 423 450 477 519 561 602 647 691 736 807 878 949 1,008 1,066 1,124 1,177 1,228 1,304 1,380 1,456 1,560 1,663 1,767 1,938 2,108 2,278 2,423 2,579 2,711 2,882 3,052 3,222 3,456 3,689 3,949 4,208 4,467 4,904 5,341 5,778 6,141 6,503 6,867 7,297 7,725 8,154 401 426 452 492 532 571 613 655 697 764 832 899 955 1,009 1,065 1,115 1,163 1,236 1,307 1,379 1,478 1,576 1,674 1,836 1,997 2,158 2,296 2,443 2,568 2,730 2,891 3,053 3,274 3,495 3,741 3,986 4,231 4,646 5,060 5,474 5,818 6,161 6,505 6,912 7,319 7,725 381 405 429 467 505 542 582 622 662 726 790 854 907 959 1,012 1,059 1,105 1,174 1,242 1,310 1,404 1,497 1,590 1,744 1,897 2,050 2,181 2,321 2,440 2,594 2,747 2,900 3,110 3,320 3,554 3,787 4,020 4,414 4,807 5,200 5,527 5,853 6,180 6,567 6,953 7,339 1,053 1,118 1,183 1,248 1,337 1,426 1,514 1,661 1,807 1,952 2,077 2,210 2,324 2,470 2,616 2,762 2,962 3,162 3,384 3,606 3,828 4,203 4,518 4,952 5,263 5,574 5,885 6,254 6,621 6,989 1,005 1,067 1,129 1,191 1,276 1,361 1,445 1,585 1,724 1,863 1,983 2,110 2,218 2,358 2,497 2,636 2,827 3,018 3,231 3,442 3,654 4,012 4,370 4,727 5,024 5,320 5,618 5,969 6,320 6,671 962 1,021 1,080 1,139 1,221 1,302 1,383 1,516 1,649 1,782 1,896 2,018 2,122 2,255 2,389 2,522 2,704 2,887 3,090 3,293 3,495 3,838 4,180 4,521 4,806 5,089 5,374 5,710 6,046 6,381 922 978 1,035 1,092 1,170 1,247 1,325 1,453 1,581 1,708 1,817 1,934 2,033 2,162 2,289 2,417 2,592 2,767 2,962 3,156 3,350 3,678 4,006 4,333 4,606 4,877 5,150 5,472 5,794 6,116 885 939 994 1,048 1,123 1,198 1,272 1,395 1,518 1,640 1,745 1,857 1,952 2,075 2,198 2,320 2,488 2,656 2,843 3,030 3,216 3,531 3,846 4,160 4,422 4,682 4,944 5,254 5,562 5,871 851 903 955 1,008 1,080 1,151 1,223 1,341 1,459 1,577 1,678 1,785 1,877 1,995 2,113 2,231 2,392 2,554 2,734 2,913 3,092 3,395 3,698 4,000 4,251 4,502 4,754 5,051 5,348 5,645 819 870 920 970 1,040 1,109 1,178 1,292 1,405 1,518 1,615 1,719 1,807 1,921 2,035 2,148 2,304 2,459 2,632 2,805 2,978 3,269 3,561 3,852 4,094 4,335 4,578 4,864 5,150 5,436 790 838 887 936 1,003 1,069 1,136 1,246 1,355 1,464 1,558 1,658 1,743 1,853 1,962 2,071 2,221 2,371 2,538 2,705 2,871 3,152 3,433 3,714 3,947 4,180 4,414 4,690 4,965 5,242 2,001 2,145 2,289 2,451 2,612 2,772 3,044 3,315 3,586 3,811 4,036 4,262 4,529 4,795 5,061 1,934 2,073 2,213 2,369 2,524 2,680 2,942 3,204 3,466 3,684 3,902 4,120 4,378 4,635 4,892 1,871 2,006 2,142 2,293 2,443 2,593 2,847 3,101 3,355 3,565 3,776 3,987 4,236 4,485 4,734 1,813 1,944 2,075 2,221 2,367 2,513 2,759 3,004 3,250 3,454 3,658 3,863 4,104 4,346 4,587 Pipe Supports
912
10
1012
11
1112
12
1212
13
1312
14
1412
15
1512
16
814
834
914
958
1018
1058
11
1112
12
1238
1278
1338
1378
1414
1434
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
187
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Straps
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Hanger Size No.
64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 B dim Sizes 64 to 83 B dim Sizes 84 to 110
412
17,089 17,866 19,615 21,362 23,111 24,564 26,015 27,466 29,186 30,904 32,622 34,489 36,355 38,222 40,297 42,371 44,444 46,666 48,888 51,111
5
15,380 16,080 17,654 19,226 20,800 22,108 23,414 24,720 26,268 27,814 29,360 31,040 32,720 34,400 36,268 38,134 40,000 42,000 44,000 46,000 49,200 52,400 55,400 58,400 61,400 66,000
512
13,982 14,618 16,049 17,478 18,909 20,098 21,286 22,473 23,880 25,286 26,691 28,218 29,746 31,273 32,971 34,668 36,364 38,182 40,000 41,819 44,728 47,637 50,364 53,091 55,819 60,000
6
12,816 13,400 14,711 16,021 17,333 18,423 19,511 20,599 21,889 23,177 24,466 25,866 27,266 28,666 30,222 31,779 33,332 35,000 36,665 38,332 40,998 43,665 46,165 48,665 51,165 54,998 61,331 67,164 73,500 80,830 87,500
612
11,831 12,370 13,580 14,790 16,000 17,007 18,011 19,016 20,207 21,396 22,585 23,878 25,170 26,462 27,899 29,335 30,770 32,309 33,847 35,386 37,847 40,309 42,616 44,924 47,232 50,771 56,617 62,002 67,848 74,617 81,540
7
10,986 11,486 12,610 13,733 14,857 15,792 16,725 17,657 18,763 19,868 20,972 22,172 23,372 24,572 25,906 27,239 28,572 30,000 31,429 32,858 35,144 37,429 39,572 41,715 43,858 47,144 52,572 57,573 63,001 69,287 75,716 78,930 82,145 85,360 87,500
712
10,253 10,720 11,769 12,817 13,866 14,738 15,609 16,480 17,512 18,542 19,573 20,693 21,813 22,933 24,178 25,422 26,666 27,999 29,333 30,666 32,799 34,932 36,932 38,932 40,932 43,999 49,065 53,732 58,799 64,665 70,665 73,665 76,665 79,665 82,665 85,998 87,500
8
9,613 10,050 11,034 12,016 13,000 13,818 14,632 15,450 16,418 17,384 18,350 19,400 20,450 21,500 22,668 23,834 25,000 26,250 27,500 28,750 30,750 32,750 34,625 36,500 38,375 41,250 46,000 50,375 55,125 60,625 66,250 69,063 71,875 74,688 77,500 80,625 83,750 86,875 87,500
812
9,047 9,459 10,385 11,310 12,236 13,005 13,773 14,542 15,452 16,362 17,271 18,259 19,248 20,236 21,335 22,432 23,530 24,707 25,883 27,060 28,942 30,824 32,589 34,354 36,119 38,825 43,295 47,413 51,884 57,060 62,355 65,002 67,649 70,296 72,943 75,884 78,826 81,767 84,708 87,500
9
8,544 8,933 9,808 10,681 11,555 12,282 13,008 13,733 14,593 15,452 16,311 17,244 18,178 19,111 20,149 21,185 22,222 23,333 24,444 25,555 27,333 29,111 30,777 32,444 34,111 36,666 40,888 44,777 49,000 53,888 58,888 61,388 63,888 66,388 68,888 71,666 74,444 77,221 80,000 83,610 87,221 87,500
912
8,094 8,463 9,291 10,119 10,947 11,635 12,323 13,010 13,825 14,639 15,452 16,336 17,221 18,105 19,088 20,070 21,052 22,105 23,157 24,210 25,894 27,578 29,157 30,736 32,315 34,736 38,736 42,420 46,420 51,051 55,788 58,156 60,525 62,893 65,261 67,893 70,524 73,156 75,787 79,210 82,629 86,050 87,500
10
7,690 8,040 8,827 9,613 10,400 11,054 11,707 12,360 13,134 13,907 14,680 15,520 16,360 17,200 18,134 19,067 20,000 21,000 22,000 23,000 24,600 26,200 27,700 29,200 30,700 33,000 36,800 40,300 44,100 48,500 53,000 55,250 57,500 59,750 62,000 64,500 67,000 69,500 72,000 75,250 78,500 81,750 85,000 87,500
1012
7,323 7,657 8,406 9,154 9,904 10,527 11,149 11,770 12,508 13,244 13,980 14,780 15,580 16,380 17,269 18,158 19,046 19,998 20,951 21,903 23,427 24,950 26,379 27,807 29,236 31,426 35,045 38,378 41,996 46,187 50,472 52,615 54,757 56,900 59,043 61,423 63,804 66,185 68,566 71,661 74,756 77,851 80,946 84,469 87,500
11
6,990 7,308 8,024 8,738 9,454 10,048 10,642 11,235 11,939 12,641 13,344 14,108 14,871 15,635 16,484 17,332 18,180 19,089 20,000 20,907 22,361 23,816 25,179 26,543 27,906 29,997 33,451 36,633 40,087 44,087 48,177 50,222 52,268 54,313 56,358 58,631 60,903 63,176 65,448 68,402 71,357 74,311 77,265 80,628 83,992 87,446 87,500
1112
6,686 6,991 7,675 8,359 9,043 9,611 10,179 10,747 11,420 12,092 12,764 13,495 14,225 14,955 15,768 16,579 17,390 18,260 19,129 20,000 21,390 22,781 24,085 25,389 26,694 28,694 31,998 35,041 38,345 42,171 46,084 48,040 50,000 51,953 53,909 56,083 58,257 60,430 62,604 65,430 68,256 71,082 73,908 77,125 80,342 83,646 86,950
12
6,408 6,700 7,356 8,011 8,666 9,211 9,755 10,300 10,945 11,589 12,233 12,933 13,633 14,333 15,111 15,889 16,666 17,500 18,333 19,166 20,500 21,832 23,082 24,332 25,582 27,500 30,665 33,582 36,749 40,415 44,165 46,040 47,915 49,790 51,665 53,748 55,831 57,914 60,000 62,706 65,414 68,122 70,831 73,914 77,000 80,163 83,330
358
418
458 4316
518 4916
512 5
6 538
612 51316
678 614
738 658
778 7116
814 712
834 778
914 8516
958 834
1018 918
1058 9916
11 10
188 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Pipe Supports
13
5,915 6,184 6,790 7,394 8,000 8,503 9,005 9,507 10,103 10,697 11,292 11,938 12,584 13,230 13,949 14,666 15,384 16,153 16,922 17,692 18,922 20,153 21,307 22,461 23,614 25,384 28,307 31,000 33,922 37,306 40,768 42,498 44,230 45,960 47,690 49,613 51,536 53,459 56,382 57,882 60,382 62,882 65,382 68,228 71,074 74,000 76,920
1312
5,696 5,955 6,538 7,120 7,703 8,188 8,671 9,155 9,728 10,301 10,873 11,496 12,118 12,740 13,432 14,123 14,814 15,555 16,295 17,036 18,221 19,406 20,517 21,628 22,739 24,443 27,258 29,850 32,665 35,924 39,257 40,924 42,590 44,257 45,923 47,775 49,627 51,479 53,330 55,738 58,145 60,552 62,960 65,700 68,441 71,255 74,070
14
5,492 5,742 6,304 6,966 7,428 7,895 8,361 8,828 9,380 9,932 10,484 11,084 11,684 12,284 12,951 13,618 14,284 14,998 15,712 16,427 17,569 18,712 19,783 20,855 21,926 23,569 26,283 28,782 31,496 34,639 37,583 39,460 41,067 42,673 44,280 46,066 47,851 49,637 51,422 53,744 56,065 58,386 60,707 63,350 65,992 68,706 71,420
1412
5,303 5,544 6,087 6,629 7,172 7,623 8,073 8,523 9,057 9,590 10,123 10,703 11,282 11,861 12,505 13,149 13,792 14,482 15,171 15,861 16,964 18,068 19,102 20,136 21,171 22,757 25,377 27,791 30,411 33,446 36,549 38,100 39,652 41,204 42,755 44,479 46,203 47,927 49,651 51,892 54,134 56,375 58,616 61,168 63,719 66,340 68,960
15
5,126 5,359 5,884 6,408 6,933 7,369 7,804 8,239 8,755 9,270 9,786 10,346 10,906 11,466 12,088 12,710 13,332 14,000 14,665 15,332 16,398 17,465 18,465 19,465 20,465 21,998 24,531 26,864 29,397 32,330 35,330 36,830 38,330 39,829 41,329 42,996 44,662 46,329 47,995 50,162 52,328 54,495 56,661 59,127 61,594 64,127 66,660
1512
4,961 5,187 5,694 6,201 6,709 7,131 7,552 7,973 8,473 8,971 9,470 10,012 10,554 11,096 11,698 12,300 12,902 13,547 14,192 14,837 15,869 16,902 17,869 18,837 19,805 21,288 23,740 25,998 28,449 31,287 34,190 35,642 37,093 39,545 40,000 41,609 43,221 44,834 46,447 48,544 50,640 52,737 54,834 57,220 59,607 62,059 64,510
16
4,806 5,025 5,517 6,008 6,500 6,909 7,317 7,725 8,209 8,692 9,175 9,700 10,225 10,750 11,334 11,917 12,500 13,125 13,750 14,375 15,375 16,375 17,313 18,250 19,188 20,626 23,000 25,188 27,563 30,313 33,125 34,531 35,938 37,344 38,750 40,313 41,875 43,438 45,000 47,031 49,063 51,094 53,125 55,438 57,750 60,125 62,500
1612
17
1712
18
1812
19
1912
20
1038
101316 11316
1158
12116
1212
1278
13516 131116
1418
14916 141516
1538
1534
16316
1658
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
189
Index
Technical Data
Shading in gray indicates this item is available upon request. (1) * Note: Total travel equals actual travel plus 1" or 20% (whichever is greater), rounded up to nearest 12" as applicable. (2) Constant supports are readily available for travel and load not listed in this table. Dimensions and lug locations may vary from those shown on the following pages. (3) For Type F Upthrust see page 203 for standard travel and sizes. (4) Fig. 80-V are not available for sizes 1 thru 9.
Application Examples
1112
12
1238
1278
1338
1378
1414
1434
32,119 33,482 34,845 36,209 37,572 39,087 40,602 42,117 43,632 45,602 47,571 49,541 51,510 53,752 55,994 58,297 60,600
31,175 32,498 33,822 35,145 36,468 37,939 39,409 40,880 42,350 44,262 46,174 48,085 50,000 52,173 54,350 56,585 58,820
30,285 31,570 32,856 34,141 35,427 36,855 38,284 39,712 41,141 42,998 44,855 46,712 48,569 50,683 52,797 54,969 57,140
29,442 30,691 31,941 33,191 34,441 35,830 37,219 38,607 39,996 41,801 43,607 45,412 47,218 49,273 51,328 53,439 55,550
28,647 29,863 31,080 32,295 33,511 34,862 36,214 37,565 38,916 40,673 42,429 44,186 45,943 47,942 49,942 52,000 54,050
27,894 29,078 30,262 31,446 32,631 33,946 35,262 36,578 37,894 39,604 41,315 43,025 44,736 46,683 48,630 50,630 52,630
27,179 28,332 29,486 30,640 31,794 33,076 34,358 35,640 36,922 38,588 40,255 41,921 43,588 45,485 47,383 49,331 51,280
26,500 27,625 28,750 29,875 31,000 32,250 33,500 34,750 36,000 37,625 39,250 40,875 42,500 44,350 46,200 48,100 50,000
Snubbers
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Straps
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Model R
F D F L L Position
L
M Position H Position
Sizes 10 - 63
J B Q N
Sizes 64 - 83
Type A of the gure 80-V vertical design model R Constant Support Hanger is designed for attachment to its supporting member by screwing a rod into a tapped hole in the top cap of hanger a distance equal to the P dimension plus 38". Sight holes are provided near the top of the casing to allow visible inspection for correct thread engagement of upper hanger rod.
Notes: See load travel tables, page 186 through 189 for B dimension. For weights see page 205. Location of travel indicator and contour of side plate may vary from that shown.
Dia. M
Total Travel TT
5 or less 512 or more 5 or less 512 or more 6 or less 612 or more 11 or less 1112 or more 1012 or less 11 or more 1012 or less 11 or more
Available in Fig. 81-H only 1878 2812 3234 4678 6712 6912 878 16 1814 2818 4414 4614 2 218 434 8516 1316 112 112 258 334 578 712 712 2538 2538 858 1234 14 18 22316 27316 6716 8916 91316 1114 11 11
7
Rod take-out = (factor) - (TT / 2), for lever in high position. I dimension for sizes 10 through 63 equals B + Q Note: See the size selection chart (page 186 through 189) for the B dimension.
0 800
1
801 1,500
5
1,501 2,540
3
2,541 4,000 1
13,401 18,300 2
190 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
J N
Factors
J-rod
Min Thd Length Rod DIa. Min Max
161516 1914 271516 30116 3238 37 4612 5134 7758 7734 78316 78516
2 2 2 4
114 112
39,001 48,000 3
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Model R
HOLE SIZE K R H ROD TAKE - OUT
D F L G
L I G
L Position
L
H Position
Sizes 10 - 63
J B Q
Sizes 64 - 83
J N
Available in Fig. 81-H only 1878 2812 3234 4678 68 6912 878 16 1814 2818 3714 38 2 218 434 8516 1316 112 112 258 334 578 712 712 112 2 3 4 412 358 2538 2538 858 1234 14 18 22316 27316 6716 8916 91316 1114 11 314 11 See page 197 138 158 212 3 112 112 114 K-hole & smaller, 112 138 K-hole and larger, 2
15 16 K-hole, 112 118 thru 112 K-hole, 2 134 K-hole and larger, 3 112 K-hole, 2 134 K-hole and larger, 3 3
8 4
238 + TT 314 + TT
2 114 2 134
1 2 212
334
414 + TT 34 214 5734 7714 534 + TT 114 234 7738 771516 3 5 4 + TT 112 314 78116
5212
Rod take-out = (factor) - (TT / 2), for lever in high position. I dimension for sizes10 through 63 equals B + Q * For constant support sizes 50-63 and 64-74 where 114" rod is required, check the R dimensions versus the Fig. 66 welded beam attachment dimensions for compatibility. Note: See the size selection chart (page 186 through 189) for the B dimension. K hole center line location is determined by the formula of B - G = K Center Line.
0 800
1 11
801 1,500
5 13
1,501 2,540
3 15
2 16
8 16
4 16
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
191
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
134 + TT
Dia. M
J-rod
Min Thd Rod DIa. Length Min Max
Type B is furnished with a single lug for attachment to the building structure. The lug permits use of a gure 66* welded beam attachment, a gure 299 clevis or a pair of angles for attachment where headroom is limited.
Notes: See load travel tables, page 186 through 189 for B dimension. For weights see page 205. Location of travel indicator and contour of side plate may vary from that shown.
M Position
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Model R
HOLE SIZE K T T ROD TAKE - OUT S T R H T
D M I G
L Position
M
M Position H Position
Sizes 10 - 63
J Q N
Sizes 64 - 83
Type C is furnished with a pair of lugs for attachment to the building structure. These lugs permit the use of an eye rod or a single plate for attachment where headroom is limited.
Notes: See load travel tables, page 186 through 189 for B dimension. For weights see page 205. Location of travel indicator and contour of side plate may vary from that shown.
Dia. M
858 1234 14 18
Available in Fig. 81-H only 1878 2812 3234 4678 68 6912 878 16 1814 2818 3634 3714 2 218 434 8516 1316 112 112 258 334 578 712 712 112 2 3 4 5 614 6716 8916 91316 1114 11 11 138 158 212 3 314 314 112 112 114 K-hole & smaller, 112 138 K-hole and larger, 2
15 16 K-hole, 112 118 thru 138 K-hole, 2 112 K-hole and larger, 3 3
3 334
Rod take-out = (factor) - (TT / 2), for lever in high position. I dimension for sizes 10 through 63 equals B + Q Note: See the size selection chart (page 186 through 189) for the B dimension. K hole center line location is determined by the formula of B - G = K Center Line.
0 800
11
1,501 2,540
15
2 16 7 8
1
4 16 114
3
192 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
L
J N
J-rod
Min Thd Rod DIa. Length Min Max
8 8
19516 2158 31116 33316 3678 4112 5212 5734 7714 7738 771516 78116
2 2 2 4
1
1
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Model R
D F L G L Position
L
M Position H Position
J B Q
Type D rests on top of structural steel while most of the Constant Support itself hangs between or below the supporting beams. The depth of the beam is limited by the P dimension. Dimension P can be varied on special order, however, P dimension shown is maximum for the hanger.
Available in Fig. 81-H only 1878 2812 878 16 2 218 434 8516 112 258 334 578 858 1234 14 18 6716 8916 91316 1114 138 158 212 3 41516 1212 1314 2412 238 238 258 278 112 112 2 3 1034 1478 1634 21 3 3 4 6
3
2 2 4
4678 2818
138
*Rod take-out = (factor) - (TT / 2), for lever in high position. I dimension for sizes 10 through 63 equals B + Q Note: See the size selection chart (page 186 through 189) for the B dimension.
J Rod Size
114
112
134
214
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
193
Index
Load (lbs)
0 800
801 1,500
1,501 2,540
2,541 4,000
4,001 6,100
6,101 9,400
9,401 13,400
13,401 18,300
18,301 24,700
Technical Data
Application Examples
3234 1814
118
5 or less 5 2 or more 5 or less 512 or more 6 or less 612 or more 11 or less 1112 or more
134 + TT
Snubbers
Dia. M
Total Travel TT
Factors
J-Rod
Min Thd Length Min Dia. Max Dia.
Notes: See load travel tables, page 186 through 189 for B dimension. For weights see page 205. Location of travel indicator and contour of side plate may vary from that shown.
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Model R
D F L G
H
D I L F I G
C B K J C B K J
Sizes 1 - 63 Type E rests on top ange of structural steel and the constant support itself is entirely above the supporting beams. If the rod takeout does not exceed the depth of the supporting steel and the rod coupling must extend below the steel, specify the depth of the supporting steel. Increase the rod take-out by the depth of the steel.
Sizes 64 - 74
Sizes 75 - 83
Notes: See load travel tables, page 186 through 189 for B dimension. For weights see page 205. Location of travel indicator and contour of side plate may vary from that shown.
Dia. X M
Angle Size
Total Travel TT
5 or less 5 2 or more 5 or less 512 or more 6 or less 612 or more 11 or less 1112 or more 1012 or less 11 or more 1012 or less 11 or more
1
Factors
J-Rod
Rod Dia Min Thd Length Min Max
878 16
2 218
4516
858
8 8
138
112 x 2 x 14
4 4 8
16
13
121316 18
138 1 8
5
3534
712 2538 1534 22316 1916 141516 11 712 2538 2558 27316 134 1512 11
4 x 4 x 38
158
1716 334 21316 41516 212 718 158 7 918 914 834 878
0 800
1
801 1,500
5
1,501 2,540
3
2,541 4,000 1
13,401 18,300 2
39,001 48,000 3
194 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
L
1
2 2 2 4
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Model R
19-34 35-49
50-63
Type F is for support of piping or equipment from below. It has a base ange for fastening to the oor or to beams. The load arm is furnished with a removable load pin. The intermediate strut which runs from the load arm to the piping is not furnished and must be ordered separately, designed to the specic requirement. Note: See load travel table for B dimension.
Not Available 1658 2538 3258 4834 834 141116 1812 2858 112 258 31116 578 858 1234 14 18 614 838 91516 1114 1 1516 214 214 1 1 112 158 9 1314 1412 1812 10 15 17 21
7
16 8 8
4 8 8 4
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
195
Index
Technical Data
118
512 or less 6 or more 4 or less 412 or more 7 or less 712 or more 8 or less 812 or more
Application Examples
Bottom Flange Flange Flange Hole and Factor Bolt Thickness Slot Dia. Circle
Total Travel
J Dia.
Snubbers
Total Travel
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Model R
H Position
HH
M Position L Position
M M
L L
Note: For orientation of "N" Dimension, see Fig. 80-V Type D on page 171.
Type G is a complete trapeze assembly. The hanger consists of two vertical type Constant Support units plus a pair of channels, back-toback, welded at each end to the hanger casing. In sizing a Type G hanger, it must be remembered that each standard spring unit carries one-half of the total pipe load. Furthermore, the weights of the hanger itself must be considered as part of the overall load. Therefore, using one-half the total pipe load, select the required hanger size from the Load Travel Table and add one-half the weight of the size hanger selected to one-half the total pipe load. If the load now exceeds the maximum load at the required total travel for the hanger size selected, it is necessary to go to the next larger hanger. If the pipe line is designed so as not to be centered on the channel, one
spring of the trapeze will carry a heavier load than the other and care must be taken in sizing the individual hanger units. The center-tocenter rod dimension must be specied when ordering. The minimum C-C dimension can be determined as follows: B plus Q > Y: (O.D. of pipe covering) + 2Q. B plus Q < Y: (O.D. of pipe covering) + 2 (Y - B). Note: If U-bolt is used to fasten pipe to channels, C-C of U-bolt tangents plus one washer plate width cannot be greater than C-C of the hanger rods minus 2 (V minus B). See load travel tables, page 186 through 189 for B dimension. For weights see page 205. Location of travel indicator and contour of side plate may vary from that shown.
Dia M
Total Travel TT
5 or less 512 or more 5 or less 512 or more 6 or less 612 or more 11 or less 1112 or more
J-Rod Factors
Min Thread Length Min Rod. Dia. Max Rod Dia.
Not available 1878 2812 878 16 1 114 112 218 2 218 434 8516 112 258 334 578 858 1234 14 18 6716 8916 2916 3916 312 4 512 612 51316 31516 9 1034 618 8 111116 14 161316 1834 1914 2378 2458 30 134 + TT 238 + TT 314 + TT 414 + TT
1
2 2 2 4
Load (lbs)
J Rod Size
0 800
1
801 1,500
5
1,501 2,540
3
2,541 4,000
1
4,001 6,100
114
6,101 9,400
112
9,401 13,400
134
13,401 18,300
2
18,301 24,700
214
196 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
CONSTANT SUppORTS
K HOLE SIZE C C K E P N T H R ROD TAKE OUT ROD TAKE OUT W H R ROD TAKE OUT E C E
G X L B
TYPE B
K HOLE SIZE
TYPE C
D J
S T T
TYPE A
Min
Max
84-94
7834
16 24
15 23
4934 64
4 4
412 412
112 712
1 7
6 6
24 24
1012 1112
3 312
12 1312
9 2 or less
1
45 4
3
54 4
3
10 13 12 15
5512 5118 60 8
1
6412 6058 69 8
5
2 212
334 334
*Rod take-out = (factor) - (.75 x TT), for Lever in high position Note: See the size selection chart (page 186 through 189) for the B dimension.
Load (lbs)
J & K-Rods K-Hole R S T (Type B) T (Type C) W
14,376 18,300
2 238 3 278
3
18,301 24,700
214 258 3 318
3
24,701 31,000
212 278 4 338 1 8
31,001 39,000
234 318 4 358 1 8
39,001 48,000
3 338 4 378 1 8
48,001 58,000
314* 358 412 418 1 9
58,001 69,000
312* 378 412 438 112 114 9
69,001 87,500
334* 418 412 458 134 114 9
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
197
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
95-110 100
Hanger Sizes
C L
Type A&B Type C
E D
Type A&B Type C
G
Type A&B Type C
Total Travel TT
Factor
Type A Type B&C Min Thread Length
J - Rod
Rod Dia.
Snubbers
Note: B Dimensions is a function of total travel (G + B should not be assumed as equal to C Dimension) Types A, B, and C sizes 84 through 110, for large loads and long travels, provide for basically the same methods of upper attachment as sizes 10 to 83 shown Type A on page 190, Type B page 191 and Type C see page 192.
Notes: See load travel tables, page 186 through 189 for B dimension. For weights see page 205.
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Model R
Type A of the Figure 81- H Horizontal Design Model R Constant Support Hanger is designed for attaching to its supporting member by screwing two rods into tapped holes in the top of the hanger from a distance equal to the P dimension plus 38". Sizes 1 to 9 are furnished with swivel eye and turnbuckle instead of yoke and coupling.
N M J
Notes: Also available for single rod suspension as indicated above. When ordering specify for single rod suspension. See load travel tables, page 186 through 189 for B dimension. For weights see page 205. Location of travel indicator and contour of side plate may vary from that shown.
D
814 8716 14716 17716 26316 3534 3534
E
1 1 114 134 11116 3 314
F
7
G
2 2916 378 434 71116 514 5
M
618 8516 12716 1334 171116 22316 27316
N
418 6716 8916 91316 1114 11 11
P
13
Total Travel TT
4 or less 412 or more 5 or less 512 or more 5 or less 512 or more 6 or less 612 or more 8 or less 812 to 11 1112 or more 1012 or less 11 or more 1012 or less 11 or more
L
1614 2014 18716 21716 261516 31116 31916 39916 45916 53916 53916 5712 63 5712 63
C
6 10 8 11 10 1418 11 19 16 24 24 1534 2114 1514 2034
Factors
1234 15516 1078 1314 1634 1878 2118 2534 241516 241516 3014 34716 34916 3612 3658
J-Rod
Min Thread Length Rod Dia. Min
1
Max
1
8 2 8 16 16
16 16
2 2 2 2 4
2 4
11
11
15
314 358
114 112
0 800
1
801 1,500
5
1,501 2,540
3
2,541 4,000 1
13,401 18,300 2
39,001 48,000 3
198 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Model R
W2
F
H
M
N M
Type B is furnished with two lugs one at each end of the hanger frame. These lugs permit use of Fig. 66 welded beam attachments, clevises or angle clips for attachment where headroom is limited. Sizes 1 to 9 are furnished with swivel eye and turnbuckle instead of yoke and coupling.
Notes: Also available for single rod suspension as indicated above. When ordering specify for single rod suspension. See load travel tables, page 186 through 189 for B dimension. For weights see page 205. Location of travel indicator and contour of side plate may vary form that shown.
D
8 4
1
E
1 4
1
F
7
G
1 4
3
H
1 2
1
M
6 8
1
N
4 8
1
Total Travel TT
4 or less 412 or more 5 or less 512 or more 5 or less 512 or more 6 or less 612 or more 8 or less 812 to 11 1112 or more 1012 or less 11 or more 1012 or less 11 or more
L
1614 2014 18716 21716 261516 31116 31916 39916 45916 53916 53916 5712 63 5712 63
C
512 912 712 1012 934 1378 1012 1812 1338 2138 2138 1514 2034 1434 2014
Factors
1458 17316 13116 15716 1978 22 2558 3018 301116 301116 36 4238 4212 4534 4578
J-Rod
Min Thd Length Rod Dia. Min
1
Max
1
8 2 8 16 16
1 4 + TT
3
2 2 2 2 4
2 4
112 2 3 4 412 5
11
15
314 358
114
112 314**
801 1,500
13
1,501 2,540
15
2 16 114 1 4* 212
1
8 16 114 1 4* 212
5
4 16 114 3 8 212
3
* 38" for single rod suspension ** 314" is furnished with 4 UNC series thread.
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
199
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
2W W
Pipe Supports
L
Straps
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Model R
S T
F
H
M
Type C is furnished with two pair of lugs, one pair of lugs at each of the hanger frame. These lugs permit the use of two eye rods or two single plates for attachment where headroom is limited. Sizes 1 to 9 are furnished with swivel eye and turnbuckle instead of yoke and coupling.
Notes: Also available for single rod suspension as indicated above. When ordering specify for single rod suspension. See load travel tables, page 186 through 189 for B dimension. For weights see page 205. Location of travel indicator and contour of side plate may vary from that shown.
D
814 8716 14716 17116 26316 3534 3534
E
114 114 2 212 3 4 412
F
7
G
134 2516 318 4 638 414 334
H
112 112 2 3 4 412 5
M
618 8516 12716 1334 171116 22316 27316
N
418 6716 8916 91316 1114 11 11
Total Travel TT
4 or less 412 or more 5 or less 512 or more 5 or less 512 or more 6 or less 612 or more 8 or less 812 to 11 1112 or more 1012 or less 11 or more 1012 or less 11 or more
L
1614 2014 18716 21716 261516 31116 31916 39916 45916 53916 53916 5712 63 5712 63
C
512 912 712 1012 812 1258 912 1712 1338 2138 2138 1334 1914 1234 1814
Factors
1458 17316 13116 15716 1978 22 2558 3018 301116 301116 36 4238 4212 4534 4534
J-Rod
Min Thd Length Rod Dia. Min
1
Max
1
2 2 2 2 4
2 4
2 8 16 16
11
15
314 358
114 112
84 - 110 See page 204 * Rod take-out = (factor) - (TT / 2), for lever in high position.
1,501 2,540
15
2 16 114 7 8 1 4* 212
1
* 38" for single rod suspension ** 314" is furnished with 4 UNC series thread.
200 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Model R
E X
J N M
Type D may be bolted directly under steel. Sizes 1 to 9 are furnished with swivel eye and turnbuckle instead of yoke and coupling.
Notes: See load travel tables, page 186 through 189 for B dimension. For weights see page 205. Location of travel indicator and contour of side plate may vary from that shown.
Hanger Sizes
1-9 10 - 18 19 - 34 35 - 49 50 - 63 64 - 74 75 - 83 84 - 110
D
814 8716
E
1 314
F
7
G
2 2916 358
M
618 8516 12716 1334
N
418 6716 8916
X
3
Y
558
Angle Size
2 x 2 x 14
L
16 4 2014 18716 21716 261516 31116 31916 39916 45916 53916 53916 5712 63 5712 63
1
C
6 10 312 6 912 1358 1012 1812 1538 2338 2338 1534 2114 1534 2114
Factors 13 8 151516 111316 14316 1734 1978 201316 25716 27116 27116 3238 3838 3812 4114 4138
3
J-Rod
Min Thd Length Rod Dia. Min
1
Max
1
2 8
4 4 8
2 2 2 4
11
15
314 358
114 112
Not available
114
112
134
214
212
234
314*
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
201
Index
0 800
801 1,500
1,501 2,540
2,541 4,000
4,001 6,100
6,101 9,400
9,401 13,400
13,401 18,300
18,301 24,700
24,701 31,000
31,001 39,000
39,001 48,000
48,001 58,000
Technical Data
Application Examples
16 412
91316 138
Snubbers
16
4 or less 412 or more 5 or less 512 or more 5 or less 512 or more 6 or less 612 or more 8 or less 812 to 11 11 or more 1012 or less 11 or more 1012 or less 11 or more
134 + TT
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Model R
F
H
M
L
ROD TAKE - OUT K
J
X Y N X
Type E incorporates two brackets as part of its frame, permitting the bolting of the constant support to the top of structural steel. Sizes 1 to 9 are furnished with swivel eye and turnbuckle instead of yoke and coupling. If rod take-out does not exceed the depth of the supporting steel and rod coupling is required to extend below the steel,
specify the depth of the supporting steel. Increase rod take-out by the depth of the steel. Notes: See load travel tables, page 186 through 189 for B dimension. For weights see page 205. Location of travel indicator and contour of side plate may vary from that shown.
D
814 8716 14716 17116 26316
F
114 1
5
G
2
M
618
N
418
P
812
X
5
Y
51516 81516 11316
L
1614 2014 18716 21716 261516 31116 31916 39916 45916 53916 53916 5712 63 5712 63
K
6 10 712 712 10 10 1158 1158 1538 2338 2338 1712 23 1712 23
Factors 518 71116 134 4116 338 512 478 912 678 678 1214 1118 1114 9 918
J-Rod
Min Thd Length Rod Dia. Min
1
Max
1
8 8 8
16 4 4
2116 8516
11
13
16 13516
15
1516 141116
4 or less 412 or more 5 or less 512 or more 5 or less 1 5 2 or more 6 or less 612 or more 8 or less 812 to 11 1112 or more 1012 or less 11 or more 1012 or less 11 or more
2 2 2
2 4
2 4
114 112
0 800
1
801 1,500
5
1,501 2,540
3
2,541 4,000 1
13,401 18,300 2
39,001 48,000 3
202 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Model R
Take-Out FactOr* A
T.T.
2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 6.0 6.5 7.0 7.5 8.0 8.5 9.0 9.5 10.0
B N
Q C N
2812
M A* TAKE OUT
* For down travel: Take-Out = A + (1/2) Actual Travel For up travel: Take-Out = A - (1/2) Actual Travel
Total Travel TT
2-6 2-8 212 - 10 3 - 10
A
See Take Out
B
1078 13 4
3
C
1178 13 4
3
D
9 13 17 1612
E
212 2 8
1
F
3
H
8
J
12 14 17 19
K
14 17 4
1
L
22716 31 8
5
M
814 12 2
1
N
5 8 10
P
1 5
Q
1378 1638 1934 2314
4 8
2 358
10 13 1134
8 4
2158
1914
678
22716
52
1738
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
203
Index
1778
1614
21
3814
1358
Technical Data
Application Examples
2712
F DIA. 4 PLACES P D K H J
3158
34
Snubbers
Sizes 10 -18 19 - 34 35 - 49 50 - 63
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
CONSTANT SUppORTS
G D B J TYPE A
TYPE B
M N
TYPE C
Types A, B, and C sizes 84 to 110, for large loads and long travels, provide for basically the same methods of upper attachment as sizes 1 through 83 shown on page 198 through 200. Type E is designed for bolting to the top of structural steel, see page 202 for sizes 1 to 83. Notes: See load travel tables, page 186 through 189 for B dimension. For weights see page 205.
G K Z B 3"
TYPE E
Y Q
E D
Type Type A&B C
G F
Type Type A&B E &C
K M
Total Travel TT
912 or less 10 or more 14 or less 1412 or more
Factors
Type A Type B&C Type E
J-Rod
Min Rod Dia. Thd Lgth Min Max
84-94 7634 28
2712 4934
412 118
14
21 24 1012 3
16 34 13 27
334
5612
66
95-110 100
49
4812
64
Load (lbs)
J & K-Rods K-Hole R S T (Type B) T (Type C) W
14,376 18,300
2 238 3 278
3
18,301 24,700
214 258 3 318
3
24,701 31,000
212 278 4 338 1 8
31,001 39,000
234 318 4 358 1 8
39,001 48,000
3 338 4 378 1 8
48,001 58,000
314* 358 412 418 1 9
58,001 69,000
312* 378 412 438 112 114 9
69,001 87,500
334* 418 412 458 134 114 9
204 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Type G n Net
160 166 176 371 375 389 405 419 435 676 706 740 762 796 1,278 1,328 1,406 1,488 1,566
Type F Net
174 177 182 415 417 424 432 439 447 640 655 672 683 700 1,181 1,206 1,245 1,286 1,325
67 70 75 171 173 180 188 195 203 312 327 344 355 372 661 686 725 766 805 1,568 1,668 1,753 1,853 2,460 2,530 2,670 2,845 2,990 3,190 3,275 3,375 4,500 4,825 5,450 5,950
20 23 25 57 60 65 158 160 167 175 182 190 292 307 324 335 352 571 596 635 676 715 1,325 1,425 1,510 1,620 2,070 2,120 2,280 2,430 2,575 2,775 2,860 2,960 4,075 4,400 5,025 5,500
179 182 187 423 425 432 440 447 455 652 667 684 695 712 1,241 1,266 1,305 1,346 1,385
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
205
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
Pipe Roll
Shipping
Shipping
Shipping
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
CONSTANT SUppORTS
Constant Support Check List for Requesting a Quote or Ordering
Anvil International Precision Park 160 Frenchtown Rd. North Kingstown, RI 02852
For technical information regarding Constant Supports Call or Email: Phone Number: (401) 886-3020 Email: eps_contact@anvilintl.com
Finish: Standard Primer: __________ Galvanized: __________ Special Coating: _______________ Quantity: _______________ Figure No.: Options a re: 80-V, 81-H or: C-80-V, C-81-H Size: Options are: #1 through #110 (Size #1 through #9 available in 81-H only) ____________________ Type: Options are: A through G* (Type F Upthrust available in 81-H only, Type G available in 80-V only) __________ Actual Travel (AT): _______________ (inches) Total Travel (TT)**: _______________(inches) Direction of Travel: _______________ + (up) or (down) Load: _______________ (lbs) J Dimension (rod diameter): _______________ (inches) (Not required for Type F) Mark Number: _______________ (If required) Travel Stops: Are always Included Lifting Lugs: Yes: _________ No: __________ Available on sizes 10 and larger. Notes: * Type G Constants must also include the C-to-C dimension & the load per spring. ** Total Travel = Actual travel + 1 or 20% whichever is greater rounded up to the next one half inch increment.
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
206 PH-1.14
Fig. 170
Size Range: Available in four sizes to take loads to 20,700 (lbs). All sizes provide for 12" of horizontal travel. Approvals: Complies with ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 58). Features: Highly economical Minimum friction Virtually dust proof Compact designed for minimum head room Versatile Installation: Shipped ready for installation. Attach to the supporting steel by welding around the frame. Ordering: Specify size number, gure number, name and H dimension, if required. Horizontal travelers will be designed for special loads, travels or dual directional travel upon request.
Horizontal Traveler
he Anvil Fig. 170 horizontal traveler facilitates the supporting T of piping systems subject to linear horizontal movements where head room is limited. Designed for use with Anvil Variable Spring Hangers or Constant Supports it can also be used in conjunction with a rigid type hanger assembly. Refer to Fig. 71SD and 72SD for additional horizontal traveler designs.
L W
A C B
H D
15 37 69 102
212 312 5 6
212 312 5 6
1 112
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
207
Index
Technical Data
Maximum Load
Weight
H Max
Application Examples
Field Weld
Snubbers
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Fig. 296 Fig. 301: with Adjustable Preload Fig. C-296, Fig. C-301: Corrosion Resistant
Size Range: Preloads from 50 to 1,800 pounds and maximum forces from 200 to 7,200 pounds. Finish: Standard nish: painted with semi gloss primer. Corrosion resistant: galvanized with coated coil. Service: Recommended for controlling vibration; absorbing shock loading; guiding or restraining the movement of pipe resulting from thermal expansion; bracing a pipe line against sway. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 55) WW-H-171E (Type 55), ANSI/MSS SP-69 and MSS SP-58 (Type 50). Installation: Shipped ready for installation (see line cuts of Fig. 297, Fig. 298, Fig. 302 and Fig. 303 on page 211 for typical installed hanger assemblies). Adjustment: The sway brace should be in the neutral position when the system is hot and operating, at which time both spring plates should be in contact with the end plates. If they are not, the sway brace should be adjusted to the neutral position by use of the load coupling. Features: Vibration is dampened with an instantaneous opposing force bringing the pipe back to normal position. A single pre-loaded spring provides two way movement. One spring saves space and simplies design. Spring has 3-inch travel in either direction. Accurate neutral adjustment assured. A tight tting connection at rear bracket and clamp. Additional Features Fig. 301: The Fig. 301 sway brace is adjustable from the initial preload to the maximum capacity of the unit selected. It is equipped with a load-deection scale to facilitate preload adjustment. Preload adjustment reduces spring travel accordingly. Ordering: Specify gure, name and sway brace size. The Anvil Fig. 296 and Fig. 301 consist of the sway brace only. Available corrosion resistant as Fig. C-296 and Fig. C-301. Preload adjustment Fig. 301: Turn the preload adjustment nut until desired preload is indicated. Turn thrust nut until it is in contact with the spring plate. Lock in position. Indicated deection must be greater than thermal movement.
END PLATES SPRING PLATES ADJ. NUT COUPLING PRELOAD ADJ. SCALE LOCK NUT THRUST NUT
Sway Brace
208 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/sway-brace or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
Fig. 296, Fig. 301: with Adjustable Preload Fig. C-296, Fig. C-301: Corrosion Resistant
Size selection: The Anvil Vibration Control and Sway Brace gives full deection forces from 200 to 7,200 pounds and has initial precompressed spring forces from 50 to 1,800 pounds to control vibrations and pipe sway. The amount of force needed to control piping should be in proportion to the mass, amplitude of movement, and nature of disturbing forces acting on the pipe. When it is possible to calculate the exact restraining force required, the size of the Vibration Control and Sway Brace capable of providing this force should be selected. As a general reference, the following sizes have been historically used for the pipe sizes shown: #1 - 3 12" and smaller #2 - 4" to 8" #3 - 10" to 16" #4 - 18" to 24" #5 and #6 - above 24"
END PLATE EYE D 2" R K P F 2" M L N A
R K P F L
END PLATE
SPRING PLATE
ROD COUPLING
2" M
2"
4 1 112 1 112 4 2
1
112 to 24 6 to 30
1 114 112
1 8
5
6 8
1
1 112
114 11316
112 to 24 6 to 30
1 114 112
1 112
4 2
1
5 16
15
7 8
7
1 112
114 11316
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/sway-brace or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
209
Index
112
658
6916
914
Technical Data
Application Examples
658
214
634
Snubbers
Fig. 296
Fig. 301
Spring Hangers
Installation: 1) attach rear bracket to structure and pipe attachment to piping or equipment. 2) connect coupling to pipe attachment and turn coupling so that spring is compressed in direction opposite to and by approximate amount of piping thermal movement. Important: Final adjustment should be made with the pipe in its hot or operating position. Turn the coupling until both spring plates are in contact with the end plates of the Sway Brace. When correct tension adjustments are completed, the brace exerts no force on the pipe in its operating position. Under shutdown conditions, the brace allows the pipe to assume its cold position. It exerts a nominal cold strain force equal to the preload force plus the amount of travel from the hot to cold position, times the spring scale of the particular size of the Vibration Control and Sway Brace.
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
vIBRATION CONTROL & SwAy BRACE Fig. 297 and Fig. 298 Sway Brace Assembly Fig. 302 and Fig. 303: with Adjustable Preload Fig. C-297, Fig. C-298, Fig. C-302 and Fig. C-303: Corrosion Resistant
he Fig. 297 and Fig. 302 consist of a structural T attachment, two studs, the Sway Brace, extension piece up to 2' 0" in length as required, and a modied Fig. 295 pipe clamp. The Fig. 298 and Fig. 303 consist of a structural attachment, two studs, the Sway Brace, adjustable extension piece 2' 1" in length or over as required, an adapter and a toleranced pipe clamp. Note: In specifying Sway Brace assemblies where the W dimension exceeds 2' 0" in length, the Fig. 298 or Fig. 303 assembly is required. Verify that calculated W is within the min/max shown in table. Ordering assemblies: Specify gure number, name, Sway Brace size, pipe size, W dimension. Available corrosion resistant as Fig. C-297, C-298, C-302 and C-303.
3" OVERALL LENGTH PIN FIG. 296 Body EXTENSION PIECE W
C L W
C L STUD E
FIG. 297
FIELD WELD
FIG. 298
REAR BRACKET
ADAPTER
STUD E
FIG. 302
3"
REAR BRACKET
F Fig 301
PIN
Fig. 297, 298, 302, 303, C-297, C-298, C-302 and C-303: DimensiOns (in)
Pipe Size
112 2 212 3 312 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30
3"
E
Size 1 4 Carbon 418 518 538 51516 6316 612 7 8916 9916 1058 1158 121116 131116 141116 1578 1778 Size 5 & 6 Carbon 11716 12716 1312 1434 1538 1638 1738 19 2158 2518 Size 5 & 6 Alloy 12116 13116 1438 1538 16 17 18 1912 2218 2518
FIG. 303
REAR BRACKET
STUD E
Fig. 297, 298, 302, 303, C-297, C-298, C-302 and C-303: DimensiOns (in)
Sway Brace Size
1 2 3 4 5 6
210 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/sway-brace or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
Fig. 211, Fig. C-211 Sway Strut Assembly Fig. 640, Fig. C-640: Field Welded Strut
Finish: Painted (Fig. 211 & Fig. 640) or Galvanized (Fig. C-211 & C-640) Service: Used to restrain movement of piping while allowing for movement in the other two directions. Note: Second lock nut available by special request only. How to size: (1) Select size consistent with max. load to be restrained. (2) C to C is obtained by subtracting E and A from the distance from structural steel to center of pipe. Verify that the calculated C to C is within the min/max limits. (3) Determine W dimension by: W=(C to C)-2F. Installation: Shipped assembled. Securely fasten bracket to structure, make necessary adjustment in overall length, and fasten clamp to pipe. Features: Effective under either tensile or compressive force. Provides 3 12" (Fig. 211) or 2" (Fig. 640) of eld adjustment in either direction. Self-aligning bushings permits 5 misalignment or angular motion. Bushings are coated with a dry lubricant. Ordering: Specify gure number, assembly size, name, option number, normal pipe size or special O.D., and W dimension. Please specify temperature for pipe clamp. For restraint parallel to the pipe axis using two sway strut assemblies, a riser clamp is available. If a riser clamp is required, consult the nearest Anvil representative for information about this clamp. Note: The rear bracket assembly can be ordered separately.
E-Take Out
E-Take Out: Dimensions (in) at 650F OD**
4 1 114 112 2 212 3 312 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30 36
3
A
2716 2916 21116 418 518 538 51516 6316 612 734 838 938 1012
B&C 1&2
638 7 7 4 734 838 938 1012 1178 1258 1358 1458 1534 1818 2114 24
1
Sizes 3 4
818 8 8 918 10 1114 1234 1378 1412 1514 1638 1734 1978 23 2612
3
5
10 11 4 1234 1378 1412 1514 1638 1734 1978 23 2612
1
6
1178 1258 1414 1538 16 1718 1814 1914 2134 25 2818
8
1614 1714 18 19 2014 2112 24 28 3114
A
8 818 814 838 858 878 918 938 958 1014 1034 1134 1234
B
858 878 918 938 958 1014 1034 1134 1234 1334 1438 1538 1638 1738 1938 2238 2538
C
858 878 918 938 958 1014 1034 1134 1234 1334 1438 1538 1638 1738 1938 2238 2538
1
858 878 918 938 958 1014 1034 1134 1234 1334 1438 1538 1638 1738 1938 2238 2538
2
858 878 918 938 958 1014 1034 1134 1234 1334 1438 1538 1638 1738 1938 2238 2538
Sizes 3
638 7 7 4 734 838 938 1012 1178 1258 1358 1458 1534 1818 2114 24
1
918 10 1114 1234 1378 1412 1514 1638 1734 1978 23 2612
938 958 1014 1034 1134 1234 1334 1438 1538 1612 1712 2038 2312 2658
1014 1034 1134 1278 14 1458 1534 1678 1778 2038 2312 2658
1118 1238 1358 1434 1538 1678 18 1938 2112 2412 2712
12 1338 1434 1578 1714 1838 1912 2038 2212 2638 2958
* Please specify whether a 1005F clamp or 1075F clamp is required when ordering. **When calculating strut C-C for intermediate sizes, use the takeout E for the next largest pipe diameter. Note: Carbon steel clamps will accomodate 4" of insulation. Alloy clamps will accomodate 6". High temperature clamps will be made from alloy steel. Stainless steel available upon request. For other special design requirements, please contact your Anvil EPS sales representative.
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/sway-strut or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
211
Straps
Fig. 211, Fig. C-211 Sway Strut Assembly Fig. 640, Fig. C-640: Field Welded Strut
OPTION 1
T D1
OPTION 2
A R F C-C 312" FOR FIG. 211 C-C 2" FOR FIG. 640 W (W = C TO C - 2F)
E F
C L
OPTION 3
Fig. 211, C-211, Fig. 640 & Fig. C-640: LOad (lbs) DimensiOns (in)
Fig. 211 & Fig. 640 Size
A B C 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
n
Load
n
D1
114 238
N
1
R
5
S
5
T
0.374 0.372 0.749 0.747 0.749 0.747 0.999 0.997 0.999 0.997 1.249 1.247 1.249 1.247 1.499 1.497 1.749 1.747 1.999 1.997 2.499 2.497
C-C
Max 60 108 Min 1612 19 21 2138
Fig. 211 W
Max 5318 9918 Min 958 1018
F
3716
Weld Z Max
60
3
F
21116 31116 418 414 5 514 6 678 8 1014
650 1,500 4,500 8,000 11,630 15,700 20,700 27,200 33,500 68,200 120,000
1 112 2
4 8
212
138 138
16
278 212 3 3 4 5 534 714 3 618 778 918 14 3316 414 538 614 834
112
16 96
634 758
4 6
15 1714
834 11
8 4
28 3434
Loads must not be applied outside a 10 included angle cone of action to the pipe clamp axis without special authorization. Fig. 640 shipped at maximum length C-C, eld cut to W to suit, unless otherwise specied.
212 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/sway-strut or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
Pipe Size
4 1 114 112 2 212 3 312 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30 36
3
Size A
2716 2916 21116 418 518 538 51516 6316 612 734 838 938 1012
Size B&C
638 7 714 734 838 938 1012 1178 1258 1358 1458 1534 1818 2114 24
Size 1
638 7 714 734 838 938 1012 1178 1258 1358 1458 1534 1818 2114 24
Note: "E" Dimensions are for carbon steel clamps only, with maximum insulation of 4" and temperature of 650. For clamp takeouts for temperatures above 650F, see corresponding size of Fig. 211.
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/sway-strut or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
213
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
D1
OPTION 1
ALL AROUND WELD BY FIELD
OPTION 2
A R B
C-C W F
E C-C C L SIZES BC-1, BC-2, 1-1 & 1-2 PIPE CLAMP (INCLUDES STUD)
OPTION 3
Load
n
C-C Max
658 812 1314 612 734 81116 101516 15716 19916 878 1058 1178 1518 2158
F Min
538 612 812 6 658 7916 81116 101516 15716 8 878 1014 1178 1518
W Min
1916 214 112 238 238 21116 21116 21116 518 21316 21316 3316 3316 3316 258 3116 51316 112 218 234 378 618 8316 21516 31316 41316 6716 91116
Max
21316 414 614 278 312 31316 41516 7316 914 31116 4916 41316 6716 91116
Rod End
D1
T Nom.
650
114
1316
B&C
4,500
212
238
138
138
218
8,000
114
212
278
1916
138
214
Loads must not be applied outside a 10 included angle cone of action to the pipe clamp axis without special authorization.
214 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/sway-strut or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
Sway Strut
Anvil International Precision Park 160 Frenchtown Rd. North Kingstown, RI 02852
For technical information regarding Sway Struts Call or Email: Phone Number: (401) 886-3020 Email: eps_contact@anvilintl.com
Finish: Standard Primer: __________ Galvanized: __________ Special Coating: _______________ Quantity: _______________ Figure No.: Options a re: 211, 640 or: C-211, C-640 Size: Options are: A, B, C and 1 thru 8______________________ Options are: 1 (1 Rear Bkt) ___________________________ 2 (2 Rear Bkt) ___________________________ 3 (1 Rear Bkt & Pipe Clamp) Pipe Size___________________________ Pipe Material: Carbon Steel, Alloy*, Stainless*
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/sway-strut or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
215
SNUBBERS
Hydraulic Snubber
Size Range: Eight standard sizes with load ratings from 350 to 120,000 pounds. Finish: Basic unit is corrosion resistant salt bath nitrided. Attachments are painted with semi gloss primer, carbon zinc or other. Service: For use on piping systems or equipment when unrestrained thermal movement must be allowed, but which must Fig. 3306 be restrained during impulsive or cyclic disturbance. The unit is not effective against low amplitude, high frequency movement. Use with standard settings to prevent destructive response to earthquakes, ow transients or wind load. Special settings are available to absorb the continuous thrust Fig. 3307 with Extension Piece resulting from safety valve blow-off or pipe rupture. Standard Settings: The standard settings are: Locking (activation) velocity 8 2 in/min. Bleed rate (post activation) at normal rated load 4 1 in/min. (Special settings are available). The valves are calibrated at the factory within the tolerances indicated at room temperature. Locking velocity and bleed rate will vary with temperature. Testing has indicated that there is little effect of these changes on dynamic operation. Features: Temperature compensating valves minimize the effects of temperature on lockup and bleed. Pressurized reservoirs Continuous operation at 150 F with brief transients to 340 F Factory calibrated valves Rapid, positive valve closure Special design minimizes the lost motion which results from the shifting and seating of piston seals Unlocked resisting force is less than 17 12 pounds for sizes 14 and 12 and less than 2% of rated load for larger sizes Stable non-ammable, long life hydraulic uid Self-aligning bushings permit 5 misalignment or angular motion. LOads (lbs) Bushings are coated with a dry lubricant. Size Stroke (in) Max Load * Choice of coating (paint, primer, carbo zinc, epoxy, plating or other) 1 4 4 350 for attachments. 1 2 212, 4 650 Applications: Direct replacement for Fig. 306/307 Pacic Scientic (PSA) mechanical 1 4, 8 1,500 snubbers: Exact load ratings, exact pin sizes, exact stroke lengths 3 5, 10 6,000 and exact pin-to-pin dimensions. The cross sectional dimensions of 10 6, 12 15,000 the Fig. 3306 are based on those of PSA to facilitate non-interference one-to-one replacement. Pins, clamps, pivot mounts, extension pieces, 32 5 32,000 and rear brackets used with PSA snubbers are compatible with the 35 6, 18 50,000 Fig. 3306 and can be utilized. 100 6 120,000 New installations: For new installations, the Fig. 3306 is available with a complete line of pipe clamps and rear brackets. * Loads must not be applied outside a 10 included angle cone of
action to the pipe clamp axis without special authorization.
216 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/snubbers or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
SNUBBERS
Pipe Supports
Hydraulic Snubber
Ordering: Specify Fig. No. Size Stroke Load Cold and hot piston settings W dimension when specifying Fig. 3307 Pipe clamp size when specifying option 3 Attachment surface coating Option
Consists of
Fig 3306: Basic unit (snubber) with pivot mount and one rear bracket. Fig. 3307: Basic unit with extension piece and one rear bracket. Option 0 plus cylinder eye. Option 0 plus cylinder eye and additional rear bracket. Option 0 plus cylinder eye and pipe clamp.
2
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
217
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Straps
SNUBBERS
Fig. 3306 Hydraulic Shock and Sway Suppressor (cont.) Fig. 3307: with Extension Piece
X A B R L P APPLIES TO SIZES 1/4 - 10 P FEMALE THREAD H FOR SIZES 3 - 100 MALE THREAD FOR SIZES 1/4 - 1 DEPTH G
PISTON SETTING
D
Z X ALL AROUND WELD BY FIELD
D Q R OPTION 1
OPTION 2
S C L T OPTION 3
K DIA.
218 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/snubbers or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
SNUBBERS
Pipe Supports N P Q R Ref Max S T Dia W
Min
C*
Min Mid Max
D1
Max Pin to Max Pin 61.50 61.50 25.06 61.00 32.62 71.72 39.16
1.00 1.19
0.19 0.19 0.13 1.25 2.25 2.10 1.00 1.12 1.48 3.38
1 3 10 32 35 100
6.00 24.0 27.00 30.0 4.62 3.00 9.75 6.50 7.75 1.88 178-12-2B 18.00 36.0 45.0 54.0 6.00 7.25 3.80 29.0 32.00 35.0 14.0 8.75 8.31 3.00 3-12-2B
6.00
4.50 1.25
1.499 5.25 79.75 117.50 1.497 14.63 55.75 117.80 2.499 6.50 74.19 117.50 2.447
4 & 12
2716 2916 21116 418 518 538 51516 6316 612 734 838 938 1012
1
7 7 7 714 734 838 938 1012 1178 1258 1358 1458 1534 1818 2114 24
32
10 10 1114 1234 1378 1412 1514 1638 1734 1978 23 2612
35
1258 1414 1538 16 1718 1814 1914 2134 25 2818
* Intermediate sizes between 20 and 36 are available and will have the take out and stock of the next larger size. Note: "E" Dimensions are for carbon steel clamps only, with maximum insulation of 4" and temperature of 650.
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/snubbers or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
219
Index
7 7 7 714 734 838 938 1012 1178 1258 1358 1458 1534 1818 2114 24
7 818 818 838 918 10 1114 1234 1378 1412 1514 1638 1734 1978 23 2612
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
1.62 112-12-2B
1.499 1.497
Pipe Roll
9.0 7.5 9.0 11.0 1.62 1.56 15.5 14.0 2.12 2.62 20.0 16.1 3.00 4.06 23.1
3.50 0.374 3.50 0.372 3.50 3.81 0.499 4.00 1.75 3.00 0.38 38-16-2A 3.25 2.38 1.31 0.38 0.69 2.00 1.00 1.00 0.497 N/A 4.44 0.749 5.00 3.62 4.50 0.75 58-18-2B 4.62 4.62 2.38 0.50 1.44 2.12 1.38 1.38 0.747 N/A 0.999 5.19 7.00 4.00 5.12 1.00 78-14-2B 5.75 5.75 2.88 1.00 1.62 2.00 1.62 1.38 0.997 N/A
Trapeze
Straps
SNUBBERS
Fig. 200, Fig. C-200 Hydraulic Snubber Fig. 201, Fig. C-201: with Extension Piece
Size Range: Seven standard sizes with cylinder bores of 1 12" to 8" and with normal load ratings from 3,000 pounds to 128,000 pounds. All are available with 5", 10", 15", or 20" strokes except the 1 12" size which is offered with 5 and 10 strokes only. Snubbers are available with integral or remote reservoirs. Finish: Fig. 200/201 painted with semi gloss primer. Fig. C-200/C-201 corrosion resistant; painted with carbo zinc. Service: For use on piping systems or equipment when unrestrained thermal movement must be allowed, but which must be restrained during impulsive or cyclic disturbance. The unit is not effective against low amplitude, high frequency movement. Use with standard settings to prevent destructive response to earthquakes, ow transients or wind load. Special settings are available to absorb the continuous thrust resulting from safety valve blow-off or pipe rupture. Standard settings: The standard settings are: Locking (activation) velocity 8 +/ - 2 in/min. Bleed rate (post activation) at normal rated load 4 +/ - 1 in/min. (Special settings are available). The valves are calibrated at the factory within the tolerances indicated at room temperature. Locking velocity and bleed rate will vary with temperature. Testing has indicated that there is little effect of these changes on dynamic operation. Features: Choice of valve type Adjustable permits eld adjustments Temperature compensating minimizes the effects of temperature on lockup and bleed Choice of reservoir type Transparent continuous operation at 200 F with brief transients to 250 F Metal or pressurized metal allows brief transients to 340 F Pressurized eliminates the concern of reservoir orientation relative to valve and cylinder minimizes internal contamination Remote Factory calibrated valves Rapid, positive valve closure Special design minimizes the lost motion which results from the shifting and seating of piston seals Unlocked resisting force is less than 1% of rated load Stable, non-ammable, long life hydraulic uid made highly visible for ease of inspection Self-aligning bushings permit 5 misalignment or angular motion. Bushings are coated with a dry lubricant. Choice of coating (paint, primer, carbo zinc, epoxy, plating or other)
LOads (lbs)
Cylinder Size (in)
112 (5" stroke) 1 2 (10" stroke)
1
Max Load *
3,000 1,250 12,500 10,500 21,000 32,000 50,000 72,000 128,000
2 2 (20" stroke)
1
3 4
1
4 5 6 8
* Loads must not be applied outside a 10 included angle cone of action to the pipe clamp axis without special authorization.
220 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/snubbers or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
SNUBBERS
Snubber (cont.)
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/snubbers or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
221
Index
dimension, Z. This dimension represents the distance between the cylinder head and the end of the rod when the rod is fully retracted. Whenever specifying the position at which the piston rod is to be set, the total dimension from the cylinder head to the end of the rod should be given. Thus, Piston Setting = Piston Position + Z. (5) Assembly length: Determine the installed C dimension by adding the installed piston position (not setting) to C minimum. Lay in take out dimensions E and/or B, and nd required pin-to-pin snubber length. If a pin-to-pin length adjustment is desired, use Fig. 201. Calculate the required W dimension by subtracting (C installed + F) from the required pin-to-pin length. If this is less than W minimum, only a Fig. 200 can be used, and one of the attachments will have to be moved or shimmed to suit. If a Fig. 200 is to be used, make sure that the required pin-to-pin length is at least as great as (C installed + B). If neither a Fig. 200 nor a Fig. 201 can be accommodated, and the installation cannot be modied, consult your Anvil representative about designing a special or modied unit.
Consists of
Fig 200: Basic unit (snubber) with pivot mount and one rear bracket. Fig. 201: Basic unit with extension piece and one rear bracket. Option 0 plus cylinder eye. Option 0 plus cylinder eye and additional rear bracket. Option 0 plus cylinder eye and pipe clamp.
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
SNUBBERS
FEMALE THREAD "H" FOR 21/2"-8" CYL. MALE THREAD FOR 11/2" CYLINDER DEPTH "G"
PISTON SETTING
SECTION X-X
T
FIG. 200 HYDRAULIC SHOCK & SWAY SUPPRESSOR SIZE COLD P.S. STROKE HOT P.S. SERIAL NO. CUSTOMERS MARK NO
U.S. PATENT NO 3106992
OPTION 1
OPTION 2
Q 10
C L
OPTION 3
222 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/snubbers or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
SNUBBERS
C
Min Mid Max
D D1
F
6 7316
G
3
H
5
I
Metal Trans. Res. Res. Press Res.
N Q
5
S
1
T
3
W
Min Max
Z
5
314
4 334
5 412
534 512
714 6
1318 1818 1338 1838 2338 2838 1478 1978 2478 2978 1618 2118 2618 3118 18 23 28 33 1934 2434 2934 3434 2312 2812 3312 3812
1558 2318 1578 2338 3078 3838 1738 2478 3238 3978 1858 2618 3358 4118 2012 28 3512 43 2214 2934 3714 4434 26 3312 41 4812
1818 2 238 2818 1838 2838 2 278 3838 4838 1978 2978 3 3316 3978 4978 2118 3118 1 6 8 414 4118 5118 23 33 778 538 43 53 2434 3434 1 9 8 614 4434 5434 2812 3812 14 834 4812 5812
4 8
8 218 118 4 2
912
634
334 214
118
71316
112 1112
118
178
11516 214 21412 9116 758 101516 514 378 2 458 312 234
2 1338
134
1412
212 1412
214
212
638 7 7 7 714 734 838 938 1012 1178 1258 1358 1458 1534 1818 2114 24
5
1178 1258 1414 1538 16 1718 1814 1914 2134 25 2818
6
1914 2134 25 2818
112
858 878 918 938 958 1014 1034 1134 1234
212
858 878 918 938 958 1014 1034 1134 1234 1334 1438 1538 1638 1738 1938 2238 2538
314
1014 1034 1134 1234 1334 1434 1578 1678 18 20 2312 2658
Cylinder Bore 4 5
1038 1118 1238 1378 15 1534 1678 18 19 2178 25 2818 1178 1314 15 1614 17 1818 1914 21 2314 2612 2958
6
2034 23 2614
8
2212 2434 2814
* Please specify whether a 1005F clamp or 1075F clamp is required when ordering. **When calculating snubber pin to pin for intermediate sizes, use the takeout E for the next largest pipe diameter. Note: Carbon steel clamps can accomodate up to 4" insulation. Alloy can accomodate 6". High temperature clamps will be made from alloy steel. Stainless steel available upon request. For other special design requirements, please contact your Anvil EPS sales representative.
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/snubbers or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
223
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Pipe Roll
158 138
1 1038
7558 6558 94916 84916 74916 64916 92 82 72 62 89916 79916 69916 59916 861316 761316 661316 561316 831516 731516 631516 531516 7512 6512 5512 4512
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
SNUBBERS
Fig. 312
Size Range: 38" through 2 12" Service: Used as a replacement to standard rear bracket load pin to facilitate easy removal at time of rebuild or testing. May be supplied with new orders, when specied. How to size: Select size consistent with load pin diameter for Fig. 200/201 or Fig. 3306/3307. Features: Designed to sharply reduce the time necessary to remove a badly corroded conventional pin and may also eliminate damage to the bushing and bracket assembly, particularly if the pin and bracket are corroded. Minimizes free play between pin to pin. Ordering: Specify gure number, nominal pin size and name. Installation: Shipped assembled. Remove nuts and washer. Loosen sleeve on pin and install sleeve/pin. Re-install washer and one nut. Tighten hex nut to snug. Install second nut.
Tapered Pin
L (REF)
T (NOMINAL)
Max Load
650 1,500 6,000 15,000 21,000 50,000 50,000 72,000 128,000
L
16164 238 3 8
7 3
8 2 4
4 & 12 1 3 10 35 100
1 3
1 114 1 2
1
4 8 412 7 8
1
2 2 314 4 5 6 8
134 2 212
The load must be applied by a spherical bearing.
634 7 4
3
938
224 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/snubbers or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
Fig. 38 SD
his product is a special design per customer requirements. T Contact Anvil Intl. for further information and how to order.
Half Clamp
C L
his product is a special design per customer requirements. Contact T Anvil Intl. for further information and how to order sizes not shown. Local pipe wall stress should be evaluated.
T - Thickness C
312 5 6 7
Fig. 71 SD
his product is a special design per customer requirements. Contact Anvil Intl. T for further information and how to order. he Anvil Fig. 71SD horizontal traveler facilitates the supporting of piping systems T subject to linear horizontal movements where head room is limited. Designed for use with Anvil Variable Spring Hangers or Constant Supports it can also be used in conjunction with a rigid type hanger assembly.
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/solutions/custom-fabrication or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
225
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
1 114 112
8 3 4
7516 7716
15
16
Constant Supports
H Max. Dia.
Spring Hangers
Max. Diam. H
Fig. 53 SD
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Fig. 72 SD
his product is a special design per customer requirements. Contact Anvil T International for further information and how to order. he Anvil Fig. 72SD Horizontal Traveler facilitates the supporting of piping systems T subject to dual directional horizontal movements where head room is limited. Designed for use with Anvil Variable Spring Hangers or Constant Supports, it can also be used in conjunction with a rigid type hanger assembly.
C L OF PIPE
Fig. 75 SD
his product is a special design per customer requirements. T Contact Anvil Intl. for further information and how to order. Pipe sizes 4" through 42" Note: Type B Saddle - If attached to alloy pipe, furnish material specication applicable to the pipe. (Alloy Bars furnished for attachment to alloy pipe only.)
C L OF PIPE
Fig. 76 SD
This product is a special design per customer requirements. Contact Anvil International for further information and how to order. Installation: The two piece fabricated roller is designed for one of the two rollers on each side of the assembly to be in contact PIPE SIZES 4" - 42" with the pipe.
A
2318 26 2878 3034 31316 32116 341516 371116 40916 4338
B
13 8
5
C
8 16
3
D
81516 91516 101516 111116 121316 1314 14516 1512 16916 1758
E
0 1 2 234 114 11116 234 31516 5 6116
6 31/2
C L OF PIPE
15/16 C
1 /4
60,000
16 4
1
10 16
13
B D
43/16
C L OF PIPE
60,000 60,000
1358 1614
8316 101316
4 138 238 2
1
226 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/solutions/custom-fabrication or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
Fig. 40 SD
Material: Carbon steel chrome molybdenum or stainless steel. Finish: Plain or Galvanized Maximum Temperature: As required. Ordering: Specify gure number 40SD, riser clamp special design, material, exact pipe size, load, operating temperature, insulation thickness, C-C dimension, rod diameter, nish and if connected to a spring or rigid connection. Service: Riser clamps are used for the support of vertical piping. Load is carried by shear lugs which are welded to the pipe. Shear lugs not provided.
A S C L K
Riser Clamp
BOLT DIAM B. LENGTH "F"
A*
Ordering: Specify Fig. 41SD double bolt pipe clamp, material specication, pipe size, load, operating temperature, insulation thickness and nish. Alloy clamps, unless otherwise specied, will be furnished with alloy studs made from ASTM A 193-B7 stud stock and ASTM A 194-Gr. 2H hex nuts.
BOLT DIA. AND LENGTH F
S A
C L
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/solutions/custom-fabrication or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
227
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Fig. 41 SD
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
C to C
A*
Pipe Roll
PIPE SPACER
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Fig. 42 SD
Ordering: Specify Fig. 42SD pipe clamp, material specication, pipe size, load, temperature and nish. Alloy clamps, unless otherwise specied, will be furnished with alloy studs made from ASTM A 193-B7 stud stock and ASTM A 194-Gr. 2H hex nuts.
C L
228 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/solutions/custom-fabrication or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
140, 146
140, 146
80 V TYPE G 140, 146 290 224, 246 290 295, 295A, 295H
60
Each of these drawings are available on the Anvil web site in CAD format. The le name at the bottom of each box refers to that CAD le.
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
229
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
80 V TYPE C
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Straps
66 81-H TYPE B
66 81-H TYPE B
140, 146 140, 146 290 295, 295A, 295H 299 53-SD WELD LUG
140, 146
ELBOW
81-H TYPE D
ELBOW
81 H TYPE F
Each of these drawings are available on the Anvil web site in CAD format. The le name at the bottom of each box refers to that CAD le.
230 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/constant-support or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
66 290 140, 146 82, 268, 98 TYPE A 140, 146 290 295, 295A, 295H 140, 146 82, 268, 98 TYPE A 140, 146 290 295, 295A, 295H
140, 146 140, 146 299 53-SD WELD LUG 299 53-SD WELD LUG
66
Each of these drawings are available on the Anvil web site in CAD format. The le name at the bottom of each box refers to that CAD le.
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/spring-hangers or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
231
Index
ELBOW
Technical Data
Application Examples
66
55L 291
Snubbers
Constant Supports
66
66
Spring Hangers
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Straps
55L
ELBOW
ELBOW
PIPE STANCHION 63 PIPE SLIDE 140, 146 290 295, 295A, 295H 82, 268, 98 TYPE F
DUAL ROLLERS
66 PIPE STANCHION 62 290 C-C (NEEDED) 140, 146 82, 268, 98 TYPE F 82, 268, 98 TYPE G C-C (NEEDED)
66 290
60
Each of these drawings are available on the Anvil web site in CAD format. The le name at the bottom of each box refers to that CAD le.
232 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
For more information please visit www.anvileps.com/product/spring-hangers or contact eps_contact@anvilintl.com
66
55 LUG 299
55 LUG 299
140, 146
140, 146
212, 216
60
Each of these drawings are available on the Anvil web site in CAD format. The le name at the bottom of each box refers to that CAD le.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
233
Index
60
Technical Data
230
45 BACK/BACK CHANNEL SIZED BY CUSTOMERS TO MEET LOAD REQ. ALTERNATE ORIENTATION OF 137S/PIPE
45 BACK/BACK CHANNEL SIZED BY CUSTOMERS TO MEET LOAD REQ. ALTERNATE ORIENTATION OF 137S/PIPE
Application Examples
290
Snubbers
290
290
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Pipe Roll
140, 146
66 290 FIG. 230 TURNBUCKLE AND FIG. 253 ROD MAY BE ADDED FOR VERTICAL ADJUSTMENT
Trapeze
Straps
218 157
218 157
218 157
92, 93
140, 146
140, 146 140, 146 140, 146
167
167
228, 292
228, 292
228, 292
218 157
HOT SERVICE UP TO 4" INSULATION 140, 146 290 295, 295A, 295H 140, 146 260 140, 146 290 212, 216
140, 146
69, CT-69
92, 93, 94
86 66 290
HOT SERVICE UP TO 4" INSULATION
140, 146
140, 146
140, 146
69, CT-69
65, CT-65, 260
Each of these drawings are available on the Anvil web site in CAD format. The le name at the bottom of each box refers to that CAD le.
234 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
60
60
167
69, CT-69
140, 146
140, 146
167
Each of these drawings are available on the Anvil web site in CAD format. The le name at the bottom of each box refers to that CAD le.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
235
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Pipe Roll
FIG. 230 TURNBUCKLE AND FIG. 253 ROD MAY BE ADDED FOR VERTICAL ADJUSTMENT
140, 146
66 290
Trapeze
Straps
140, 146 160 (1" INSULATION) 161 (112" INSULATION) 162 (2" INSULATION) 163 (212" INSULATION) 164 (3" INSULATION) 165 (4" INSULATION) 171 160 (1" INSULATION) 161 (112" INSULATION) 162 (2" INSULATION) 163 (212" INSULATION) 164 (3" INSULATION) 165 (4" INSULATION)
140, 146
271
171
140, 146
177 175
271
Each of these drawings are available on the Anvil web site in CAD format. The le name at the bottom of each box refers to that CAD le.
236 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
(g) The total travel for Constant Support Hangers will be equal to actual travel plus 20%. In no case will the difference between actual and total travel be less than 1". The Constant Support Hanger will have travel scales on both sides of the support frame to accommodate inspections.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
237
(z) All threads are UNC unless otherwise specied. Hanger Design Service anger for piping 2 12" and larger, and all spring support for H assemblies, shall be completely engineered. (a) Engineered hanger assemblies shall be detailed on 8 12" x 11" sheets. Each sketch will include a location plan showing the location of the hanger in relation to columns of equipment. Each sketch will include an exact bill of material for the component parts making up each assembly.
(b) Each engineered hanger assembly will be individually bundled and tagged as far as practical, ready for installation. Hanger material for piping 2" and smaller shall be shipped as loose material, identied by piping system only. A piping drawing marked with approximate hanger locations and types, and hanger sketches showing typical support arrangements will be furnished.
(c) Hanger inspections shall be performed in accordance with MSS-SP-89 (Section 7.7), ASME B31.1 (Appendix V), and ASME Section III Subsection NF (NF-5000).
238 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Section 15060
PART 1 GENERAL
1.1 1.2 SECTION INCLUDES A. Hangers and supports for mechanical piping, ducting and equipment. RELATED SECTIONS A. Division 3 Section: Cast-in-Place Concrete. B. Division 5 Section: Structural Steel. C. Division 5 Section: Metal Fabrications.
B. Selection of Hangers and Supports for Pipe Movement: 1. Select hangers and supports to perform under all conditions of operation, allowing free expansion and contraction, and to prevent excessive stresses being introduced into piping system and connected equipment. 2. Angularity of rod hanger resulting from horizontal movement of the piping system from cold to hot positions shall not to exceed 4 degrees from vertical. 3. Where horizontal pipe movement is greater than 1/2 inch (12.7 mm), offset pipe hanger and support so that rod hanger is vertical in hot position. 4. Where signicant vertical movement of the pipe occurs at the hanger location, a resilient support must be used. Selection of
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
239
Index
1.4 SYSTEM DESCRIPTION A. Contractor General Requirements: 1. Incorporate in construction pipe hangers and supports to manufacturers recommendations utilizing manufacturers regular production components, parts and assemblies. 2. Comply with maximum load ratings with consideration for allowable stresses prescribed by ASME B31.1 or MSS SP-58. 3. Provide supports, guides and anchors that do not transmit unacceptable heat and vibration to building structure. 4. The selection of pipe hangers and supports shall be based upon the overall design concept of the piping systems and any special requirements, which may be called for in the specications. The support systems shall provide for, and control, the free or intended movement of the piping including its movement in relation to that of connected equipment. (Extracted from ANSI/ MSS-SP69, 2003, Page 1, Section 4.2, with permission of the publisher, the Manufacturers Standardization Society.) 5. Provide for vertical adjustments after installation of supported material and during commissioning, where feasible, to ensure pipe is at design elevation and slope.
Application Examples
Snubbers
C.
Manufacturers Standardization Society of The Valve and Fittings Industry (MSS) Standard Practices: 1. SP-58 Pipe Hangers and Supports - Materials, Design and Manufacture. 2. SP-69 Pipe Hangers and Supports - Selection and Application. 3. SP-77 Guidelines for Pipe Support Contractual Relationships. 4. SP-89 Pipe Hangers and Supports - Fabrication and Installation Practices. 5. SP-90 Guidelines on Terminology for Pipe Hangers and Supports. 6. SP-127 Bracing for Piping Systems Seismic-Wind-Dynamic Design, Selection, Application.
B. ASTM International (ASTM): 1. A36 - Standard Specication for Carbon Structural Steel. 2. A47 - Standard Specication for Ferritic Malleable Iron Castings. 3. A48 - Standard Specication for Gray Iron Castings. 4. A53 - Standard Specication for Pipe, Steel, Black and Hot-Dipped, Zinc-Coated, Welded and Seamless. 5. A123 - Standard Specication for Zinc (Hot-Dip Galvanized) Coatings on Iron and Steel Products. 6. A240 - Standard Specication for Chromium and Chromium-Nickel Stainless Steel Plate, Sheet, and Strip for Pressure Vessels and for General Applications. 7. A387 - Standard Specication for Pressure Vessel Plates, Alloy Steel, Chromium-Molybdenum. 8. A515 - Standard Specication for Pressure Vessel Plates, Carbon Steel, for Intermediate-and Higher-Temperature Service. 9. A536 - Standard Specication for Ductile Iron Castings. 10. A575 - Standard Specication for Steel Bars, Carbon, Merchant Quality, M-Grades. 11. A668 - Standard Specication for Steel Forgings, Carbon and Alloy, for General Industrial Use. 12. A1011 - Standard Specication for Steel, Sheet and Strip, Hot-Rolled, Carbon, Structural, High-Strength Low-Alloy and High- Strength Low-Alloy with Improved Formability. 13. B633 - Standard Specication for Electrodeposited Coatings of Zinc on Iron and Steel.
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
1.3 REFERENCES A. American Society of Mechanical Engineers (ASME): 1. B31.1 - Power Piping (SI Edition). 2. B31.3 - Chemical Plant and Petroleum Renery Piping. 3. B31.9 - Building Services Piping.
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Section 15060
resilient supports shall be based on permissible load variation and effects on adjacent equipment. Support selection for typical load variations are shown in Table 2 of MSS-SP-69. Load and movement calculations shall be made for the proper selection of spring hangers. Vertical movement and load transfer from riser expansion to horizontal runs shall be given consideration when applying spring hangers. Spring Cushion Hangers may be used where vertical movement does not exceed 1/4 inch (6 mm), and where formal load and movement calculations are not required. Variable spring Hangers shall be used for all other resilient support requirements. Constant Support Hangers shall be used on piping systems where the deviation in supporting force must be limited to 6 percent and which cannot be accommodated by a Variable Spring Hanger. (Extracted from ANSI/MSS-SP69, 2003, Page 7, Section 7.4 and 7.4.1 to 7.4.3, inclusive, with permission of the publisher, the Manufacturers Standardization Society.)
C. Hanger Spacing: (Extracted from ANSI/MSS-SP69, 2003, Page 8, Table 3, with permission of the publisher, the Manufacturers Standardization Society.)
5 Fire Protection
8 Glass
9 Plastic
10 Fiberglass Reinforced
(6) (10) (15) (20) (25) (32) (40) (50) (65) (80) (90) (100) (125) (150) (200) (250) (300) (350) (400) (450) (500) (600) (750)
7 7 7 7 7 9 10 11 12 13 14 16 17 19 22 23 25 27 28 30 32 33
2.1 2.1 2.1 2.1 2.1 2.7 3.0 3.4 3.7 4.0 4.3 4.9 5.2 5.8 6.7 7.0 7.6 8.2 8.5 9.1 9.8 10.1
8 8 9 9 9 12 13 14 15 16 17 19 21 24 26 30 32 35 37 39 42 44
2.4 2.4 2.7 2.7 2.7 3.7 4.0 4.3 4.6 4.9 5.2 5.8 6.4 7.3 7.9 9.1 9.8 10.7 11.3 11.9 12.8 13.4
5 5 5 5 6 7 8 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 16 18 19
1.5 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.8 2.1 2.4 2.4 2.7 3.0 3.4 3.7 4.0 4.3 4.9 5.5 5.8
5 6 6 7 8 9 10 11 13 14 15 16 18 20 23 25 28
1.5 1.8 1.8 2.1 2.4 2.7 3.0 3.4 4.0 4.3 4.6 4.9 5.5 6.1 7.0 7.6 8.5
20 ft. (6.1 m) max spacing; min of one (1) hanger per pipe section close to the joint behind the bell and at change of direction and branch connections. For pipe sizes six (6) inches (150 mm) and under, installed on ASME B31 projects, that are subjected to loadings other than weight of pipe and contents, the span should be limited to the maximum spacing for water service steel pipe.
10 ft. (3.0 m) max spacing; min of one (1) hanger per pipe section close to joint on the barrel also at change of direction and branch connections
Follow pipe manufacturers recommendations for material and service condition. See Section 18.
Follow pipe manufacturers recommendations for material and service condition. See Section 19.
8 ft. (2.4 m) max spacing, follow pipe manufacturers recommendations See Section 17.
Notes: (1) For spacing supports incorporating type 40 shields, see table 5. (2) Does not apply where span calculations are made or where there are concentrated loads between supports such as anges, valves, specialties, etc. or changes in direction requiring additional supports. (3) Unbalanced forces of hydrostatic or hydrodynamic origin (thrust forces) unless restrained externally can result in pipe movement and separation of joints if the joints of the system are not of a restrained joint design. See Section 13.3.
D. Pipe Attachments for Insulated Lines: 1. The connections to pipe attachments shall be outside the insulation so that movement of the line shall not cause damage to the insulation. Insulation protection shields shall be provided to protect the vapor barrier of the insulation on cold lines. Under no circumstances shall hangers, supports or guides be applied directly to horizontal pipe or tubing on vapor barrier lines. For cryogenic piping systems, shields incorporating rigid, high-density polyurethane foam inserts or other load bearing insulation should be used. The support should include means for maintaining vapor barrier integrity. Because of the temperature/compressive strength relationship of polyurethane foam, the recommended shield designs must be selected to accommodate loading conditions at both the installation and operating temperature. (Extracted from ANSI/MSS-SP69, 2003, Page 10, Section 10 and 10.1 to 10.3, inclusive, with permission of the publisher, the Manufacturers Standardization Society.) 2. Deviation to the above is permissible when the Anvil Fig 260 ISS (Insulation Saddle System) is used when proper insulating techniques are employed including the use of mastic and caulk on all insulation edges, and nal taping.
Follow requirements of the National Fire Protection Association See Section 14.
240 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Section 15060
E. Recommended Minimum Rod Diameters for Single Rigid Rod Hangers: (Extracted from ANSI/MSS-SP69, 2003, Page 9, Table 4, with permission of the publisher, the Manufacturers Standardization Society.)
TABLE 4 Recommended Min. Rod Diameter for Single Rigid Rod Hangers(1)(2)
Columns(3) 1, 2, 6, 7
Nominal Pipe or Tubing Size
in. mm
Columns(3) 3, 4, 8, 9, 10
Nominal Rod Diameter
ft. m
1.5
B. Product Data: Manufacturers data sheets on each product to be used, including: 1. Preparation instructions and recommendations.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
241
Index
F. Anchors Guides and Restraints: 1. Anchors, guides and restraints shall be located by the Engineer responsible for piping design. Should the need or the desirability of relocating, eliminating or adding anchors, guides or restraints arise; such changes shall be brought to the attention of the Engineer for consideration and approval. 2. Anchors, guides and restraints shall be designed for imposed loadings as determined by the Engineer. For guided systems, in the absence of specied lateral loads, the guide shall be designed for 20 percent of the dead weight load based on the spans listed in Table 3, with a design load of 50 lb (0.22 kN) as a minimum. 3. For pressure piping with joints not having a restraining design, other positive restraining means such as clamps, rods and/or thrust blocking shall be used to maintain the integrity of the joints. 4. The necessity for, and the location of, shock suppressors and seismic control devices shall be as determined by the Engineer responsible for piping design. 5. The location, type and number of corrective devices which may be necessary to control any unforeseen vibrations, as determined after the piping is in service, are not a part of this standard. 6. Refer to MSS SP-127 for the design, selection, and application of the bracing piping systems subject to seismic - wind - dynamic loading. 7. (Extracted from ANSI/MSS-SP69, 2003, Page 11, Section 13 and 13.1 to 10.6, inclusive, with permission of the publisher, the Manufacturers Standardization Society.)
Application Examples
Snubbers
1. 2. 3.
(1) For calculated loads, rod diameters may be sized in accordance with MSS SP-58, Table 3 provided Table 1 and Section 73 of MSS SP-58 are satised. (2) Rods may be reduced one size for double rod hangers. Minimum rod diameter shall be 3/8 inch (9.5 mm) (M10). (3) Columns noted refer to Table 3.
(6) (10) (15) (20) (25) (32) (40) (50) (65) (80) (90) (100) (125) (150) (200) (250) (300) (350) (400) (450) (500) (600) (750)
M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M12 M12 M12 M16 M16 M20 M20 M20 M20 M24 M24 M24 M30 M30 M30
8 3 8 3 8 3 8 3 8 3 8 3 8 3 8 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 5 8 3 4 3 4 3 4
3
M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M12 M12 M12 M12 M12 M16 M20 M20 M20
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Section 15060
2. Load capacity and sizing schedules specic to Project. 3. Installation methods.
C. Certications: 1. Product certicates signed by manufacturer certifying materials comply with specied performance characteristics and criteria and physical requirements. Certicates shall be furnished only as required by specic codes, upon request. D. Shop Drawings: 1. Bases, hangers and supports. 2. Connections to equipment and structure. 3. Structural assemblies.
E. Selection Samples: For each nish product specied, two complete sets of color chips representing manufacturers full range of available colors and patterns. F. Verication Samples: For each nish product specied, two samples, minimum size 6 inches (150 mm) square, representing actual product, color, and patterns. G. Closeout Submittals: 1. Warranty: Warranty documents. 2. Operation and Maintenance Data: Operation and maintenance data for installed products in accordance with Division 1 Closeout Submittals (Maintenance Data and Operation Data) Section. Include methods for maintaining installed products, and precautions against cleaning materials and methods detrimental to nishes and performance. 1.6 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Manufacturer Qualications: 1. Manufacturing facilities shall be registered to ISO 9001.2000 and assessed to ISO 9000.2000 standard. A copy of the current certicate shall be available upon request. B. Installer Qualications: 1. Utilize an installer experienced in performing work of this section who is experienced in installation of work similar to that required for this project and per the minimum requirements of MSS SP-89. C. Conduct pre-installation meeting to verify project requirements, coordinate with other trades, and establish condition and completeness of substrate. Review manufacturers installation instructions and manufacturers warranty requirements. 1.7 DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND HANDLING A. Store products in manufacturers unopened packaging until ready for installation.
B. Store and dispose of solvent-based materials, and materials used with solvent-based materials, in accordance with requirements of local authorities having jurisdiction. 1.8 PROJECT CONDITIONS A. Maintain environmental conditions (temperature, humidity, and ventilation) within limits recommended by manufacturer for optimum results. Do not install products under environmental conditions outside manufacturers absolute limits. 1.9 WARRANTY A. Manufacturers Warranty: Submit, for Owners acceptance, manufacturers standard warranty document executed by authorized company ofcial. Manufacturers warranty is in addition to, and not a limitation of, other rights, Owner may have under Contract Documents.
A. Acceptable Manufacturer: Anvil Intl., Inc.; 110 Corporate Dr. Suite 10, Portsmouth, NH 03802. ASD. Tel: (603) 422-8000. Fax: (603) 422-8033. Web: http://www.anvilintl.com. B. Substitutions: Not permitted. C. Requests for substitutions will be considered in accordance with provisions of Section 01 60 00. MANUFACTURED UNITS - APPLICATION REQUIREMENTS A. Fabricate hangers, supports and sway braces to comply with building codes. B. Do not use installed hangers for rigging or erection purposes.
C. Materials available by product type. Provide materials to comply with location and application requirements unless noted otherwise on drawings and schedules. 1. Pipe rings - Malleable iron, carbon steel.
242 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Section 15060
2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. D. E.
D.
Steel Pipe Clamps: Fig. Numbers. 1. 40 Riser Clamp - Standard, MSS-SP-69 (Type 42). 2. 100 Extended Pipe Clamp. 3. 103 Offset Pipe Clamp.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
243
Index
C. Clevis: Fig. Numbers. 1. 65 Light Duty Adjustable Clevis. 2. 67 Pipe or Conduit Hanger, MSS-SP-69 (Type 5). 3. 260 ISS (Insulation Saddle System) for support of insulated pipe operating between 40 degrees F to 200 degrees F. See section 2.3.P.11 for additional information. 4. 260 Adjustable Clevis Hanger, MSS-SP-69 (Type 1). 5. 300 Adjustable Clevis for Insulated Lines, MSS-SP-69 (Type 1). 6. 590 Adjustable Clevis for Ductile or Cast Iron Pipe, MSS-SP-69 (Type 1).
Application Examples
B.
Pipe Rings: Fig. Numbers. 1. 67 Pipe or Conduit Hanger, MSS-SP-69 (Type 5). 2. 69 Adjustable Swivel Ring, Tapped per NFPA Standards, MSS-SP-69 (Type 10). 3. 104 Adjustable Swivel Ring, Split Ring Type, MSS-SP-69 (Type 6). 4. 108 Split Pipe Ring, MSS-SP-69 (Type 11). 5. 138R Extension Split Pipe Clamp (Rod Threaded), MSS-SP-69 (Type 12).
2.3 MANUFACTURED UNITS - MSS-SP-69 TYPES NOTED FOR PRODUCTS THAT ARE IN COMPLIANCE A. Copper Tubing Hangers: Fig. Numbers. 1. CT65 Light Weight Adjustable Clevis. 2. CT69 Adjustable Swivel Ring, MSS-SP-69 (Type 10). 3. CT109 Split Tubing Ring (Ring Only), MSS-SP-69 (Type 11). 4. CT121 Copper Tubing Riser Clamp, MSS-SP-69 (Type 8). 5. CT121C Copper Tubing Riser Clamp. 6. CT128R Rod Threaded Ceiling Flange. 7. CT138R Extension Split Tubing Clamp (Rod Threaded), MSS-SP-69 (Type 12). 8. CT255 Copper Tubing Alignment Guide.
Snubbers
Application Requirements: Use components for intended service conditions only. Comply with service requirements below unless noted otherwise on drawings and schedules. 1. Steel hangers in contact with copper piping shall be copper plated, copper painted or epoxy coated. 2. Exterior utility and mechanical yard areas shall use piping that is hot dip galvanized. 3. Interior piping to be black iron. 4. Hydronics and plumbing piping hangers shall be manufactured from carbon steel, cast malleable iron or cast iron. 5. Steam piping hangers shall be manufactured from Chrome Molybdenum steel. 6. Submerged piping hangers shall be manufactured from 316 stainless steel.
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Finishes: Provide nishes to comply with location and application requirements unless noted otherwise on drawings and schedules. 1. Electro-plating galvanizing process per ASTM B633. 2. Hot Dipped galvanizing process per ASTM A153. 3. Epoxy paint. 4. Zinc-rich paint. 5. Standard primer shall meet Fed Spec TT-P-636.
Clevis - Carbon steel. Steel pipe clamps - Carbon steel, alloy, stainless steel. Socket clamps - Carbon steel. Beam clamps - Malleable/ductile iron, hardened steel, carbon steel, forged steel. Structural attachments - Carbon steel, malleable iron. Ceiling plates/ceiling anges - Plastic, cast iron, malleable iron. Concrete inserts and attachments Malleable iron, carbon steel; stainless steel body, berglass bars, polypropylene disc (iron cross design). Rod attachments - Carbon steel, malleable iron, forged steel. Pipe supports - Carbon steel, cast iron. Pipe shields and saddles - Carbon steel, alloy steel, stainless steel. Pipe rolls - Cast iron, carbon steel. Guides - Carbon steel; slides, carbon steel with PTFE slide plates. Engineered hangers - Carbon steel, stainless steel, chrome molybdenum steel.
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Section 15060
4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 212 Medium Pipe Clamp, MSS-SP-69 (Type 4). 212FP Earthquake Bracing Clamp, MSS-SP-69 (Type 4). 216 Heavy Pipe Clamp, MSS-SP-69 (Type 4). 224 Alloy Steel Pipe Clamp, MSS-SP-69 (Type 2). 246 Heavy Duty Alloy Steel Pipe Clamp, MSS-SP-69 (Type 2). 261 Extension Pipe or Riser Clamp, MSS-SP-69 (Type 8). 295 Double Bolt Pipe Clamp, MSS-SP-69 (Type 3). 295A Alloy Double Bolt Pipe Clamp, MSS-SP-69 (Type 3). 295H Heavy Duty Double Bolt Pipe Clamp, MSS-SP-69 (Type 3).
E. Steel Riser Clamps: Fig. Numbers. 1. 40 Riser Clamp - Standard, MSS-SP-69 (Type 42). 2. 261 Extension Pipe or Riser Clamp, MSS-SP-69 (Type 8). F. G. H. I. J. Socket Clamps (AWWA/Ductile/Cast Iron Pipe Sizes Only): Fig. Numbers. 1. 594 Socket Clamp Washer. 2. 595 Socket Clamp for Ductile Iron or Cast Iron Pipe, MSS-SP-69 (Type 8). 3. 599 Socket Clamp Washer. 4. 600 Socket Clamp for Ductile Iron or Cast Iron Pipe, MSS-SP-69 (Type 8). Beam Clamps: Fig. Numbers. 1. 14 Adjustable Side Beam Clamp, MSS-SP-69 (Type 27). 2. 86 C-Clamp with Set Screw & Lock Nut, MSS-SP-69 (Type 23). 3. 87 C-Clamp with Set Screw & Fig. 89 Retaining Clip, MSS-SP-69 (Type 23). 4. 88 C-Clamp with Set Screw Only, MSS-SP-69 (Type 23). 5. 89 Retaining Clip. 6. 89X Retaining Clip. 7. 92 Universal C-type Clamp (Standard Throat), MSS-SP-69 (Type 19 and 23). 8. 93 Universal C-type Clamp (Wide Throat), MSS-SP-69 (Type 19 and 23). 9. 94 Wide Throat Top Beam C-Clamp, MSS-SP-69 (Type 19). 10. 95 C-Clamp with Locknut, MSS-SP-69 (Type 23). 11. 133 Standard Duty Beam Clamp, MSS-SP-69 (Type 21). 12. 134 Heavy Duty Beam Clamp, MSS-SP-69 (Type 21). 13. 217 Adjustable Side Beam Clamp, MSS-SP-69 (Type 25). 14. 218 Malleable Beam Clamp without Extension Piece, MSS-SP-69 (Type 30). 15. 227 Top Beam Clamp, MSS-SP-69 (Type 25). 16. 228 Universal Forged Steel (UFS) Beam Clamp, MSS-SP-69 (Type 28 and 29). 17. 292 Beam Clamp Right Hand Thread with Weld less Eye Nut, MSS-SP-69 (Type 28 and 29). 18. 292L Beam Clamp Left Hand Thread with Weld less Eye Nut, MSS-SP-69 (Type 28 and 29). Structural Attachments: Fig. Numbers. 1. 54 Two Hole Welding Beam Lug. 2. 55 Structural Welding Lug (Short), MSS-SP-69 (Type 57). 3. 55L Structural Welding Lug (Long), MSS-SP-69 (Type 57). 4. 60 Steel Washer Plate. 5. 66 Welded Beam Attachment, MSS-SP-69 (Type 22). 6. 112 Brace Fitting Complete. 7. 113 Brace Fitting (Pipe End Only). Ceiling Plates and Ceiling Flanges: Fig. Numbers. 1. 127 Plastic Ceiling Plate. 2. 128 Pipe Threaded, Ceiling Flange. 3. 128R Rod Threaded, Ceiling Flange. 4. 153 Pipe Hanger Flange. 5. 395 Cast Iron Ceiling Plate. Brackets: Fig. Numbers. 1. 194 Light Welded Steel Bracket, MSS-SP-69 (Type 31). 2. 195 Medium Welded Steel Bracket, MSS-SP-69 (Type 32). 3. 199 Heavy Welded Steel Bracket, MSS-SP-69 (Type 33). 4. 202 Iron Side Beam Bracket, MSS-SP-69 (Type 34). 5. 206 Steel Side Beam Bracket, MSS-SP-69 (Type 34).
244 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Section 15060
K. L. M. N. 6. 207 Threaded Steel Side Beam Bracket, MSS-SP-69 (Type 34). Concrete Inserts and Attachments: Fig. Numbers. 1. 47 Concrete Single Lug Plate. 2. 49 Concrete Clevis Plate. 3. 52 Concrete Rod Attachment Plate. 4. 152 Screw Concrete Insert. 5. 281 Wedge Type Concrete Insert, MSS-SP-69 (Type 18). 6. 282 Universal Concrete Insert, MSS-SP-69 (Type 18). 7. 285 Light Weight Concrete Insert, MSS-SP-69 (Type 19). 8. 286 Iron Cross Design, MSS-SP-69 (Type 18).
Pipe Supports: Fig. Numbers. 1. 62 Pipe Stanchion, Type A, B and C. 2. 63 Pipe Stanchion, Type A, B and C. 3. 191 Pipe Stanchion Saddle With U-Bolt, MSS-SP-69 (Type 37). 4. 192 Adjustable Pipe Saddle Support, MSS-SP-69 (Type 38). 5. 258 Pipe Saddle Support,MSS-SP-69 (Type 36). 6. 259 Pipe Stanchion Saddle Support, MSS-SP-69 (Type 37). 7. 264 Adjustable Pipe Saddle Support, MSS-SP-69 (Type 38). 8. 265 Adjustable Pipe Saddle Support with U-Bolt, MSS-SP-69 (Type 38).
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
245
Index
Application Examples
U-Bolts and Straps: Fig. Numbers. 1. 120 Light Weight U-Bolt. 2. 126 One-Hole Clamp. 3. 137 Standard U-Bolts, MSS-SP-69 (Type 24). 4. 137C Plastic Coated U-Bolts, MSS-SP-69 (Type 24). 5. 137S Special U-Bolts (Non-Standard). 6. 243 Pipe Strap. 7. 244 Pipe Strap. 8. 262 Strap Short, MSS-SP-69 (Type 26). 9. 291 Clevis Pin with Cotters.
Snubbers
Hanger Rod and Rod Attachments: Fig. Numbers. 1. 110R Socket, Rod Threaded, MSS-SP-69 (Type 16). 2. 114 Turnbuckle Adjuster, MSS-SP-69 (Type 15). 3. 135 Straight Rod Coupling (With Sight-Hole). 4. 135E Straight Rod Coupling (Less Sight-Hole). 5. 135R Straight Rod Coupling (Reducing). 6. 136 Straight Rod Coupling, MSS-SP-69 (Type 40). 7. 136R Straight Rod Coupling (Reducing). 8. 140 Machine Threaded Rod. Threaded both ends with right-hand threads. 9. 142 Machine Threaded Coach Screw Rod. Plain nish. 10. 146 Continuous Machine Threaded Rods. 11. 148 Machine Threaded Rod with Eye End. 12. 157 Extension piece. 13. 230 Turnbuckle, MSS-SP-69 (Type 13). 14. 233 Turnbuckle, MSS-SP-69 (Type 13). 15. 248 Machine Threaded Rod with Eye End. Right-hand threads with un-welded eye. 16. 248L Machine Threaded Rod with Eye End. Left-hand threads with un-welded eye. 17. 248X Machine Threaded Rod with Linked Eye Ends. Un-welded eye. 18. 253 Machine Threaded Rod. Threaded both ends with right-hand and left-hand threads. 19. 278 Machine Threaded Rod with Eye End. Right-hand threads with welded eye. 20. 278L Machine Threaded Rod with Eye End. Left-hand threads with welded eye. 21. 278X Machine Threaded Rod with Linked Eye Ends. Welded eye. 22. 290 Thread Weld less Eye Nut (Right Hand Threads), MSS-SP-69 (Type 17). 23. 290L Thread Weld less Eye Nut (Left Hand Threads), MSS-SP-69 (Type 17). 24. 299 Forged Steel Clevis, MSS-SP-69 (Type 14).
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Pipe Supports
Straps
Section 15060
P. Q. R. 2. 46 Universal Trapeze Assembly. 3. 50 Equal Leg Angle for Trapeze Assembly.
Pipe Shields and Saddles: Fig. Numbers. 1. 160 Pipe Covering Protection Saddle, MSS-SP-69 (Type 39A and 39B). 2. 161 Pipe Covering Protection Saddle, MSS-SP-69 (Type 39A and 39B). 3. 162 Pipe Covering Protection Saddle, MSS-SP-69 (Type 39A and 39B). 4. 163 Pipe Covering Protection Saddle, MSS-SP-69 (Type 39A and 39B). 5. 164 Pipe Covering Protection Saddle, MSS-SP-69 (Type 39A and 39B). 6. 165 Pipe Covering Protection Saddle, MSS-SP-69 (Type 39A and 39B). 7. 165A Pipe Covering Protection Saddle (Alloy),MSS-SP-69 (Type 39A and 39B). 8. 166A Pipe Covering Protection Saddle (Alloy), MSS-SP-69 (Type 39A and 39B). 9. 167 Insulation Protection Shield, MSS-SP-69 (Type 40). 10. 168 Rib-Lok Shield, MSS-SP-69 (Type 40). 11. 260 (ISS) Insulation Saddle System, Clevis with High Impact Glass Reinforced Poly-Propylene Saddle. Pipe Rolls: Fig. Numbers. 1. 171 Single Pipe Roll, MSS-SP-69 (Type 41). 2. 175 Roller Chair, MSS-SP-69 (Type 44). 3. 177 Adjustable Pipe Roll Support, MSS-SP-69 (Type 41). 4. 178 Spring Cushion Hanger, MSS-SP-69 (Type 49). 5. 181 Adjustable Steel Yoke Pipe Roll, MSS-SP-69 (Type 43). 6. 271 Complete Pipe Roll Stand, MSS-SP-69 (Type 44). 7. 274 Adjustable Pipe Roll Stand With Base Plate, MSS-SP-69 (Type 46). 8. 274P Adjustable Pipe Roll Stand, Base Plate Only. 9. 275 Adjustable Pipe Roll Stand Without Base Plate. 10. 277 Pipe Roll and Base Plate with Cast Iron Base Plate, MSS-SP-69 (Type 45). 11. 277S Pipe Roll and Base Plate with Steel Base Plate. Guides and Slides: Fig. Numbers. 1. 212 Medium Pipe Clamp, use with slide assemblies. 2. 255 Pipe Alignment Guide, Single Clamp (MVT 4-8 in.) 3. 256 Pipe Alignment Guide, Double Clamp (MVT 6-10 in.) 4. 257 Pipe Slides Assembly, Structural Tee Slide Assembly, MSS-SP-69 (Type 35). 5. 257A Pipe Slides Assembly, Structural Tee. 6. 432 Special Clamp, use with slide assemblies. 7. 436 Pipe Slides Assembly, Fabricated Tee Slide Assembly, MSS-SP-69 (Type 35). 8. 436A Pipe Slides Assembly, Fabricated Tee. 9. 439 Structural H Slide Assembly, Complete, MSS-SP-69 (Type 35). 10. 439A H Section Only.
2.4 METAL FRAMING A. Provide metal framing channel, ttings and hardware components as indicated or required for the structural support of piping systems and equipment. 1. Metal framing shall be Anvil Strut as manufactured by Anvil International. 2. Accessories: As indicated or required by application and location. a. Strut mounted pipe support, Klo-Shure insulated couplings with strut clamp, size range of 3/8 inch (9.5 mm) through 4 inch (102 mm) copper tube with 3/8 inch (9.5 mm) through 1 inch ( 25 mm) thick insulation. b. Strut mounted pipe clamps. c. Strut mounted pipe rollers. d. Strut mounted Cushion Clamps (steel pipe and copper tube). B. Materials Available: Provide materials and nishes to comply with locations and applications requirements as noted on drawings or schedules. 1. Channels shall be produced from prime structural metals complying with the following specication as applicable: a. Pre-Galvanized Steel - ASTM A653. b. Plain Steel - ASTM A570. 1) Finish: Hot-dip galvanized. 2) Finish: Supr-Green powder coating. 3) Finish: PVC coated. c. Aluminum (Type 6063-T6) - ASTM B221. d. Stainless Steel (Type 304 and 316) - ASTM A240.
246 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Section 15060
2.6 EQUIPMENT ANCHOR BOLTS AND TEMPLATES A. Provide templates to ensure accurate location of anchor bolts.
PART 3 EXECUTION
3.1 3.2
B. If substrate preparation is the responsibility of another installer, notify Architect of unsatisfactory preparation before proceeding. PREPARATION A. Clean surfaces thoroughly prior to installation.
3.3
HANGER SPACING A. Plumbing Piping: Most stringent requirements of Plumbing Code, or authority having jurisdiction. B. Fire Protection: Comply with applicable re code. C. Gas and Fuel Oil Piping: Comply with pipe manufacturers recommendations and applicable codes. D. Copper Piping: Comply with pipe manufacturers recommendations and applicable codes.
E. Flexible System Grooved Pipe: Minimum of one hanger required per the minimum recommended pipe length. Comply with groove manufacturers recommended average hangers per pipe length. F. When practical located immediately adjacent to any change of direction of pipe. Total length of pipe between supports less than three-fourths the full hanger span. 3.4 G. In case of concentrated loads (such as valves) the supports shall be placed as close as possible. HANGER INSTALLATION A. Install in accordance with manufacturers instructions. Clamps on Riser Piping: 1. Support independent of connected horizontal pipework using riser clamps and riser clamp lugs welded to riser. 2. Bolt tightening torques shall be to industry standards. 3. Cast Iron Pipes: Install clamp below joint. 4. Steel Pipes: Clamp is tted preferably below coupling or welded pipe lug.
D. Use variable support spring hangers where: 1. Transfer of load to adjacent piping or to connected equipment is not critical. 2. Variation in supporting effect does not exceed 25 percent of total load. E. Adjust hangers to equalize load. F. Support from Structural Members: Where structural bearing does not exist or inserts are not in suitable locations, provide supplementary structural steel members. 3.5 G. Field welding of supports should be done by qualied welders using qualied welding procedures. H. Proper care and ventilation should be given when welding galvanized components. HORIZONTAL MOVEMENT A. Angularity of rod hanger resulting from horizontal movement of pipework from cold to hot position not to exceed 4 degrees from vertical.
B. Where horizontal pipe movement is greater than 1/2 inch (12.7 mm), offset pipe hanger and support so that rod hanger is vertical in hot position. 3.6 FINAL ADJUSTMENT A. Adjust Hangers and Supports: 1. Ensure that rod is vertical under operating conditions.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
247
Index
Application Examples
C. Use approved constant support type hangers where: 1. For critical high temperature where vertical movement of pipe work is 1/2 inch (12.7 mm) or more. 2. Transfer of load to adjacent hangers or connected equipment is not permitted.
Snubbers
B.
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
B. Prepare surfaces using the methods recommended by the manufacturer for achieving the best result for the substrate under the project conditions.
Pipe Roll
EXAMINATION A. Do not begin installation until substrates have been properly prepared.
Trapeze
2.5 EQUIPMENT SUPPORTS A. Fabricate equipment supports not provided by equipment manufacturer from structural grade steel meeting requirements of Section 05 12 16 - Fabricated Fireproofed Steel Columns.
Pipe Supports
Straps
Section 15060
2. Equalize loads. B. Adjustable Clevis: 1. Tighten hanger load nut securely to ensure proper hanger performance. 2. Tighten upper nut after adjustment.
C. C-Clamps: 1. Follow manufacturers recommended written instructions and torque values when tightening C-clamps to bottom ange of beam. D. Beam Clamps: 1. Tighten all set screws and lock nuts. 2. Hammer jaw rmly against underside of beam for Figure 127 only. 3.7 PROTECTION A. Protect installed products until completion of project. B. Touch-up, repair or replace damaged products before Substantial Completion. END OF SECTION
248 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
TECHNICAL DATA
Pipe Supports Straps
Max. Span (Ft) Water Service Max. Span (Ft) Vapor Service Recommended Hanger Rod Sizes
7 8
7 9
7 9
3
9 12
10 13
11 14
12 15
1
13 16
14 17
5
16 19 8
17 21
3
19 24 4
22 26
7
23 30 8
25 32 1
27 35
28 37 1
30 39
32 42
33 44
or trapeze
1
6 8
3
10 14
312
11 15
4
12 16
10
11
13
Note: Spans shown in Tables 1 and 2 do not apply where there are concentrated loads between supports or where temperatures exceed 750F.
73
5 5 512 5 2
1
100
4 2
1
120
4 2
1 1
140
4 4 412 5 5 5 6 6 612 612 7 712 8 8 2
1
160
2 2
1 1
180
2 2
1 1
73
5 2
1 1
100
5 5 2
1
120
4 2
1
140
4 2
1 1
160
3 3 312 3 2
1
180
212 212 3 3 312 312 4 4 412 412 5 512 6 612 8 812
2 4
1 1 4
1
512 5 2
1
5 5 2
1
212 3 3 3 3 2
1 1
6 6 2
1
6 6 612 7 7 2
1
512 6 6 612 7 2
1 1
5 5 2
1
2 2 2
1
6 7 7 712 712 8 2
1
6 7 7 712 712 8 9 10 10 2
1
512 6 2
1
6 6 2
1
4 4 2
1 1
312 4 6 8 10 12 14 16
7 7 7 2
1
4 4 4 2
1
812 9 9 2
1
8 812 9 10 1012 11 2
1
5 5 5 2
1
1012 11 2
1
912 10 10 11
512 6 6 7
11 12 1312 15
13
12
9 2
1
8 2
1
16
13 2
1
12
Note: Although support spacing is shown at 140F, consideration should be given to the use of CPVC or continuous support above 120F. The possibility of temperature overrides beyond regular working temperatures and cost may either make either of the alternatives more desirable. This chart based on continuous spans and for un-insulated line carrying uids of specic gravity up to 1.00. The above table is meant as a general guideline, it is recommended that the pipe manufacturer be consulted for specic spacing recommendations relating to their pipe, load conditions, operating temperature and service conditions. Local codes and specications may also vary from the above recommended spacing and should be consulted for the applicable spacing requirements prior to installation.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
249
Index
Technical Data
12
11
15
1212
11
Application Examples
912
812
1012
3 2
7 2
4 2
Snubbers
112
512
512
312
4 2
2 2
2 2
5 2
4 2
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Max. Span (Ft) Water Service Max. Span (Ft) Vapor Service
The above spacing and capacities are based on pipe lled with water. Additional valves and ttings increase the load and therefore closer hanger spacing is required. *Many codes and specications state pipe hangers must be spaced every 10ft. regardless of size. This local specication must be followed.
Pipe Roll
1 2
1
2 2
1
Trapeze
Table 1: Maximum HOriZOntal Spacing BetWeen Pipe SuppOrts fOr Standard Weight Steel Pipe*
TECHNICAL DATA
Pipe Support Spacing PVC
80
3 2
1
100
3 2
1 1
120
2 2 2
1 1
60
4 4 2
1
80
4 4 2
1 1
100
3 2
1
120
2 2
1 1
60
5 512 6 612 612 712 8 8 2
1
80
5 5 5 2
1
100
4 2
1
120
3 3 3 2
1
140
212 3 3 312 312 312 4 412 412 5 512 6
4 8 2 4
4 4 2
1
3 2 4 4 4 2
1
4 4 2
1
2 2 3 3 3 2
1
4 2 5 5 2
1
5 5 2
1
212 2 2
1
3 3 3 312 3 2
1
6 6 612 712 7 2
1
4 4 4 412 4 2
1
8 812 9 912 10 2
1
5 5 512 6 6 2
1
9 10 2
1
5 5 2
1
11 12 13 1312 14 1412 15
10 10 2
1
7 7 2
1
6 6 2
1
9 2 10 1012 11 1112 12 2
1
6 2 7 712 8 10 11
12 1212 13 14 15
11 1112 12 1212 13
6 612 7 812 9 2
1
11 1112 12 1212 14
8 812 11 1112 12 2
1
7 712 9 912 10 2
1
14 1412 1512 17
SDR 41
18 20 24 13 13 2
1
SDR 26
8 8 2
1
9 9 2
1
12 12 2
1
11 11 2
1
7 7 2
1
14 2
1
14 14 2
1
12 12 2
1
8 8 2
1
15 1512
14
13
12
15
13
10
Note: Although support spacing is shown at 140F, consideration should be given to the use of CPVC or continuous support above 120F. The possibility of temperature overrides beyond regular working temperatures and cost may either make either of the alternatives more desirable. This chart based on continuous spans and for un-insulated line carrying uids of specic gravity up to 1.00. The above table is meant as a general guideline, it is recommended that the pipe manufacturer be consulted for specic spacing recommendations relating to their pipe, load conditions, operating temperature and service conditions. Local codes and specications may also vary from the above recommended spacing and should be consulted for the applicable spacing requirements prior to installation.
250 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
TECHNICAL DATA
Pipe Supports
1
2 4
0.840 1.050 1.315 1.660 1.900 2.375 2.875 3.500 4.000 4.500 5.563 6.625 8.625 10.75 12.75 14.000 16.000 18.000 20.000 24.000 30.000 36.000
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
251
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Pipe Roll
0.675
40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 20 20
0.091 0.126 0.109 0.147 0.113 0.154 0.133 0.179 0.140 0.191 0.145 0.200 0.154 0.218 0.203 0.276 0.216 0.300 0.226 0.318 0.237 0.337 0.258 0.375 0.280 0.432 0.322 0.500 0.365 0.593 0.406 0.687 0.437 0.750 0.500 0.843 0.562 0.937 0.593 1.031 0.687 1.218 0.500 0.500
0.568 0.739 0.851 1.088 1.131 1.474 1.679 2.172 2.273 2.997 2.718 3.631 3.653 5.022 5.793 7.661 7.580 10.25 9.11 12.51 10.79 14.98 14.62 20.78 18.97 28.57 28.55 43.39 40.48 64.33 53.53 88.51 63.37 106.13 82.77 136.46 104.75 170.75 122.91 208.87 171.17 296.36 158.00 190.00
0.083 0.061 0.132 0.101 0.230 0.188 0.374 0.311 0.648 0.555 0.882 0.765 1.455 1.280 2.076 1.837 3.20 2.864 4.280 3.850 5.510 4.980 8.660 7.870 12.51 11.29 21.69 19.800 34.10 31.10 48.50 44.00 58.70 53.20 76.50 69.70 97.00 88.50 120.4 109.4 174.3 158.3 286.2 417.1
Trapeze
Pipe Size
O.D.
Schedule No.
Wall Thickness
Straps
TECHNICAL DATA
Pipe Data Steel Schedule No. 10
Pipe Size
1 114 112 2 212 3 312 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24
O.D.
1.315 1.660 1.900 2.375 2.875 3.500 4.000 4.500 5.563 6.625 8.625 10.75 12.75 14.000 16.000 18.000 20.000 24.000
Wall Thickness
0.109 0.109 0.109 0.109 0.120 0.120 0.120 0.120 0.134 0.134 0.148 0.165 0.180 0.250 0.250 0.250 0.250 0.250
Type L & K
TYpe K
Weight of Water per Foot (lbs)
.034 .062 .100 .151 .209 .357 .546 .767 1.341 2.064 2.949 3.989 5.188 8.081 11.616 20.289 31.590 45.426
Tubing O.D.
0.375 0.500 0.625 0.750 0.875 1.125 1.375 1.625 2.125 2.625 3.125 3.625 4.125 5.125 6.125 8.125 10.125 12.125
Wall Thickness
.030 .035 .040 .042 .045 .050 .055 .060 .070 .080 .090 .100 .110 .125 .140 .200 .250 .280
Tube Size
4 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 1 114 112 2 212 3 312 4 5 6 8 10 12
1 3
Tubing O.D.
0.375 0.500 0.625 0.750 0.875 1.125 1.375 1.625 2.125 2.625 3.125 3.625 4.125 5.125 6.125 8.125 10.125 12.125
Wall Thickness
.035 .049 .049 .049 .065 .065 .065 .072 .083 .095 .109 .120 .134 .160 .192 .271 .338 .405
252 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
TECHNICAL DATA
Pipe Supports Straps
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
253
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
2 3 4 5 6 8 10 12 15
3 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30 36 42 48
53 53 53 53 53 53 53 53 53 53 53 53 53 53 53
3.96 4.80 6.90 9.05 11.10 13.20 15.30 17.40 19.50 21.60 25.80 32.00 38.30 44.50 50.80
.31 .32 .34 .36 .38 .40 .42 .43 .44 .45 .47 .51 .58 .65 .72
11.20 14.20 22.00 31.00 40.40 50.70 62.40 72.80 83.60 95.20 119.20 161.30 219.50 285.20 360.30
3.80 5.90 13.10 23.00 36.40 52.30 71.10 93.10 117.90 145.80 210.20 326.50 469.30 634.90 828.90
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
Nom. Weight Weight of O.D. Wall Pipe Class per Foot Water per Foot D.I. Pipe Thickness Size (lbs) (lbs)
TECHNICAL DATA
PVC Plastic Pipe Data Schedule No. 40 & 80
Pipe Size
1
O.D.
0.405 0.540 0.675 0.840 1.050 1.315 1.660 1.900 2.375 2.875 3.500 4.000 4.500 5.563 6.625 8.625 10.750 12.750
Schedule No.
40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80
Wall Thickness
0.068 0.095 0.088 0.119 0.091 0.126 0.109 0.147 0.113 0.154 0.133 0.179 0.140 0.191 0.145 0.200 0.154 0.218 0.203 0.276 0.216 0.300 0.226 0.318 0.237 0.337 0.258 0.375 0.280 0.432 0.322 0.500 0.366 0.593 0.406 0.687
8 4 8 2 4
254 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
TECHNICAL DATA
Pipe Supports Straps
Temp F
-200 -100 0 0 100 200 300 400 500 600 700 800 900 1,000 1,100 1,200 1,300 1,400
Temp F
-200 -100 0 0 100 200 300 400 500 600 700 800 900 1,000 1,100 1,200 1,300 1,400
0
-0.0281 -0.0187 -0.0078 -0.0078 0.0034 0.0146 0.0261 0.0380 0.0501 0.0624 0.0750 0.0880 0.1012 0.1148 0.1284 0.1420 0.1556 0.1692
10
-0.0295 -0.0197 -0.0089 -0.0067 0.0045 0.0158 0.0273 0.0392 0.0513 0.0637 0.0763 0.0893 0.1260 0.1162 0.1298 0.1434 0.1570 0.1704
20
-0.0305 -0.0207 -0.0100 -0.0056 0.0056 0.0169 0.0285 0.0404 0.0526 0.0649 0.0776 0.0906 0.1039 0.1175 0.1311 0.1447 0.1583 0.1717
70
-0.0353 -0.0254 -0.0155 0 0.0112 0.0227 0.0344 0.0465 0.0587 0.0712 0.0841 0.0972 0.1107 0.1243 0.1379 0.1515 0.1651 0.1784
80
-0.0362 -0.0263 -0.0166 0.0012 0.0124 0.0238 0.0356 0.0477 0.0599 0.0725 0.0854 0.0986 0.1121 0.1257 0.1393 0.1529 0.1665 0.1796
90
-0.0372 -0.0272 -0.0176 0.0023 0.0135 0.0250 0.0368 0.0489 0.0612 0.0737 0.0867 0.0999 0.1134 0.1270 0.1406 0.1542 0.1678 0.1811
Note: Intersect 10 Degree increments across the top of each table with the 100 degree increments down the left side to determine the coefcient of thermal expansion for the desired temperature.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
255
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
-0.0180 -0.0121 -0.0051 -0.0051 0.0023 0.0099 0.0182 0.0270 0.0362 0.0460 0.0563 0.0670 0.0781 0.0889 0.1004 0.1110 0.1222 0.1334
-0.0187 -0.0127 -0.0058 -0.0044 0.0030 0.0107 0.0191 0.0279 0.0372 0.0470 0.0574 0.0681 0.0792 0.0901 0.1015 0.1121 0.1233
-0.0192 -0.0133 -0.0065 -0.0037 0.0038 0.0116 0.0200 0.0288 0.0382 0.0481 0.0584 0.0692 0.0803 0.0912 0.1025 0.1132 0.1244
-0.0198 -0.0140 -0.0073 -0.0029 0.0046 0.0124 0.0208 0.0298 0.0391 0.0491 0.0595 0.0703 0.0813 0.0924 0.1036 0.1144 0.1256
-0.0203 -0.0146 -0.0080 -0.0022 0.0053 0.0132 0.0217 0.0307 0.0401 0.0501 0.0606 0.0714 0.0824 0.0935 0.1046 0.1155 0.1267
-0.0209 -0.0152 -0.0087 -0.0015 0.0061 0.0141 0.0226 0.0316 0.0411 0.0512 0.0617 0.0726 0.0835 0.0946 0.1057 0.1166 0.1278
-0.0215 -0.0158 -0.0096 -0.0007 0.0068 0.0149 0.0235 0.0325 0.0421 0.0522 0.0627 0.0737 0.0846 0.0958 0.1068 0.1177 0.1299
-0.0220 -0.0163 -0.0103 0 0.0076 0.0157 0.0244 0.0334 0.0431 0.0532 0.0638 0.0748 0.0857 0.0970 0.1078 0.1188 0.1320
-0.0225 -0.0169 -0.0109 0.0008 0.0084 0.0165 0.0252 0.0344 0.0440 0.0542 0.0649 0.0759 0.0867 0.0981 0.1089 0.1200 0.1342
-0.0230 -0.0174 -0.0116 0.0015 0.0091 0.0174 0.0261 0.0353 0.0450 0.0553 0.0659 0.0770 0.0878 0.0993 0.1099 0.1211 0.1363
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Pipe Roll
10
20
70
80
90
Trapeze
TECHNICAL DATA
Thermal Expansion of Pipe Material
Copper
-0.0275 -0.0231 -0.1830 -0.1320 -0.0790 -0.0022 0.0000 0.0034 0.0091 0.0151 0.0208 0.0267 0.0327 0.0388 0.0449 0.0512 0.0574 0.0639 0.0703 0.0768 0.0834 0.0900 0.0967 0.1037 0.1105 0.1175
Brass
-0.2870 -0.0241 -0.1900 -0.0137 -0.0081 -0.0023 0.0000 0.0035 0.0093 0.0152 0.0214 0.0276 0.0340 0.0405 0.0472 0.0540 0.0610 0.0680 0.0753 0.0826 0.0902 0.0978 0.1056 0.1135 0.1216 0.1298
Aluminum
-0.0373 -0.0310 -0.0244 -0.0176 -0.0104 -0.0030 0.0000 0.0046 0.0123 0.0200 0.0283 0.0366 0.0452 0.0539 0.0628 0.0717 0.0810 0.0903
256 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
TECHNICAL DATA
Pipe Supports Standard UNC thread thru 4" diameter and 4-UN-2A thread series for 414" diameter and larger Straps
Bolt Size
4 5 16 3 8 7 16 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8 1
1
Thread Size
1 3 1 5 3 7
4 8 2 8 4 8
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
257
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
8 2 5 8 3 4 7 8 1 114 112 134 2 214 212 234 3 314 312 334 4 414 412 434 5
3 1
16 UNC 13 UNC 11 UNC 10 UNC 9 UNC 8 UNC 7 UNC 6 UNC 5 UNC 412 UNC 412 UNC 4 UNC 4 UNC 4 UNC 4 UNC 4 UNC 4 UNC 4 UNC 4 UN 4 UN 4 UN 4 UN
0.0678 0.126 0.202 0.302 0.419 0.551 0.890 1.29 1.74 2.30 3.02 3.72 4.62 5.62 6.72 7.92 9.21 10.6 12.1 13.7 15.4 17.2
730 1,350 2,160 3,230 4,480 5,900 9,500 13,800 18,600 24,600 32,300 39,800 49,400 60,100 71,900 84,700 98,500 114,000 129,000 146,000 165,000 184,000
572 1,057 1,692 2,530 3,508 4,620 7,440 10,807 14,566 19,265 25,295 31,169 38,687 47,066 56,307 66,331 77,139 88,807 101,337 114,807 128,982 144,096
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
LOad CarrYing Capacities Of Threaded Hanger ROds. Materials CarbOn Steel With Minimum Actual Tensile Strength Of 50 Ksi.
S SHapes
Depth of Weight Section per Ft., Y lb. Flange Width Mean Thick of Flange Z
W SHapes
Depth of Weight Section per Ft., Y lb. Flange Width Mean Thick of Flange Z
W SHapes
Depth of Weight Section per Ft., Y lb. Flange Width Mean Thick of Flange Z
3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10
12 15
18
4.1 5.0 6.0 5.4 7.25 6.7 9.0 8.2 10.5 13.0 9.8 12.25 14.75 11.5 13.75 18.75 13.4 15.0 20.0 15.3 20.0 25.0 30.0 20.7 25.0 30.0 33.9 40.0 50.0 42.7 45.8 51.9 58.0
138 112 158 158 134 134 178 178 2 218 218 214 214 214 238 212 238 212 258 258 234 278 3 3 3 318 338 312 334 4 4 418 414
0.250 0.313
3 4 5
5.7 7.5 7.7 9.5 10.0 14.75 12.5 17.25 15.3 20.0 18.4 23.0 25.4 35.0 31.8 35.0 40.8 50.0 42.9 50.0 54.7 70.0 66.0 75.0 86.0 96.0 80.0 90.0 100.0
238 212 258 234 3 314 338 358 358 378 4 418 458 5 5 518 514 512 512 558 6 614 614 638 7 714 7 718 714
5 6
0.625
12
14
19 25 18 21 24 28 31 35 40 48 58 67 22 26 30 33 39 45 49 54 60 68 77 88 26 30 35 40 45 50 53 58 65 72 79 87 96 106 30 34 38 43 48 53 61 68 74 82 90
5 618 514 514 612 612 8 8 818 818 814 814 534 534 534 8 8 8 10 10 1018 1018 1014 1014 612 612 612 8 8 818 10 10 12 12 1218 1218 1218 1214 634 634 634 8 8 8 10 10 1018 1018 1412
0.430 0.455 0.330 0.400 0.400 0.465 0.435 0.495 0.560 0.685 0.810 0.935 0.360 0.440 0.510 0.435 0.530 0.620 0.560 0.615 0.680 0.770 0.870 0.990 0.380 0.440 0.520 0.515 0.575 0.640 0.575 0.640 0.605 0.670 0.735 0.810 0.900 0.990 0.385 0.455 0.515 0.530 0.595 0.660 0.645 0.720 0.785 0.855 0.710
14
16
18
21
24
27
30
33 36
99 109 120 132 36 40 45 50 57 67 77 89 100 50 55 60 65 71 76 86 97 106 62 68 73 83 93 101 111 122 76 84 94 104 117 131 94 102 114 146 108 116 124 132 118 130 141 135 150 160
1458 1458 1458 1434 7 7 7 718 718 1014 1014 1038 1038 712 712 712 758 758 11 1118 1118 1114 814 814 814 838 838 1214 1238 1238 9 9 918 1234 1234 1278 10 10 1018 14 1012 1012 1012 1012 1112 1112 1112 12 12 12
0.780 0.860 0.940 1.030 0.430 0.505 0.565 0.63 0.715 0.665 0.760 0.875 0.985 0.570 0.630 0.695 0.750 0.810 0.680 0.770 0.870 0.940 0.615 0.685 0.740 0.835 0.930 0.800 0.875 0.960 0.680 0.770 0.875 0.750 0.850 0.960 0.745 0.830 0.930 0.975 0.760 0.850 0.930 1.000 0.740 0.855 0.960 0.790 0.940 1.020
258 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
88 89 89X 92 93 94 95 100 103 104 108 110R 112 113 114 120 126 127 128R 133
23 19 & 23 19 & 23 19 23 6 11 16 15 21
23 23 23 19 23 6 11 16 15 21
23 19 & 23 19 & 23 19 23 6 11 16 15 21
*= FM Approved
= UL Listed
= ULC Listed
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
259
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
23
23
23
Constant Supports
10
10
10
Spring Hangers
27 42 57 57 22 5
54 57 57 1 22
27 42 57 57 22 5
3 8 1 2 3 8 3 8 3 8 1 2 3 8 1 2 3 8, 12 3 8 1 2
3 8 1 2 3 8 1 2 3 4 3 8 3 4 3 8 1 2 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 3 8 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8 3 8 1 2
3 8 1 2 3 4 3 8 3 4 3 8 1 2 3 8 1 2
Pipe Roll
Product Types MSS SP-58 Federal Specications & ANSI/MSS WW-H-171-E A-A-1192A SP-69
UL n Rod Size
UL n Pipe Size
Trapeze
Application Sizes
Straps
Application Sizes
FM* Rod Size FM* Pipe Size UL n Rod Size UL n Pipe Size ULC Rod Size ULC Pipe Size
21 24 24 25 40A & 40B 40A & 40B 40A & 40B 40A & 40B 40A & 40B 40A & 40B 40A & 40B 40A & 40B 41 41 42 45 42 50 44 = ULC Listed
21 24 24 12 39A & 39B 39A & 39B 39A & 39B 39A & 39B 39A & 39B 39A & 39B 39A & 39B 39A & 39B 40 40 41 44 41 49 43
136R 137 137C 137S 138R 140 142 146 148 152
153
157 160 161 162 163 164 165 165A 166A 167 168 171 175 177 178 181 185 186 187 188 189
*= FM Approved
2 8 3 8 1 2 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8 3 8 1 2 3 8 1 2 3 8
1 5
2 8 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8 3 8 1 2 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8 3 8
1 5
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 3 8
= UL Listed
260 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
37 38 31 32 33 34 34 34
38 39 32 33 34 35 35 35
37 38 31 32 33 34 34 34
1
218 224 227 228 228L 230 233 243 244 246 248 248L 248X 253 255 256 257 257A 258 259
30 2 25 28 & 29 28 & 29 13 13 2 35 36 37
30 2 25 28 & 29 28 & 29 13 13 2 35 36 37
*= FM Approved
= UL Listed
= ULC Listed
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
261
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
4 4 25
4 4
4 4 25
212
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
8 3 8 1 2 3 8
3
8 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 8 1 2 3 8 1 2 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8 3 8 1 2
3
8 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 8 1 2 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
3
4 - 4 1 -4 5- 8 10, 12 3 4 - 4 5- 8 3 4 - 4 5- 8 10, 12 12 12
3
Pipe Roll
Product Types MSS SP-58 Federal Specications & ANSI/MSS WW-H-171-E A-A-1192A SP-69
UL n Rod Size
UL n Pipe Size
Trapeze
Application Sizes
Straps
(cont.)
(cont.)
Application Sizes
FM* Rod Size FM* Pipe Size UL n Rod Size UL n Pipe Size ULC Rod Size ULC Pipe Size
260 261 262 264 265 271 274 274P 275 277 278 278L 278X 281
282 284 285 286 290 290L 291 292 292L 295 295A 295H 299 300 395 432 436 436A 439 590 594 595 599 600 777
*= FM Approved
n
18 19 18 17 17 28 & 29 28 & 29 3 3 3 14 1 35 35 1 8 8
= UL Listed
18 18 18 17 17 28 & 29 28 & 29 3 3 3 14 1 35 35 1 8 8
8 2 5 8 3 4 7 8 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8 3 8 1 2
3 1
8 2 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 8
3 1
8 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 8
3
262 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
(cont.)
Application Sizes
FM* Rod Size FM* Pipe Size UL n Rod Size UL n Pipe Size ULC Rod Size ULC Pipe Size
1 10 8 25 = ULC Listed
10 8 12
3 8 - 114 1 8 - 34
X X X X X X
8 3 8
3
1-2 4 - 2 3 4 - 2
3
0 - 90
A - Sch. 40, Sch. 10 IPS and Flow Pipe B - Sch. 40 1" - 6"; Sch. 10 11/4" - 6" D - Sch. 10 and Sch. 40 21/2" - 8". Flow Pipe 21/2" - 6" OSHPD - State of California Ofce of Statewide Health Planning and Development
Note: Refer to UL/ULC & FM websites for load and size combinations.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
263
50
4 5 6 8
51
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
35 36 37 38
52
53
19
40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
21 22
54 55 56 57 58
23
24 25
264 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
Anvil Markets
Fire Protection Mechanical HVAC/Plumbing Industrial Petro Chemical Renery Pulp & Paper Waste Water, Water Treatment Marine Co-generation Fossil Power Nuclear Power Seismic
Technical Services
Design services, either on or off site, help you maximize the efciency of your pipe support systems. These services include: Pipe Hanger design and engineering Drafting Services System Analysis Pipe Stress Analysis Product Qualication Testing Supervision of client design personnel HYDRAULIC SNUBBERS: The Pipe Support Division has the technical expertise, manufacturing facilities and testing equipment to provide extensive design, installation, maintenance and repair or rebuild services for hydraulic shock suppressors. On site service available by certied technicians for fossil and nuclear plants.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-11.11
265
266 PH-11.11
www.anvilintl.com
INDEX
Table of Contents Photo Index General Notes Copper Tubing Hangers Stainless Steel Hangers CPVC Pipe Hangers Pipe Rings Clevis Steel Pipe Clamps Socket Clamps Beam Clamps Structural Attachments Brackets Ceiling Plates & Flanges Concrete Inserts & Attachments Hanger Rods Rod Attachments Bolts, Nuts, Pins & U-Bolts Straps Pipe Supports Trapeze Pipe Shields & Saddles Pipe Rolls Pipe Guide & Slides Sway Brace - Seismic Spring Hangers Constant Supports Vibration Control & Sway Brace Sway Strut Assembly Hydraulic Snubbers & Tapered Load Pin Special Design Products Application Assembly Examples Pipe Hanger Specications Master Format 3 Part Specication 4-6 7 - 15 16 - 18 20 - 27 28 - 31 32 - 35 36 - 39 40 - 47 48 - 57 58 - 59 60 - 71 72 - 76 77 - 83 84 - 86 87 - 95 96 - 99 100 - 104 105 - 108 109 - 110 111 - 117 118 - 120 121 - 126 127 - 135 136 - 147 148 - 163 164 - 181 182 - 207 208 - 210 211 - 215 216 - 224 225 - 228 229 - 236 237 - 238 239 - 248
Pipe Supports Straps
Subject Index
Technical Data Index (Note #1) Pipe Support Spacing 249 - 250 Pipe Data 251 - 254 Thermal Expansion of Pipe Material 255 - 256 Threaded Rod Data 257 Torques: Riser Clamps & C-Clamps 257 Beam Dimensions 258 Anvil Compliances, Listings & Approvals 259 - 264 Anvil Pipe Hangers and Support Services 265 Anvil Terms of Sale and Conditions 266
Note #1: Charts and Tables Charts and tables in this section are compiled from information published by nationally recognized organizations and are intended for use as a guide only. Anvil International ("Anvil") recommends that users of this information determine the validity of such information as applied to their own applications.
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
267
Index
Technical Data
Application Examples
Snubbers
Constant Supports
Spring Hangers
Pipe Roll
Trapeze
= Columbia, PA = North Kingstown, RI = Henderson, TN = Regional Service Centers * = rod dia. over 112" (North Kingstown, RI)
Figure Number Fig. 103 Fig. 104 Fig. 108 Fig. 110R Fig. 112 Fig. 113 Fig. 114 Fig. 120 Fig. 126 Fig. 127 Fig. 128R Fig. 133 Fig. 134 Fig. 135, Fig. 135E & Fig. 135R Fig. 136 & Fig. 136R Fig. 137, Fig. 137S & Fig. 137C Fig. 137SS Fig. 138R Fig. 140 Fig. 142 Fig. 146 Fig. 148 Fig. 152 Fig. 153 Fig. 157 Fig. 160 thru Fig. 166A Fig. 167 Fig. 168 Fig. 170 Fig. 171 Fig. 175 Fig. 177 Fig. 178 Fig. 181 Fig. 185 Fig. 186 Fig. 187 Fig. 188 Fig. 189 Fig. 190 Fig. 191 Fig. 192 Fig. 194 Fig. 195 Fig. 199 Fig. 200, C-200 Fig. 201, C-201 Fig. 202 Fig. 206 Fig. 207 Fig. 211, C-211 Fig. 212 Fig. 212FP Fig. 216
Page 50 38 36 101 76 76 101 108 109 84 85 68 68 100 100 107 - 108 28 37 97 96 96 99 87 86 102 123 - 126 121 122 207 128 131 127 129 130 32 33 34 35 79 80 113 113 81 82 83 220 - 223 220 - 223 77 78 78 211 - 212 51, 147 52 53
268 PH-1.14
www.anvilintl.com
= Columbia, PA = North Kingstown, RI = Henderson, TN = Regional Service Centers * = rod dia. over 112" (North Kingstown, RI)
Figure Number Fig. 312 Fig. 395 Fig. 432 Fig. 436 & Fig. 436A Fig. 439 & Fig. 439A Fig. 590 Fig. 590SS Fig. 595 & Fig. 594 Fig. 600 & Fig. 599 Fig. 640, C-640 Fig. 770 Fig. 771 Fig. 772 Fig. 773 Fig. 775 Fig. 776 Fig. 777 Fig. 778 Fig. 779 Fig. 3306, 3307 Fig. CT-65 Fig. CT-69 Fig. CT-121 Fig. CT-128R Fig. CT-138R Fig. CT-255
Page 224 84 146 140 - 143 144 - 145 47 31 58 59 211 - 212 148 - 149 162 - 163 156 - 158 160 152 - 153 150 - 151 161 154 - 155 159 216 - 219 21 20 25 22 22 26 - 27 259 - 264 265 266 258 206 186 - 189 252 249 106 264 239 - 248 257 182 - 185 180 - 181 168 166 - 167 17 -18 16 251 - 252 215 255 - 256 178 - 179 237 - 238 205
Anvil Compliances, Listings and Approvals Anvil Pipe Hangers and Support Services Anvil Terms of Sale and Conditions Beam Dimensions Constant Support Check List Constant Support, Total Travel & Selection Chart Copper Tube Data CPVC Pipe Support Spacing Hexagon Nuts & Machine Bolts Manufacturers Standardization Society Hanger Type Index Master Format 3 Part Specication Maximum Recommended Applied Torques Model R 80-V, 81-H Mathematically Perfect Pipe Support Quadruple Spring, Quadruple Spring-CR Series Spring Hanger Check List Spring Hanger Size & Series Selection Standard Galvanizing Practice Standard Materials Steel Pipe Data Sway Strut Check List Thermal Expansion of Pipe Material Triple Spring, Triple Spring-CR Series Typical Pipe Hanger Specication Weight Chart - Fig. 80-V & Fig.81-H
www.anvilintl.com
PH-1.14
269
NOTES
270
www.anvilintl.com
NOTES
www.anvilintl.com
271
NOTES
272
www.anvilintl.com
NOTES
www.anvilintl.com
273
B R A N D S O F A N V I L I N T E R N AT I O N A L
Anvil product lines include malleable and cast iron ttings, unions and anges; seamless and welded steel pipe nipples; steel pipe couplings; universal anvilets; forged steel ttings and unions; pipe hangers and supports; threaded rod; and engineered hangers. The SPF/Anvil product line includes a variety of internationally sourced products such as grooved couplings, ttings, cast iron, malleable iron and ductile iron threaded ttings, steel pipe nipples, as well as tee-lets.
The Gruvlok product line consists of couplings for grooved and plainend ttings, buttery valves and check valves; anges; pump protection components; pipe grooving tools; as well as copper and stainless steel system components.
JB Smith is the leading manufacturer of oil country tubular fittings, swages and bull plugs all meeting API specifications. Offering tubing nipples, casing nipples as well as a full line of traditional line pipe and oil country threads in every schedule, JB Smith is the resource for all your oilfield needs.
Anvil-Strut products include a complete line of channel in stock lengths of 10 and 20 feet, with custom lengths available upon request. A variety of fittings and accessories are also offered. All products can be ordered in an assortment of finishes and material choices including SupR-Green, Zinc Trivalent Chromium, pre-galvanized, hot-dipped galvanized, electro-galvanized, aluminum, plain, and stainless steel.
Steel pipe nipples and steel pipe couplings are manufactured in accordance with the ASTM A733 Standard Specification for Welded and Seamless Carbon Steel and Stainless Steel Pipe Nipples.Steel pipe couplings are manufactured in accordance with the ASTM A865 Standard Specification for Threaded Couplings, Steel, Black or Zinc-Coated (Galvanized) Welded or Seamless, for Use in Steel Pipe Joints. API couplings are manufactured in accordance with the API Specification for line pipe.
The Merit product line includes a variety of tee-lets and drop nipples for fire protection applications. Most Merit products are UL/ULC Listed, FM Approved, and rated from 175 to 300 psi.
Catawissa NACE and API approved wing unions for Standard Service are offered in non-pressure seal ends as well as threaded and butt weld, and are interchangeable with most leading union manufacturers. Fully traceable and available with complete mill certifications, Catawissas oilfield wing union product line includes the standard ball-and-cone design plus our unique Figure 300 Flat Face design, where space and pipe line separation are a consideration.
Canvil manufactures low pressure hexagon reducer bushings, as well as plugs and hex caps up to 1 in diameter in various finishes including Oil Treat, Phosphate and Electro Galvanized. In addition, Canvil manufactures A105 hex or round material in class 3000 and 6000 pound, forged steel couplings and bar stock products offered as either as normalized (A105N) or non-normalized (A105) that are fully traceable for mechanicals and chemistry through our MTR program.
North Alabama Pipe Founded in 1983, NAP is a manufacturer of fabrication equipment, including automatic welders, plasma cut-off equipment, hole cutting equipment, make-on machines and pipe threaders. NAP, innovators of pipe fabrication equipment.
Anvil EPS-Engineered Pipe Supports are products used to support piping systems under thermal, seismic, and other dynamic loading conditions. The product line encompasses variable spring hangers, constant supports, sway struts and snubbers as well as standard and special design clamps. Anvil EPS brings the highest quality products and innovative engineering solutions to common and uncommon piping system problems.
CORpORaTE OFFIcEs 2 Holland Way, Exeter, NH 03833 Tel: 603-418-2800 Fax: 603-418-2833 E-mail: sales@anvilintl.com U.S. REGIOnaL SErVICE CEnTErs Northern Region Regional Distribution & Customer Service Center 7979 W. 183rd Street, Tinley Park, IL 60477 Tel: 708-885-3000 Fax: 708-534-5441 Toll Free: 1-800-301-2701 Southern Region Regional Distribution & Customer Service Center 1401 Valley View Lane, Suite 150, Irving, TX 75061 Tel: 972-871-1206 Fax: 972-641-8946 Toll Free: 1-800-451-4414 Anvil EPS Engineered Pipe Supports Customer Service Center 160 Frenchtown Road, North Kingstown, RI 02852 Tel: 401-886-3000 Fax: 401-886-3010 Toll Free: 1-877-406-3108 CanaDa SErVICE CEnTEr Anvil International Canada Customer Service Center 390 Second Avenue, P.O. Box 40, Simcoe, Ontario N3Y 4K9 Tel: 519-426-4551 Fax: 519-426-5509 InTErnaTIOnaL saLEs Europe and Middle East Region Rick van Meesen rvanmeesen@anvilintl.com Tel: +31-53-5725570 Fax: +31-53-5725579 Mexico, Puerto Rico and Latin America Region International Customer Service Tel: +1-708-885-3000 Fax: +1-708-534-5441
B U I L D I N G
C O N N E C T I O N S
T H A T
L A S T
North Alabama Pipe